Quarterlytics / Healthcare / Medical - Devices / Globus Medical

Globus Medical

gmed · NYSE Healthcare
Claim this profile
Ticker gmed
Exchange NYSE
Sector Healthcare
Industry Medical - Devices
Employees 1001-5000
← All annual reports
FY2023 Annual Report · Globus Medical
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
FORM 10-K

☒ ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2023 
or
☐ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from ______________ to _______________

Commission File No. 001-35621

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

DELAWARE
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

04-3744954
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

2560 General Armistead Avenue, Audubon, PA 19403
(Address of principal executive offices) (Zip Code)

(610) 930-1800
(Registrant’s telephone number, including Area Code)

Title of each class
Class A Common Stock, par value $.001 per share

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Trading Symbol(s)
GMED

Name of exchange on which registered
New York Stock Exchange

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act: Yes  ☒  No  ☐ 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act: Yes ☐  No ☒

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 
12  months  (or  for  such  shorter  period  that  the  registrant  was  required  to  file  such  reports),  and  (2)  has  been  subject  to  such  filing  requirements  for  the  past  90  days: 
Yes ☒  No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T 
(§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files): Yes ☒  No ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company or an emerging growth 
company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange 
Act:

Large Accelerated Filer

☒ Accelerated Filer ☐



Non-accelerated Filer ☐


Smaller Reporting Company ☐


If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised 
financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of
the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C.
7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report.

☒

Emerging Growth Company ☐



If securities are registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Exchange Act, indicate by check mark whether the financial statements of the registrant included in the filing 
reflect the correction of an error to previously issued financial statements. ☐

Indicate by check mark whether any of those error corrections are restatements that required a recovery analysis of incentive-based compensation received by any of the 
registrant’s executive officers during the relevant recovery period pursuant to §240.10D-1(b). ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act): Yes ☐  No ☒

The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant, computed by reference to the closing sales price for the 
registrant’s common stock on the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second quarter, June 30, 2023, as reported on the New York Stock Exchange, 
was approximately $4.6 billion.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The number of shares outstanding of the issuer’s common stock (par value $0.001 per share) as of February 16, 2024 was 135,372,391 shares.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

Portions of our Proxy Statement for our 2024 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed within 120 days of December 31, 2023, are incorporated by reference in Part III, 
Items 10, 11, 12, 13 and 14 herein of this Annual Report. Such Proxy Statement, except for the parts therein which have been specifically incorporated by reference, shall 
not be deemed “filed” for the purposes of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. 

2

 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
TABLE OF CONTENTS

Item 1.
Item 1A.
Item 1B.
Item 2.
Item 3.
Item 4.

Item 5.
Item 7.
Item 7A.
Item 8.
Item 9.
Item 9A.
Item 9B.
Item 9C.

Item 10.
Item 11.
Item 12.
Item 13.
Item 14.

Item 15
Item 16

PART I
Business
Risk Factors
Unresolved Staff Comments
Properties
Legal Proceedings
Mine Safety Disclosures

PART II
Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure About Market Risk
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
Controls and Procedures
Other Information
Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent inspections

PART III
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
Executive Compensation
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
Principal Accountant Fees and Services

PART IV
Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
Form 10-K Summary

SIGNATURES

3

Page

5
20
46
46
46
46

47
49
59
61
97
97
97
99

99
99
99
99
99

100
105

106

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

PART I

CAUTIONARY NOTE CONCERNING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This  Annual  Report  on  Form  10-K  contains  forward-looking  statements  within  the  meaning  of  the  Private  Securities  Litigation  Reform  Act  of 
1995, Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended 
(the  “Exchange  Act”).  All  statements  other  than  statements  of  historical  fact  are  forward-looking  statements.  We  have  tried  to  identify  forward-looking 
statements by using words such as “believe,” “may,” “might,” “could,” “will,” “aim,” “estimate,” “continue,” “anticipate,” “intend,” “expect,” “plan” and 
similar words. These forward-looking statements are based on our current assumptions, expectations and estimates of future events and trends. Forward-
looking statements are only predictions and are subject to many risks, uncertainties and other factors that may affect our businesses and operations and 
could  cause  actual  results  to  differ  materially  from  those  predicted.  These  risks  and  uncertainties  include,  but  are  not  limited  to,  the  risks  and  costs 
associated  with  the  integration  of,  and  our  ability  to  successfully  integrate  the  NuVasive  business  and  Globus  Medical,  Inc.  and  to  achieve  anticipated 
synergies from the integration, health epidemics, pandemics and similar outbreaks, factors affecting our quarterly results, our ability to manage our growth, 
our ability to sustain our profitability, demand for our products, our ability to compete successfully (including without limitation our ability to convince 
surgeons to use our products and our ability to attract and retain sales and other personnel), our ability to rapidly develop and introduce new products, our 
ability to develop and execute on successful business strategies, our ability to comply with changes and applicable laws and regulations that are applicable 
to our businesses, our ability to safeguard our intellectual property, our success in defending legal proceedings brought against us, trends in the medical 
device industry, general economic conditions, and other risks set forth throughout this Annual Report, including under “Item 1. Business,” “Item 1A. Risk 
Factors,” “Item  7.  Management’s  Discussion  and  Analysis  of  Financial  Condition  and  Results  of  Operations,”  and  “Item  7A.  Quantitative  and 
Qualitative Disclosure About Market Risk” and those discussed in other documents we file with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). 
Moreover, we operate in an evolving environment. New risk factors and uncertainties emerge from time to time and it is not possible for us to predict all 
risk factors and uncertainties, nor can we assess the impact of all factors on our business or the extent to which any factor, or combination of factors, may 
cause actual results to differ materially from those contained in any forward-looking statements.

Given  these  risks  and  uncertainties,  readers  are  cautioned  not  to  place  undue  reliance  on  any  forward-looking  statements.  Forward-looking 
statements contained in this Annual Report speak only as of the date of this Annual Report. We undertake no obligation to update any forward-looking 
statements as a result of new information, events or circumstances or other factors arising or coming to our attention after the date hereof.

4

 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Item 1. Business

Overview

Globus Medical, Inc. (together, as applicable, with its consolidated subsidiaries, “Globus,” the “Company,” “we,” “us” or “our”), headquartered in 
Audubon, Pennsylvania, is a medical device company that develops and commercializes healthcare solutions whose mission is to improve the quality of 
life of patients with musculoskeletal disorders. Founded in 2003, Globus is committed to medical device innovation and delivering exceptional service to 
hospitals, ambulatory surgery centers and physicians to advance patient care and improve efficiency. Since inception, Globus has listened to the voice of 
the surgeon to develop practical solutions and products to help surgeons effectively treat patients and improve lives. 

Globus is an engineering-driven company with a history of rapidly developing and commercializing advanced products and procedures to address 
treatment  challenges.  With  over  10  product  launches  in  2023  and  operations  across  64  countries  worldwide,  we  offer  a  comprehensive  portfolio  of 
innovative and differentiated technologies that are used to treat a variety of musculoskeletal conditions. Although we manage our business globally within 
one reportable segment, we separate our products and services into two major categories: Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies.

NuVasive Merger

On September 1, 2023, pursuant to that certain merger agreement (the “Merger Agreement”) with NuVasive, Inc. (“NuVasive”) and Zebra Merger 
Sub Inc. (“Merger Sub”), Merger Sub, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, merged with and into NuVasive, with NuVasive surviving as a wholly 
owned subsidiary of the Company (the “Merger”). Under the Merger Agreement, each share of common stock, par value $0.001 per share, of NuVasive 
issued and outstanding immediately prior to the effective time of the Merger (other than certain excluded shares as described in the Merger Agreement) was 
cancelled and converted into the right to receive 0.75 fully paid and non-assessable shares of Class A common stock of Globus, $0.001 par value per share, 
and the right to receive cash in lieu of fractional shares.

Overall Business

Market

The  primary  market  for  our  products  is  the  United  States  (“U.S.”),  where  we  sell  our  products  through  a  combination  of  direct  sales 
representatives employed by us and sales representatives employed by our exclusive independent distributors, who distribute our products on our behalf for 
a commission that is generally based on a percentage of sales. We believe there is significant opportunity to strengthen our position in the U.S. market by 
increasing the size of our sales force and continuing to add direct and distributor sales representatives in the future.

During the year ended December 31, 2023, international sales accounted for approximately 18.4% of our total sales. Internationally, we sell our 
products  through  a  combination  of  direct  sales  representatives  employed  by  us  and  exclusive  international  distributors.  We  believe  there  are  significant 
opportunities for us to increase our presence in both existing and new international markets through the continued expansion of our direct and distributor 
sales forces as well as through the commercialization of additional products.

Strategy

Our  goal  is  to  become  the  market  leader  in  providing  innovative  solutions  to  promote  healing  in  patients  with  musculoskeletal  disorders.  To 

achieve this goal, we employ the following business strategies:

(cid:0) Leverage  our  integrated  product  development  engine.  We  plan  to  continue  developing  new  products,  using  the  capabilities  of  our  product 
development  engine.  We  believe  our  team-oriented  and  highly  integrated  development  approach,  active  surgeon  input,  and  demonstrated 
performance  position  us  to  maintain  a  rapid  rate  of  new  product  launches.  We  launched  10  new  products  in  2023,  in  addition  to  assuming 
NuVasive’s  portfolio  of  products,  which  include  the  X360  portfolio,  the  C360  portfolio  featuring  the  Simplify  Cervical  Disc,  and  the  P360 
portfolio. We have a range of new products in various stages of development and expect to continue to regularly launch new products.

(cid:0) Increase the size, scope and productivity of our exclusive U.S. sales force. We believe there is significant opportunity for us to further penetrate 
existing  markets,  and  to  enter  new  markets,  by  increasing  the  size  and  geographic  scope  of  our  exclusive  U.S.  sales  force  for  Musculoskeletal 
Solutions. Through the Merger with NuVasive, we have significantly grown our global sales force.  We expect to continue to increase the number 
of our direct and distributor sales representatives in the U.S., to expand into new geographic territories and to deepen our penetration in existing 
territories.  We  will  also  continue  to  provide  our  sales  representatives  with  specialized  development  programs  designed  to  improve  their 
productivity.

5

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

(cid:0) Continue to expand into international markets. As of December 31, 2023, we had an existing direct or distributor sales presence in 64 countries 
outside  the  U.S.  We  expect  to  continue  to  increase  our  international  presence  through  the  commercialization  of  additional  Musculoskeletal 
Solutions products in current markets and through the expansion of our international sales force in current and new markets.

(cid:0) Pursue strategic acquisitions.

 In 2017, we acquired KB Medical SA, developer of a computer-assisted robotic guidance system, and in 2018 we acquired Nemaris Inc., 
a company that markets and develops Surgimap®, a leading surgical planning software platform, to further bolster our efforts to advance surgical 
procedures  through  Enabling  Technologies.  In  2019,  we  acquired  substantially  all  of  the  assets  of  StelKast,  Inc.,  a  company  that  designs, 
manufactures  and  distributes  orthopedic  implants  for  knee  and  hip  replacement  surgeries.  During  the  second  quarter  of  2020,  the  Company 
acquired Synoste Oy, a Finnish engineering company that specializes in the research and development of a limb lengthening system. During the 
fourth  quarter  of  2021,  the  Company  acquired  Capstone  Surgical  Technologies,  LLC.,  a  company  that  engages  in  the  business  of  creating 
advanced  drill  and  robotic  surgery  platforms.    During  the  fourth  quarter  of  2022,  the  Company  acquired  the  membership  interests  of  Harvest 
Biologics LLC, which engages in the business of selling systems that produce autologous biologics.  

In 2023, we acquired NuVasive, a leader in spine technology innovation, with a mission to transform surgery, advance care, and change 
lives.  NuVasive’s  less-invasive,  procedurally  integrated  surgical  solutions  are  designed  to  deliver  reproducible  and  clinically  proven  outcomes. 
The  procedural  portfolio  includes  surgical  access  instruments,  spinal  implants,  fixation  systems,  biologics,  software  for  surgical  planning, 
navigation  and  imaging  solutions,  magnetically  adjustable  implant  systems  for  spine  and  orthopedics,  and  intraoperative  neuromonitoring 
(“IONM”) technology and service offerings. The Merger expanded our global commercial reach, increased operational capabilities and enhanced 
our comprehensive offerings of Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies. 

We  intend  to  selectively  pursue  acquisitions  and  alliances  that  complement  our  strategic  plan  and  provide  innovative  technologies, 
personnel  with  significant  relevant  experience,  or  increased  market  penetration.  We  regularly  evaluate  possible  acquisitions  and  strategic 
relationships and believe that our resources and experience make us an attractive acquirer or partner.

The Globus Solution 

We believe that our focus on actively listening and responding to the needs of our customers with high quality solutions separates us from our 
industry  peers.  Since  2003  we  have  introduced  many  products,  including  10  products  in  2023,  designed  for  the  treatment  of  musculoskeletal  disorders. 
Given our robust product portfolio of unique and differentiated products, as well as the numerous disruptive products in various stages of development, we 
believe we are well positioned for growth in the musculoskeletal markets we operate in. 

We  believe  that  our  innovative  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  products,  combined  with  our  ability  to  provide  world-class  service  through  a  highly 

trained and exclusive sales force and corporate account management, create significant value for our customers.

Product & Service Categories

While we group our products and services into two categories, Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies, they are not limited to a 
particular technology, platform or surgical approach. Instead, our goal is to offer a comprehensive product suite that can be used to safely and effectively 
treat patients based on their specific anatomy and condition, and is customized to the surgeon’s training and surgical preference.

Musculoskeletal Solutions

Our Musculoskeletal Solutions consist primarily of implantable devices, biologics, accessories, unique surgical instruments, and neuromonitoring 
services, used in an expansive range of spinal, orthopedic and neurosurgical procedures. Musculoskeletal disorders are a leading driver of healthcare costs 
worldwide.  Disorders  range  in  severity  from  mild  pain  and  loss  of  feeling  to  extreme  pain  and  paralysis.  These  disorders  are  primarily  caused  by 
degenerative  and  congenital  conditions,  deformity,  tumors  and  traumatic  injuries.  Treatment  alternatives  for  musculoskeletal  disorders  range  from  non-
operative conservative therapies to surgical interventions depending on the pathology. Conservative therapies include bed rest, medication, casting, bracing, 
and physical therapy. When conservative therapies are not indicated, or fail to provide adequate quality of life improvements, surgical interventions may be 
used. Surgical treatments for musculoskeletal disorders can be instrumented, which include the use of implants, or non-instrumented, which forego the use 
of hardware but may include biologics.

6

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Our broad spectrum of spine products addresses the vast majority of conditions affecting the spine including degenerative conditions, deformity, 
tumors, and trauma. With 20 years in this competitive market, we provide comprehensive solutions that facilitate both open and minimally invasive surgery 
(“MIS”)  techniques.  This  includes  traditional  fusion  implants  such  as  pedicle  screw  and  rod  systems,  plating  systems,  intervertebral  spacers  and 
corpectomy  devices.  We  believe  we  pioneered  innovative  expandable  solutions  for  interbody  fusion,  corpectomy  and  interspinous  fixation  that  allow 
intraoperative  customization  of  our  devices  to  the  patient’s  anatomy,  eliminating  sequential  trialing  and  potentially  saving  surgical  time.  We  have  also 
developed  treatment  options  for  motion  preservation  technologies,  such  as  dynamic  stabilization,  total  disc  replacement  and  interspinous  distraction 
devices; as well as interventional solutions to treat vertebral compression fractures. Our biologic solutions include regenerative biologic products such as 
allografts and synthetic alternatives that are adjunctive treatments typically used in combination with stabilizing implant hardware.

Our orthopedic trauma solutions are designed to treat a wide variety of orthopedic fracture patterns and patient anatomies in the upper and lower 
extremities  as  well  as  the  hip.  Our  orthopedic  trauma  and  extremity  products,  covering  four  major  segments  of  the  orthopedic  trauma  market:  fracture 
plates, compression screws, intramedullary nails, and external fixation. We began marketing these products in 2018 and intend to grow our presence in this 
field. Fracture plating includes proximal humerus, distal radius, proximal tibia, distal tibia, distal fibula, distal femur, small fragment, mini-fragment and 
clavicle plates. Intramedullary nailing includes tibial, trochanteric, and femoral nail systems. Regenerative biologic products such as bone void fillers and 
allograft struts are used in orthopedic procedures where applicable.

Our hip and knee joint solutions for the treatment of degenerative conditions or failed previous reconstruction have a long history of clinical use. 
Over  13  different  implants  have  been  marketed  to  date,  including  modular  hip  stems  and  acetabular  cups  for  total  hip  arthroplasty  as  well  as  posterior 
stabilizing and cruciate retaining knee arthroplasty implants. 

Our neuromonitoring services utilize proprietary software that employs hunting algorithms and graphical user interfaces to provide surgeons with 
an enhanced and intuitive nerve avoidance system. Through our IONM platforms, we give surgeons the option to connect their instruments to a computer 
system that provides discrete, real-time, surgeon-directed and surgeon-controlled feedback about the directionality and relative proximity of nerves during 
surgery.  We  believe  our  proprietary  IONM  platforms  are  a  differentiator  in  the  market  and  are  unique  in  their  ability  to  provide  information  about  the 
directionality and proximity of nerves. Our systems analyze and then translate complex neurophysiologic data into simple, useful information to assist the 
surgeon’s clinical decision-making process. Surgeons can connect certain instruments to our IONM systems, thus creating an interactive set of instruments 
that  better  enable  the  safe  navigation  through  the  body’s  nerve  anatomy  during  surgery.  We  provide  onsite  and  remote  monitoring  of  the  neurological 
systems  of  patients  undergoing  spinal  and  brain-related  surgeries.  Monitoring  the  health  of  the  nervous  system  during  spinal  surgery  has  been  a  key 
component of our strategy of product differentiation since early in our development.

Enabling Technologies

Our  Enabling  Technologies  are  comprised  of  imaging,  navigation  and  robotics  (“INR”)  solutions  for  assisted  surgery  which  are  advanced 
computer-assisted intelligent systems designed to enhance a surgeon’s capabilities, and ultimately improve patient care and reduce radiation exposure for 
all involved, by streamlining surgical procedures to be safer, less invasive, and more accurate. The market for our Enabling Technologies in spine, cranial 
and  orthopedic  surgery  is  still  in  the  infancy  stage  and  consists  primarily  of  imaging,  navigation  and  robotic  systems.  In  spine,  a  majority  of  these 
technologies are limited to surgical planning and assistance in implant placement for increased accuracy and time savings with less intraoperative radiation 
exposure to the patient and surgical staff. As our Enabling Technologies become more fully integrated with our Musculoskeletal Solutions, a continued rise 
in  adoption  is  expected.  Furthermore,  we  believe  as  new  technologies  such  as  augmented  reality  and  artificial  intelligence  are  introduced,  Enabling 
Technologies have the potential to transform the way surgery is performed and most importantly, continue to improve patient outcomes.

Our INR solutions include the ExcelsiusGPS® platform which is a robotic guidance and navigation system that supports minimally invasive and 
open procedures with screw and interbody spacer placement applications. The ExcelsiusGPS® platform has a modular design that we expect will serve as a 
foundation for future clinical applications using artificial intelligence and augmented reality. Also, in 2018, we acquired Nemaris Inc., the company that 
developed and marketed Surgimap®, a leading surgical planning software platform. Surgimap®’s  intuitive,  patient-specific  surgical  planning  and  cloud-
based  infrastructure  includes  predictive  algorithms  and  visual  guides  that  enable  healthcare  professionals  to  plan  and  simulate  surgical  treatment  of 
complex deformities. The software also enables medical professionals to share medical imaging technology globally to improve procedural workflow and 
patient  care.    In  2022,  we  launched  Excelsius3D™,  which  when  combined  with  the  ExcelsiusGPS®  robotic  navigation  system,  provides  a  superior 
intraoperative,  image-guided  robotic  navigation  solution  that  is  designed  to  improve  implant  placement  accuracy,  lower  radiation  exposure,  and  shorten 
operative times. This highly maneuverable and intuitive imaging platform offers 3 imaging modalities, position memory, and a large field of view.

Our innovative Enabling Technologies products offer surgeons more information about patient anatomy and surgical options to help them to make 
well-informed  preoperative  and  intraoperative  surgical  decisions.  We  believe  the  advantages  of  pre-planning  implant  position  and  viewing  implants  or 
instruments relative to patient anatomy during surgery are self-evident, and also create significant secondary gains such as eliminating radiation exposure 
altogether.

7

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Product Development and Research

We believe in bringing products to market quickly by reducing the time from product conception to launch. We believe our approach to product 
development is unique and highly efficient. We employ an integrated team approach to product development involving collaboration among surgeons, our 
engineers,  our  dedicated  researchers,  our  highly-skilled  machinists,  and  our  regulatory  personnel.  We  believe  that  this  team  approach,  as  well  as  our 
extensive in-house facilities, allows us to design, test and obtain regulatory clearance and approvals for our products more effectively. We also believe that 
our  product  development  engine  provides  us  with  a  competitive  advantage  in  developing  solutions  to  challenging  clinical  problems  for  surgeons  and 
improving outcome for patients.

Our product development efforts are supported by our in-house research capabilities. We believe that centralizing and consolidating the critical 
elements of the product development and commercialization process in one facility allows us to bring products from the concept stage to the market more 
rapidly.  Research  resources  available  in-house  include  a  mechanical  testing  laboratory,  spinal  kinematics  laboratory,  tribology  laboratory,  cadaveric 
laboratory, materials characterization laboratory, computational laboratory, and clinical and biomechanical research experts.

The markets in which we operate are subject to rapid technological advancements. We must constantly improve existing products and introduce 

new products in order to continue to succeed. Accordingly, we have made significant investments in our product development and research capabilities.

Sales and Marketing

We market and sell our products primarily through our exclusive global sales force. As of December 31, 2023, we had a direct or distributor sales 
presence in the U.S. and in 64 other countries. We have dedicated spinal implant, orthopedic trauma and Enabling Technologies sales teams in place. We 
sell our hip and knee products primarily through independent sales agents. We expect to continue to increase the number of our direct and distributor sales 
representatives  in  each  of  these  areas,  both  in  the  U.S.  and  internationally,  to  expand  into  new  geographic  territories  and  to  deepen  our  penetration  in 
existing territories. We believe the expansion of our U.S. and international sales forces provides us with significant opportunities for future growth as we 
continue to penetrate existing geographic markets and enter new ones.

Our  implant  sales  representatives  are  present  in  the  operating  room  during  most  surgeries  in  the  U.S.  and  in  many,  but  not  all,  of  the  other 
countries in which our products are sold. These representatives have the responsibility to confirm that all of the items needed in the surgery are available 
and are provided sterile or are capable of being sterilized at the hospital. An assortment of sizes and quantities of implants are made available to be able to 
satisfy varying surgical requirements and patient anatomy, along with numerous surgical instruments and cases needed to safely perform the surgery and 
implantation. As products are used in surgeries, replacement items are shipped to our sales representatives and hospitals to replenish their supply.

Surgeon Training and Education

We  devote  significant  resources  to  training  and  educating  surgeons  regarding  the  safety  and  reproducibility  of  our  surgical  techniques  and  our 
procedurally integrated solutions. Our surgeon education and training program integrates surgical training with professional development and enables us to 
introduce surgeons to our comprehensive portfolio and patented approaches to spine surgery. We offer educational and training courses globally through in-
person formats and via virtual content, including virtual conferences and video and social channels, to demonstrate the benefits of our innovative products 
and procedures.

Competition

We believe that our significant competitors are Medtronic, DePuy Synthes, Stryker, Zimmer Biomet, and Smith and Nephew. Alphatec Holdings, 
Orthofix, Integra LifeSciences, ZimVie and other smaller public and private companies are also competitors of ours. At any time, these or other market
participants may develop alternative treatments, products or procedures for the treatment of musculoskeletal disorders that compete directly or indirectly 
with our products. They may also develop and patent processes or products earlier than we can, or obtain regulatory clearance or approvals for competing 
products more rapidly than we can.

We compete in the marketplace to recruit and retain qualified scientific, management, and sales personnel, as well as in acquiring technologies and 

technology licenses complementary to our products or advantageous to our business.

Manufacturing and Supply

We  have  greatly  expanded  our  dedicated  in-house  manufacturing  capabilities.  Our  implant  products  are  manufactured  in  our  facilities  in 

Eagleville, Pennsylvania, Limerick, Pennsylvania and West Carrollton, Ohio. Most of our regenerative biologic products 

8

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
are  processed  in  our  facilities  in  San  Antonio,  Texas,  and  in  Audubon,  Pennsylvania.  The  ExcelsiusGPS®  robotic  guidance  and  navigation  system  and 
Excelsius3D™ imaging system are assembled in our facility in Methuen, Massachusetts.

Of our implant and instrument products that are not manufactured in-house, a majority are generally manufactured through a network of third-
party suppliers. Our suppliers use high precision, computer-aided manufacturing equipment to manufacture our products. We have focused on developing a 
strong supplier base as part of our manufacturing strategy. Our relationship with our suppliers enables significant interaction between our design engineers 
and project managers and the suppliers’ engineers and schedulers to work through issues arising during the entire product development cycle. The majority 
of our suppliers are domestic, which affords our engineers and other members of our product development team the opportunity to work closely with them 
to commercialize our products.

We select our suppliers carefully and generally use a small number of suppliers for each of our key products for added reliability. Our internal 
quality  assurance  group  evaluates  the  potential  vendor  through  a  formal  vendor  approval  process  before  we  enter  into  a  relationship  with  the  vendor. 
Suppliers  that  meet  our  internal  quality  assurance  standards  are  added  to  our  approved  supplier  list.  Supplier  performance  is  maintained  and  managed 
through a supplier qualification, performance management and corrective action program intended to ensure that all of our product requirements are met or 
exceeded. All of our suppliers that provide us with implants are ISO-13485 certified, meaning they meet the International Organization for Standardization 
(“ISO”)  requirements  for  the  manufacture  of  medical  devices.  Our  outsourcing  strategy  is  targeted  at  companies  that  meet  U.S.  Food  and  Drug 
Administration (“FDA”), ISO, and quality standards supported by internal policies and procedures. 

 We currently rely on several tissue banks as suppliers of allograft tissue implants, including for our Osteocel Plus and Osteocel Pro product lines. 
Like our relationships with our device manufacturing suppliers, we subject our tissue processing suppliers to the same quality criteria in terms of selection, 
qualification, and verification of processed tissue quality upon receipt of goods, as well as hold them accountable for compliance with FDA regulations, 
state requirements, and voluntary industry standards (such as those put forward by the American Association of Tissue Banks). We also work with a limited 
number  of  suppliers  for  certain  components  of  our  Enabling  Technologies  and  IONM  platforms  and  continue  to  develop  redundancies  for  critical 
components within those supply chains.   

Our quality assurance group conducts periodic audits to ensure continued compliance with our standards. Under our existing contracts with third-
party  manufacturers,  we  reserve  the  right  to  inspect  and  assure  conformance  of  each  product  and  product  component  to  our  specifications.  With  every 
shipment  of  inventory  that  we  receive,  our  suppliers  provide  a  certificate  of  compliance  with  our  quality  control  standards.  Our  receiving  group  also 
performs inspections, packaging and labeling at one of our facilities.

We,  and  our  third-party  manufacturers,  are  subject  to  the  quality  system  regulations  of  the  FDA,  state  regulations  (such  as  the  regulations 
promulgated by the California Department of Health Services), and regulations promulgated by foreign regulatory bodies (such as in the European Union). 
For tissue products, we are FDA registered and licensed in the States of California, Delaware, Florida, Illinois, Maryland, New York, and Oregon. For our 
device implants and instruments, we are FDA-registered, California-licensed, Conformité Européenne (“CE”)-marked and ISO-certified. CE, an acronym 
for “Conformité Européenne” or European Conformity, is the registration marking designating that a device can be commercially distributed throughout the 
European Union (“EU”). Our facilities and the facilities of our third-party manufacturers are subject to periodic announced and unannounced inspections 
by regulatory authorities, and may undergo compliance inspections conducted by the FDA, state, and/or international regulatory agencies for, among other 
things,  conformance  to  Quality  System  Regulations  and  Current  Good  Manufacturing  Practice  requirements  as  well  as  separate  foreign  or  international 
standards.

We  work  closely  with  our  suppliers  to  ensure  that  our  inventory  needs  are  met  while  maintaining  high  quality  and  reliability.  We  believe  our 
supplier relationships and facilities will support our capacity needs for the foreseeable future.  A majority of our product inventory is held primarily with 
our sales representatives and at hospitals throughout the U.S. We stock inventory in our warehouse facilities and retain title to consigned inventory which is 
maintained with our field representatives and hospitals in sufficient quantities so that products are available when needed for surgical procedures. Safety 
stock levels are determined based on a number of factors, including demand, manufacturing lead times, and quantities required to maintain service levels.

Surgical Instrument, Implant Sets and Equipment Sales

For many of our customers, we provide surgical instrumentation sets, including both implants and instruments, as well as our IONM systems in a 
manner tailored to fulfill our customer’s obligations to meet surgery schedules. We do not generally receive separate economic value specific to the surgical 
instrument sets from the surgeons or hospitals that utilize them. In many cases, once the surgery is finished, the surgical instrument sets are returned to us, 
and we prepare them for shipment to meet future surgeries.

We  complement  this  implant  and  instrument  shipment  model  with  field-based  instrument  assets.  This  hybrid  strategy  is  designed  to  improve 
customer  service,  minimize  backlogs,  increase  asset  turns,  optimize  freight  costs,  and  maximize  cash  flow.  Our  pool  of  surgical  equipment  we  make 
available to hospitals continues to increase as we increase our product offering, expand our distribution 

9

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
channels and increase the market penetration of our products. These surgical instrumentation and implant sets are important to the growth of our business, 
and we anticipate additional investments in such assets going forward.

In certain cases, we will sell either surgical instruments, implant sets or both to our customers. While this does not constitute a material component of 
our business, as customer penetration and volume increases, these sales of sets allow our customers to increase the amount of surgical volume performed 
locally. Additionally, we offer flexibility to customers for our capital equipment by offering capital sales and leasing arrangements. We do not have a long 
history of selling, leasing or servicing capital equipment, but we have invested and intend to continue to invest in building resources and expertise in this 
area. Selling and leasing of capital equipment do not make up a material portion of our total net sales.

Intellectual Property

We  protect  our  proprietary  rights  through  a  variety  of  methods.  In  particular,  we  rely  on  patent,  trademark,  copyright,  trade  secret  and  other 

intellectual property laws and also utilize nondisclosure agreements and other measures to protect our rights.

We  require  our  employees,  consultants  and  advisors  to  execute  confidentiality  agreements  in  connection  with  their  employment,  consulting  or 
advisory relationships with us. We also require our employees, consultants and advisors who we expect to work on our products to agree to disclose and 
assign  to  us  all  inventions  conceived  using  our  property  or  which  relate  to  our  business.  Despite  measures  taken  to  protect  our  intellectual  property, 
unauthorized parties may attempt to copy aspects of our products or to obtain and use information that we regard as proprietary.

As of December 31, 2023, we owned 2,583 issued U.S. patents (2,547 utility patents; 36 design patents) and had applications pending for 867 U.S. 
patents (866 utility patents; 1 design patents), and we owned 1,744 issued foreign patents and had applications pending for 502 foreign patents. Our issued 
patents expired or will expire between March 2015 and November 2043.

Our trademark portfolio contains 732 registered trademarks and 196 pending trademarks. Our portfolio includes domestic and foreign trademarks 

with associated logos and tag lines.

Third-Party Coverage and Reimbursement

We  expect  that  sales  volumes  and  prices  of  our  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  products  including  spinal  implant,  orthopedic  trauma,  hip  and  knee 
arthroplasty, regenerative biologics, advanced technology products and IONM services may grow to be more dependent on the availability of coverage and 
reimbursement from third-party payors, such as state and federal programs including Medicare, Medicaid and workers’ compensation as well as private 
insurance plans including Blue Cross Blue Shield plans and commercial insurers. Reimbursement is dynamic and is contingent on coding for given services 
or procedures, coverage by third-party payors, and adequate payment for the services or procedures.

Physicians,  hospital  outpatient  departments,  and  ambulatory  surgery  centers  use  Current  Procedural  Terminology  (“CPT®”)  codes  to  bill  for 
services  and  procedures  which  are  established  by  the  American  Medical  Association  (“AMA”).  Specialty  societies  such  as  the  North  American  Spine 
Society (“NASS”), the American Association of Neurological Surgeons, and the American Academy of Orthopedic Surgeons provide advice to the AMA 
CPT® Editorial Panel for developing codes. The availability of existing codes to bill for services and procedures may impact the adoption of technology. 
The CPT codes, depending on the situation and payor rules, are sometimes billed with billing modifiers that can affect coverage and reimbursement. 

The  Centers  for  Medicare  and  Medicaid  Services  (“CMS”)  and  the  National  Center  for  Health  Statistics  are  jointly  responsible  for  overseeing 
changes  and  modifications  to  International  Classification  of  Diseases,  Clinical  Modification/Procedure  Coding  System  (“ICD-10-CM/PCS”)  procedure 
codes  used  by  all  providers  including  physicians  and  facilities  for  reporting  patient  diagnosis(es)  (“ICD-10-CM  codes”)  and  hospitals  for  reporting 
inpatient  procedures  (“ICD-10-PCS  codes”).  The  granularity  and  specificity  of  the  ICD-10-CM/PCS  coding  system  may  impact  reimbursement  in  the 
future, particularly hospital inpatient reimbursement. Physician and hospital coding is subject to change, which could impact coverage and reimbursement 
and thus potentially impact physician practice behavior.

Independent of coding status, third-party payors may deny coverage based on their own criteria. Payor medical policies vary from payor to payor 
and  contract  to  contract.  There  are  thousands  of  payor  medical  policies  which  are  continually  reviewed  and  revised  at  the  discretion  of  payors.  Payor 
medical policies may become more restrictive. Payors may deem the clinical efficacy of a device or procedure to be experimental or investigational, not the 
most  cost-effective  treatment  available,  or  used  for  an  unapproved  indication.  Additionally,  many  private  payors  use  coverage  decisions  and  payment 
amounts established by CMS for the Medicare program as guidelines in setting their coverage and reimbursement policies. 

Medicare may establish National Coverage Determinations or Medicare Administrative Contractors may establish Local Coverage Determinations 
that provide coverage information and determine whether services are reasonable and necessary. As the portion of the U.S. population over the age of 65 
and eligible for Medicare continues to grow, we may be more vulnerable to coverage 

10

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
and reimbursement limitations imposed by CMS. National and local coverage policy decisions are subject to unforeseeable change and have the potential to 
impact physician behavior. We will continue to provide the appropriate and compliant resources to patients, physicians, hospitals, and insurers in order to 
promote the best patient care, provide clarity regarding coverage and reimbursement policies, and work to reverse any non-coverage policies.

However, certain third party payors, large and small, may have policies significantly limiting coverage of, products or services that we offer. We 
will continue to provide resources to patients, surgeons, hospitals, and insurers in order to ensure optimum patient care and clarity regarding reimbursement 
and work to remove any and all non-coverage policies. National and regional coverage policy decisions are subject to unforeseeable change and have the 
potential  to  impact  physician  behavior  and  reimbursement  for  physician  services.  We  cannot  offer  definitive  timeframes  or  final  outcomes  regarding 
reversal of the coverage-limiting policies, as the process is dictated by the third-party payors. For a discussion of these risks, please see the “Risk Factors” 
section of this Annual Report.

Payment  amounts  are  established  by  government  and  private  payor  programs  and  are  subject  to  fluctuations,  which  could  impact  physician 

practice behavior. Third-party payors are increasingly challenging the prices charged for a wide range of medical products and services. 

For  federal/state  programs,  such  as  Medicaid,  coverage  and  reimbursement  differ  from  state  to  state.  Some  state  Medicaid  programs  may  not 
reimburse  an  adequate  amount  for  the  procedures  performed  with  our  products,  if  any  payment  is  made  at  all.  In  addition,  state-level  workers’ 
compensation coverage and reimbursement vary from state to state. Payment by Medicare and other third-party payors may not be adequate to cover the 
cost of medical devices used in musculoskeletal procedures. Additionally, more musculoskeletal procedures are being performed in the hospital outpatient 
and ambulatory surgery center settings, in part due to innovation. Reimbursement levels in the hospital outpatient and ambulatory surgery center settings 
are typically lower than for the hospital inpatient setting and may not be adequate to cover the cost of innovative and novel medical devices.

In international markets, reimbursement and healthcare payment systems vary significantly by country and some countries have instituted price 
ceilings on specific product lines. There can be no assurance that our products will be accepted by third-party payors, that coverage and reimbursement will 
be  available  or,  if  available,  that  the  third-party  payors’  coverage  and  reimbursement  policies  will  not  adversely  affect  our  ability  to  sell  our  products 
profitably.

In the U.S., as a result of healthcare reform, third-party payors are increasingly required to demonstrate they can improve quality and reduce costs; 
we  accordingly  see  an  increase  in  pre-approval/prior  authorizations  and  non-coverage  policies  citing  higher  levels  of  evidence  required  for  medical 
therapies and technologies. In addition, insured individuals are facing increased premiums and higher out–of-pocket costs for medical coverage, which may 
lead patients to delay medical treatment. An increasing number of insured individuals receive their medical care through managed care programs, which 
monitor and often require pre-approval of the services that a member will receive. The percentage of individuals covered by managed care programs is 
expected to grow in the U.S. over the next decade.

We believe that the overall escalating cost of medical products and services has led to, and will continue to lead to, increased pressures on the 
healthcare industry to reduce the costs of products and services. There can be no assurance that third-party coverage and reimbursement will be available or 
adequate, or that future legislation, regulation, coding or coverage and reimbursement policies of third-party payors will not adversely affect the demand 
for our products or our ability to sell these products on a profitable basis.

Government Regulation

Our business is subject to extensive federal, state, local and foreign laws and regulations. These laws and regulations and their interpretations are 
subject to change. Our products are medical devices and human tissue products subject to extensive regulation by the FDA and other regulatory bodies both 
inside and outside of the U.S. Each of these agencies requires us to comply with laws and regulations governing the development, testing, manufacturing, 
storage, labeling, marketing, sales and distribution of our products.

Both federal and state governmental agencies continue to subject the healthcare industry to intense regulatory scrutiny, including heightened civil 
and  criminal  enforcement  efforts.  We  believe  that  we  have  structured  our  business  operations  and  relationships  with  our  customers  to  comply  with  all 
applicable legal requirements. However, it is possible that governmental entities or other third parties, including Relators (whistleblowers) who  can  file 
complaints on behalf of the government and on their own behalf under the federal False Claims Act (“FCA”), could interpret these laws and our efforts to 
comply with them differently and assert otherwise. We discuss below the statutes and regulations that are most relevant to our business.

11

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

U.S. Food and Drug Administration Regulation

Our  products  meet  the  FDA’s  definition  of  medical  devices  (per  Section  201(h)(1)  of  the  Food,  Drug,  and  Cosmetic  Act)  and  human  tissue 
products  (under  21  CFR  Parts  1270  and  1271  or  Public  Health  Service  Act  Section  361),  each  subject  to  varying  regulation(s)  by  the  FDA  and  other 
federal, state, local and foreign regulatory bodies. FDA regulations govern, among other things, the following activities that we or our partners perform and 
will continue to perform:

(cid:0) product design and development;
(cid:0) product testing, manufacturing and safety;
(cid:0) post-market surveillance and reporting;
(cid:0) product-labeling;
(cid:0) complaint-handling;
(cid:0) post-market approval studies;
(cid:0) controls for electronic and other radiation emitting products; and
(cid:0) product advertising, marketing and promotion.

FDA Premarket Clearance and Approval Requirements for Medical Devices

Unless an exemption applies (as is usually the case with instruments not intended for implantation), each medical device we wish to introduce 
within interstate commerce in the U.S. requires pre-authorization by the FDA either via 510(k) clearance, premarket approval (“PMA”), grant of a de novo 
classification request grant or, in less frequent occasions, via Humanitarian Device Exemption (“HDE”) approval. The FDA classifies medical devices into 
three classes and devices deemed to pose low or moderate risk are placed in either Class I or II. Unless determined as exempt from premarket notification, 
Class I and II devices generally require the manufacturer to submit to the FDA a premarket notification seeking permission for commercial distribution, 
and detailing substantial equivalence to another legally U.S. marketed medical device. This process is known as 510(k) review and if successfully resolved 
results in issuance of a 510(k) clearance by the FDA. The FDA has identified low risk devices which are exempt from this pre-authorization requirement 
but are not exempt from Design Controls (compliance to which must be documented internally). Devices deemed by the FDA to pose the greatest risk to 
patients,  such  as  life-sustaining,  life-supporting  or  implantable  devices,  and  devices  deemed  not  substantially  equivalent  to  a  previously  cleared  510(k) 
devices  are  designated  as  Class  III,  which  typically  requires  approval  of  a  PMA  application.  For  novel/unclassified  devices  not  previously  formally 
classified by the FDA with no legally marketed predicate which present low to moderate risk, a risk-based classification determination can be requested in 
accordance with the de novo classification request process, under which the FDA may determine that the product can be appropriately regulated as a Class I 
or  II  device  and  “granted”  authorization  for  commercialization  within  the  U.S.  For  novel/unclassified  devices  not  previously  formally  classified  by  the 
FDA with no legally marketed predicate intended to treat or diagnose a disease or condition that affects fewer than 8,000 individuals per year in the U.S., 
the FDA requires adherence to the HDE program. This requires a Humanitarian Use Designation (“HUD”); if the FDA approves the HUD, manufacturers 
should then seek FDA approval on an Investigational Device Exemption (“IDE”) to collect the necessary human clinical data to support approval of the 
HDE application.

510(k)  premarket  notifications,  de novo  requests,  and  PMAs  are  subject  to  the  payment  of  user  fees,  paid  at  the  time  of  submission  for  FDA 
review. The FDA can also impose restrictions on the sale, distribution or use of devices at the time of their clearance, approval or grant, or subsequent to 
marketing. IDEs, PMAs and HDEs most often have post-approval obligations to the FDA and to participating clinical sites, including but not limited to: 
continued  follow-up  of  enrolled  /  implanted  investigational  patients,  periodic  annual  clinical  reporting,  site  monitoring  and  oversight  of  on-going 
Institutional Review Board compliance.

Since  the  Institute  of  Medicine  published  their  review  of  the  predicated  510(k)  review  process  in  2010,  the  FDA  has  continually  worked  to 
strengthen and modernize the 510(k) Program. The FDA continues to improve the program through policies which clarify the FDA’s expectations for the 
content of filings, establishment of alternative pathways to a Traditional 510(k) (known as the Safety and Performance Based pathway), and through the 
issuance of numerous draft guidance. This evolution has impacted the ability of medical device manufacturers to obtain or maintain 510(k) clearance for 
devices  by  both  driving  clarity  and  incentivizing  the  development  of  safer,  more  effective  devices.  Manufacturers  must  continue  to  demonstrate  their 
product’s same / superior performance to existing devices more readily & extensively. Among other initiatives, the FDA promotes the use of a best-practice 
approach  as  it  relates  to  predicate  devices  with  a  long-established  history  of  safe  and  effective  use  as  opposed  to  simply  accepting  reliance  on  older 
predicate  devices  for  purposes  of  comparison  in  new  device  510(k)  clearance  submissions.  If  a  manufacturer  cannot  establish  that  a  new  or  modified
product is substantially equivalent to a predicate device, it may be required to seek premarket approval through the PMA or de novo process (the latter only 
for new products). There are numerous increased burdens associated with the PMA process, which typically requires conduct and submission of human 
clinical trials with high costs and uncertain outcomes.

12

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

FDA Postmarket Requirements

Pursuant to FDA regulations, we can only market our medical devices for cleared, approved, or granted uses. Although surgeons are permitted to 
use  medical  devices  for  indications  other  than  those  cleared,  approved  or  granted  by  the  FDA  based  on  their  medical  judgment,  manufacturers  are 
prohibited from marketing or promoting products for uses which differ from those deemed acceptable through respective 510(k) clearance, de novo grants, 
or PMA/HDE approvals. Use of our medical devices in a manner different or inconsistent than those detailed within our labeling is considered an “off-
label” use.

After  a  medical  device  is  placed  in  the  U.S.  market,  numerous  regulatory  requirements  continue  to  apply.  These  regulatory  requirements  could 

include, but are not limited to:

(cid:0) device listing and establishment registration;
(cid:0) adherence to the Quality System Regulation (per 21 CFR Part 820) (“QSR”) and the newly published Quality Management System Regulation 

(effective February 2, 2026) which requires stringent design, testing, control, documentation and other quality assurance procedures;

(cid:0) labeling requirements and FDA prohibitions against the promotion of off-label uses or indications;
(cid:0) adverse event reporting (Manufacturer and User Facility Device Experience);
(cid:0) post-approval restrictions or conditions, which could include post-approval clinical trials or other required testing and periodic reporting;
(cid:0) post-market surveillance requirements;
(cid:0) the FDA’s recall authority, whereby it can ask for, or require, the recall of products from the market (see FDA Enforcement section below); and
(cid:0) requirements relating to voluntary corrections or removals.

Failure  to  comply  with  applicable  regulatory  requirements  can  result  in  fines  and  other  enforcement  actions  by  the  FDA,  which  could  adversely 

impact our business.

Human Cell, Tissue and Cellular and Tissue-Based Products

We currently distribute a number of products processed from human tissue, some of which are manufactured by third-party suppliers. The FDA 
regulates human tissue products as Human Cells and Cellular and Tissue-Based Products (“HCT/Ps”). Certain HCT/Ps are regulated solely under Section 
361 of the Public Health Service Act and are referred to as “Section 361 HCT/Ps,” while other HCT/Ps are subject to the FDA’s regulatory requirements for 
medical  devices  or  biologics  under  21  CFR  Parts  1270  and  1271.  Section  361  HCT/Ps  do  not  require  premarket  authorization  (510(k)  clearance,  PMA 
approval,  or  other  pre-market  approvals)  from  the  FDA  before  marketing.  Tissue  banks  that  handle  HCT/Ps  must  register  their  establishments  with  the 
FDA,  list  their  HCT/P  products  with  the  FDA,  and  comply  with  FDA  donor  eligibility  and  screening  requirements,  current  Good  Tissue  Practice 
(“CGTP”), Cellular- and Tissue-Based Product Establishments, product labeling, and postmarket reporting requirements for HCT/Ps.

 The FDA and other state and regional agencies periodically inspect tissue processors to determine compliance with these requirements. Entities 
that provide us with allograft bone tissue are responsible for performing donor recovery, donor screening and donor testing and our compliance with those 
aspects of the CGTP regulations that regulate those functions are dependent upon the actions of these independent entities.

The  procurement  and  transplantation  of  allograft  bone  tissue  is  subject  to  U.S.  federal  law  pursuant  to  the  National  Organ  Transplant  Act 
(“NOTA”), a criminal statute which prohibits the purchase and sale of human organs used in human transplantation, including bone and related tissue, for 
“valuable  consideration.”  NOTA  permits  reasonable  payments  associated  with  the  removal,  transportation,  processing,  preservation,  quality  control, 
implantation and storage of human bone tissue. With the exception of removal and implantation, we provide services in all of these areas.

The procurement of human tissue is also subject to state anatomical gift acts and some states have statutes similar to NOTA. In addition, some 

states require that tissue processors be licensed by that state.

FDA Enforcement

The FDA enforces these requirements (for both medical device and human tissue products) by inspection and routine market surveillance. Failure 

to comply with applicable regulatory requirements can result in enforcement action by the FDA, which may include any of the following sanctions:

(cid:0) untitled letters or formal warning letters;

(cid:0) fines, injunctions and civil penalties;

(cid:0) recall or seizure of our products;

13

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

(cid:0) operating restrictions, partial suspension or total shutdown of production;

(cid:0) refusing our request for review of 510(k), de novo, or PMA of new products;

(cid:0) withdrawal of 510(k) clearance(s), de novo grant(s), or PMA approval(s) that are already issued; 

(cid:0) refusal to grant export approval of our products; and

(cid:0) criminal prosecution.

Failure  to  comply  with  applicable  regulatory  requirements  can  result  in  fines  and  other  enforcement  actions  by  the  FDA,  which  could  adversely 

impact our business.

We  are  subject  to  both  announced  and  unannounced  inspections  (device  and  tissue)  by  the  FDA’s  Office  of  Regulatory  Affairs,  Office  of 
Compliance, Center for Devices and Radiological Health, Center for Biologics Evaluation and Research, and American Association of Tissue Banks, as 
well  as  other  regulatory  agencies  overseeing  the  implementation  and  adherence  of  applicable  state  and  federal  tissue  licensing  regulations.  These 
inspections may include our manufacturing, suppliers’ and sub-contractors’ facilities.

On October 31, 2018, we received a warning letter from the FDA resulting from an inspection of the facilities of our subsidiary Human Biologics 
of Texas, located in San Antonio, Texas, in April 2018. The letter described observed non-conformities to regulations for human cells, tissues, and cellular 
and  tissue-based  products  relating  to  one  allograft  tissue  product  processed  by  Human  Biologics  of  Texas  and  sold  to  end  users.    We  took  the  matters 
identified  in  the  warning  letter  seriously  and  worked  diligently  to  address  the  FDA’s  observations.    We  responded  to  the  FDA’s  warning  letter  on 
November 20, 2018, provided periodic updates to the FDA on our progress, and notified the FDA of actions completed to resolve the observations.  As of 
December 31, 2023, this warning letter has been resolved.

State-Level Requirements

While the FDA regulates the inter-state distribution and commerce of medical devices and tissue products within the U.S. (as outlined above), 
there  are  a  number  of  states  with  specific  regional  registration  requirements.  We  are  obligated  to  comply  with  state-level  requirements  and  register 
ourselves as a medical device wholesaler and human tissue processor.  States with such registration requirements include but are not limited to: Illinois, 
Connecticut, Oregon, Delaware, California, Louisiana, and Pennsylvania. These state-level agencies have varying requirements which may require annual 
obligations and can result in periodic inspection by respective Health Departments. 

International

International sales of medical devices are subject to foreign government regulations, which vary substantially from country to country. In order to 
market  our  products  in  other  countries,  we  must  obtain  regulatory  approvals  and  comply  with  extensive  country-specific  device  safety  and  quality 
regulations. The time required to obtain approval by a foreign country may be longer or shorter than that required for FDA clearance, approval or grant, and 
the requirements may differ. The EU/European Economic Area (“EEA”) requires a CE mark in order to place medical devices “in market”. Many other 
countries, such as Australia, India, New Zealand, Pakistan and Sri Lanka, accept CE or FDA authorizations (clearance, approval or grant). Other countries, 
such as Brazil, Canada, Switzerland and Japan, require separate region-specific regulatory filings.

In  the  EEA,  our  devices  are  required  to  comply  with  the  essential  requirements  of  the  EU  Medical  Device  Directive  (Council  Directive 
93/42/EEC) (“MDD”). Compliance with these requirements entitles us to affix the CE conformity mark to our medical devices, without which medical 
devices cannot be commercialized in the EEA. To demonstrate compliance with the essential requirements and obtain the right to affix the CE conformity 
mark  we  must  undergo  a  conformity  assessment  procedure,  which  varies  according  to  the  type  of  medical  device  and  its  classification.  The  method  of 
assessing conformity varies depending on the classification of the product, but typically involves a combination of self-assessment by the manufacturer and 
a  third-party  assessment  by  an  accredited  “Notified  Body”.  This  third-party  assessment  consists  of  an  audit  of  the  manufacturer’s  quality  system  and 
technical review of the manufacturer’s product. 

The EU has also adopted the EU Medical Device Regulation (“MDR”), which replaced existing directives and imposes stricter requirements for 
the  marketing  and  sale  of  medical  devices,  including  new  clinical  evaluation,  quality  system,  and  post-market  surveillance  requirements.  Following the 
expiration  of  the  transitional  provisions  of  the  MDD  relating  to  the  CE  mark  (extended  to  December  2027),  all  medical  device  companies  intending  to 
manufacture  and/or  market  products  in  the  EEA  after  May  2024,  including  Globus  Medical,  NuVasive  and  NuVasive  Specialized  Orthopedics),  will  be 
required  to  comply  with  requirements  of  the  MDR  EU  2017/745,  which  increased  technical  documentation  requirements,  imparted  more  labeling 
obligations of higher risk devices, and altered the classification of some of our products. Most devices that are CE-marked under the MDD may continue to 
be marketed in the EU under certain conditions until December 2027 for Class III and IIb devices; 2028 for Class II and class I devices which require 
involvement  of  a  Notified  Body  in  the  conformity  assessment,  at  which  time  these  products  must  comply  with  the  new  regulation.    MDD  compliant 
products intended to be placed on the market after May 2024 must meet certain conditions and be under contract with an MDR accredited Notified Body 
and in compliance with Transitional Provisions. 

14

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Additionally, in the EEA the procurement, testing, processing, preservation, storage and distribution of human tissues and cells is subject to the 

requirements of the laws of individual EEA Member States implementing Directive 2004/23/EC, Directive 2006/17/EC and Directive 2006/86/EC.

Further,  the  advertising  and  promotion  of  our  products  in  the  EEA  is  subject  to  limited  provisions  under  Regulation  2017/745  and  the  laws  of 
individual EEA Member States implementing Directive 2006/114/EC concerning misleading and comparative advertising, and Directive 2005/29/EC on 
unfair commercial practices, as well as other EEA Member State laws and industry codes governing the advertising and promotion of medical devices. 
These  laws  and  codes  may  limit  or  restrict  the  advertising  and  promotion  of  our  products  to  the  general  public  and  may  impose  limitations  on  our 
promotional activities with healthcare professionals.  

In addition to the presiding MDD (93/42/EEC; MDD) and MDR (2017/745; MDR) outlined above, we must also comply with EU / EEA laws, 
directives, regulations and recognized standards as applicable to the devices we produce. These requirements can include all facets of healthcare, including 
environmental compliance, product stewardship, technical considerations, material of manufacture, and labeling availability. Below is a non-exhaustive list 
of requirements to apply to devices within our portfolio and to which we must demonstrate some degree of compliance:  

(cid:0) Regulation  (EC)  No  1907/2006  of  the  European  Parliament  and  of  the  Council  of  18  December  2006  concerning  the  Registration,  Evaluation, 

Authorization and Restriction of Chemicals;

(cid:0) Directive 2011/65/EU of the European Parliament and of the Council of 8 June 2011 on the restriction of the use of certain hazardous substances 

in electrical and electronic equipment (recast);

(cid:0) Directive 2012/19/EU of the European Parliament and of the Council of 4 July 2012 on waste electrical and electronic equipment;
(cid:0) Commission Implementing Regulation (EU) 2021/2226 of 14 December 2021 laying down rules for the application of Regulation (EU) 2017/745 

of the European Parliament and of the Council as regards electronic instructions for use of medical devices;

(cid:0) Directive (EU) 2023/2413 of the European Parliament and of the Council of 18 October 2023 amending Directive (EU) 2018/2001, Regulation 
(EU)  2018/1999  and  Directive  98/70/EC  as  regards  the  promotion  of  energy  from  renewable  sources,  and  repealing  Council  Directive  (EU) 
2015/652;

(cid:0) Directive 2014/30/EU of the European Parliament and the Council of 26 February 2014 on the harmonization of the laws of the Member States 

relating to electromagnetic compatibility;

(cid:0) Directive 2006/66/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council of 6 September 2006 on batteries and accumulators and waste batteries and 

accumulators and repealing Directive 91/157/EEC; and

(cid:0) Directive 94/62/EC of 20 December 1994 on packaging and packaging waste.

In addition to compliance with EU & EEA statutes, we must also comply with national laws of individual sovereign nations (i.e. Member States). 
These laws vary and can include additional registration efforts to be completed before CE -marked product can be distributed within respective Member 
States. 

Following a national referendum and enactment of legislation by the government of the United Kingdom (“UK”), the UK formally withdrew from 
the  EU  and  ratified  a  trade  and  cooperation  agreement  governing  its  future  relationship  with  the  EU.  The  agreement  addresses  trade,  economic 
arrangements,  law  enforcement,  judicial  cooperation,  and  a  governance  framework,  including  procedures  for  dispute  resolution,  among  other  things. 
Because the agreement merely sets forth a framework in many respects and will require complex additional bilateral negotiations between the UK and the 
EU, significant political and economic uncertainty remains about how the precise terms of the relationship between the parties will differ from the terms 
before withdrawal. Further, pursuant to guidance issued by the UK Government, the Medicines and Healthcare products Regulatory Agency (“MHRA”) 
became the standalone medicines and medical devices regulator for the UK as of January 1, 2021. A new mark, UK Conformity Assessed (“UKCA”), has 
also been introduced and will replace the CE conformity mark in the UK. UK-approved Notified Bodies designated by the MHRA will conduct conformity 
assessments  against  applicable  requirements  of  the  UKCA  mark.  Obtaining  the  UKCA  conformity  mark  is  optional  from  January  2021  and  will  have 
rolling  requirements  for  MDD/MDR  certified  devices  through  2027.  Although  CE  conformity  marking  and  certificates  issued  by  Notified  Bodies  will 
continue to be recognized in the UK through 2027, all medical devices were required to be registered with the MHRA as of January 1, 2021 in accordance 
with the provided grace period depending on the product risk classification. This grace period has been extended, and the UK Parliament intends to bring 
forward  an  additional  statutory  instrument  to  legislate  for  further  measures  in  Spring  2024.  Additionally,  for  manufacturers  based  outside  of  the  UK,  a 
single UK Responsible Person with a place of business in the UK must be established. Complying with this new regulatory framework will require us to 
invest in additional resources and could be expensive, time-consuming and disruptive to our existing operations in the UK.

In 2014, the Japanese government revised the Pharmaceutical Affairs Law, now the Pharmaceutical and Medical Device Act (“PMD Act”), which 
made significant changes to the pre-approval regulatory systems. These changes have, in part, stipulated that, in addition to obtaining a manufacturing or 
import  approval  from  the  Ministry  of  Health,  Labor  and  Welfare,  certain  low-risk  medical  devices  can  now  be  evaluated  by  third-party  organizations. 
Based on the risk-based classification, manufacturers are provided three 

15

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
procedures  for  satisfying  the  PMD  Act  requirements  prior  to  placing  products  on  the  market:  Premarket  Submission,  Premarket  Certification,  and 
Premarket Approval. Devices marketed in Japan must comply with the PMD Act, MO169, 2021 and are assessed by both government entities and third-
party organizations using all three procedures in place for manufacturers. The level of review and timeline for medical device approval depends on the risk-
based  classification  and  subsequent  regulatory  procedure  that  the  medical  device  is  aligned  based  on  assessment  against  the  current  PMD  Act. 
Manufacturers  must  also  obtain  a  manufacturing  or  import  license  from  the  prefectural  government  prior  to  importing  medical  devices;  manufacturers 
should also expect an inspection by the government agency. We also pursue authorizations required by the prefectural government as required.

Device and tissue pre-market approval, registration. and facility licensing requirements also exist in other markets where international facilities are 
established and where we may conduct business, including, but not limited to, Southeast Asia, Australia, and Latin America. Such requirements vary by 
country and Globus Medical & all its subsidiaries have established procedures to drive its compliance with these requirements.

Data  protection  laws,  including  the  EU  General  Data  Protection  Regulation  (“GDPR”),  also  apply  to  our  international  operations.  The  GDPR 
requires,  among  other  things,  obligations  and  restrictions  on  the  ability  to  collect,  analyze  and  transfer  EU  personal  data  and  the  prompt  notice  of  data 
breaches to data subjects and supervisory authorities in certain circumstances. These data protection regulations create a range of compliance obligations 
and authorize substantial fines for non-compliance.

We are subject to announced and unannounced device inspections by Notified Bodies (an organization accredited by a Member State of the EEA 
to conduct conformity assessments), as well as other regulatory agencies overseeing the implementation and adherence of applicable regulations. These 
inspections may include our suppliers’ facilities.

Sales and Marketing Commercial Compliance 

Federal anti-kickback laws and regulations prohibit, among other things, persons from knowingly and willfully soliciting, receiving, offering or 
paying  remuneration,  directly  or  indirectly,  in  exchange  for,  to  induce  or  to  reward  either  the  referral  of  an  individual,  or  the  purchase,  order  or 
recommendation  of,  any  good  or  service  paid  for  under  federal  healthcare  programs  such  as  the  Medicare  and  Medicaid  programs.    The  term 
“remuneration” has been interpreted broadly to include anything of value.  State anti-kickback laws have similar prohibitions.

Federal false claims laws prohibit any person from knowingly presenting, or causing to be presented, a false or fraudulent claim for payment to the 
federal government; knowingly making, or causing to be made, a false statement to get a false claim paid; or knowingly avoiding, decreasing or concealing 
an obligation to pay money to the federal government. Violations of the federal Anti-Kickback Statute and off-label promotion have been pursued by the 
Department of Justice (“DOJ”) and the Department of Health and Human Services (“HHS”) as violations of the federal civil False Claims Act (“FCA”).  
Intent to deceive is not required to establish liability under the civil False Claims Act.  Rather, a claim may be false for deliberate ignorance of the truth or 
falsity of the information provided or for acts in reckless disregard of the truth or falsity of that information.  Lawsuits under the FCA often are initiated by 
Relators  on  behalf  of  the  government.    Relators  are  incentivized  to  pursue  claims  against  manufacturers  and  providers  by  the  potential  to  share  in  any 
monetary recoveries by the government in litigation or as part of a settlement, which can be significant.  In addition, private payers have been filing follow-
on lawsuits alleging fraudulent misrepresentation, although establishing liability and damages in these cases is more difficult than under the FCA.

Pursuant to FDA regulations, we can only market our products for cleared or approved uses.  Although surgeons are permitted to use medical 
devices for indications other than those cleared or approved by the FDA based on their medical judgment, we are prohibited from promoting products for 
such off-label uses.  Legislation periodically is introduced in the United States Congress that would broaden the applicability of the FCA and implement 
other changes that would not be favorable to defendants in FCA cases.  If enacted, such legislation could apply to any case filed under the FCA on or after 
the date of enactment.  Additionally, the majority of states in which we market our products have similar anti-kickback, false claims, anti-fee splitting and 
physician self-referral laws, which may apply to items or services reimbursed by any third-party payor, including commercial insurers, and violations may 
result in substantial civil and criminal sanctions. 

Other federal statutes pertaining to healthcare fraud and abuse include the civil monetary penalties statute, which prohibits, among other things, the 
offer  or  payment  of  remuneration  to  a  Medicaid  or  Medicare  beneficiary  that  the  offeror  or  payor  knows  or  should  know  is  likely  to  influence  the 
beneficiary to order a receive a reimbursable item or service from a particular supplier, and the additional federal criminal statutes created by the Health 
Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996, as amended (“HIPAA”), which prohibits, among other things, knowingly and willfully executing or 
attempting to execute a scheme to defraud any healthcare benefit program or obtain by means of false or fraudulent pretenses, representations or promises 
any  money  or  property  owned  by  or  under  the  control  of  any  healthcare  benefit  program  in  connection  with  the  delivery  of  or  payment  for  healthcare 
benefits, items or services.

16

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Also  under  HIPAA,  a  Covered  Entity  is  required  to  adhere  to  certain  requirements  regarding  the  use,  disclosure  and  security  of  protected  health 
information (“PHI”). In the past, HIPAA has generally affected us indirectly, as Globus is generally neither a Covered Entity nor a Business Associate, as 
further  defined  under  HIPAA,  to  Covered  Entities,  except  that  our  provision  of  IONM  services  through  various  subsidiaries  may  create  a  Business 
Associate relationship; additionally, we treat our IONM service business and Puerto Rico subsidiary as a Covered Entity. Regardless of Covered Entity 
status under HIPAA, in those cases where patient data is received, Globus is committed to maintaining the security and privacy of PHI. The potential for 
enforcement action against us is now greater, as HHS can take action directly against Business Associates. Thus, while we believe we are and will continue 
to be in compliance with all required HIPAA standards, there is no guarantee that HHS will agree. Enforcement actions can be costly and interrupt regular 
operations of our business.

The  Physician  Payments  Sunshine  Act  of  2009  (the  "Sunshine  Act”)  was  enacted  into  law  in  2010  and  requires  public  disclosure  to  the  U.S. 
government of certain payments and other transfers of value to U.S.-licensed physicians, physician assistants, nurse practitioners, clinical nurse specialists, 
certified registered nurse anesthetists and anesthesiologist assistants, nurse midwives, and teaching hospitals, including in-kind transfers of value such as 
educational items or meals.  Ownership and investment interests by physicians and their immediate family members also must be reported. The Sunshine 
Act also provides penalties for non-compliance. The Sunshine Act requires that we file an annual report on March 31 of a calendar year for the transfers of 
value  incurred  for  the  prior  calendar  year.  This  law,  along  with  various  international  and  individual  state  reporting,  compliance  program,  gift  ban  and 
marketing program requirements, such as in Massachusetts and Vermont, increases the possibility that a healthcare company may run afoul of one or more 
of the requirements.

The U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act (“FCPA”) and similar anti-bribery laws in non-U.S. jurisdictions, such as the UK’s Bribery Act, generally 
prohibit companies and their intermediaries from making improper payments to non-U.S. government officials and (in the case of the Bribery Act) private 
sector decision makers for the purpose of obtaining or retaining business. Because of the predominance of government-owned or-administered healthcare 
systems in many jurisdictions around the world, many of our customer relationships outside of the U.S. are with governmental entities and are therefore 
potentially subject to such laws. Global enforcement of anti-corruption laws has increased considerably in recent years, with more frequent voluntary self-
disclosures  by  companies,  aggressive  investigations  and  enforcement  proceedings  by  U.S.  and  non-U.S.  governmental  agencies,  and  assessment  of 
significant fines and penalties against companies and individuals. It is our policy to implement safeguards to educate our employees and agents on these 
legal  requirements  and  prohibit  improper  practices.  The  government  may  seek  to  hold  us  liable  for  FCPA  violations  committed  by  companies  that  we 
acquire.  Violations  of  these  laws  may  be  punishable  by  criminal  or  civil  sanctions,  including  substantial  fines,  imprisonment  of  current  or  former 
employees and exclusion from participation in governmental healthcare programs.

Additionally, we must comply with a variety of other laws that protect the privacy of individually identifiable healthcare information and impose 

extensive tracking and reporting related to transfers of value provided to certain healthcare professionals. 

Environmental Matters

The manufacture of certain of our products, including our allograft implants and products, and the handling of materials used in the product testing 
process, including in our cadaveric laboratory, involve the controlled use of biological, hazardous and/or radioactive materials and wastes. Our business and 
facilities and those of our suppliers are subject to foreign, federal, state and local laws and regulations relating to the protection of human health and the 
environment, including those governing the use, manufacture, storage, handling and disposal of, and exposure to, such materials and wastes. In addition, 
under some environmental laws and regulations, we could be held responsible for costs relating to any contamination at our past or present facilities and at 
third-party waste disposal sites even if such contamination was not caused by us.

We  are  not  currently  aware  of  any  material  costs  or  liabilities  relating  to  environmental  matters,  including  any  claims  or  actions  under 
environmental laws or obligations to perform any cleanups at any of our facilities or any third-party waste disposal sites that we expect to have a material 
adverse effect on our business, financial condition or operating results. However, it is possible that material environmental costs or liabilities may arise in 
the future.

Human Capital

Workforce Overview

We believe our employees are our most valuable asset and are critical to our success as an organization. Our talent-related initiatives, including 
employee recruitment and development, compensation and benefit programs, are focused on building and retaining the world-class and talented staff that is 
needed to meet our goals.

As of December 31, 2023, we had over 5,000 employees worldwide, including sales and marketing, product development, general administrative 
and accounting, both domestically and internationally. Our employees are not subject to a collective bargaining agreement except in a single market outside 
the U.S., and we consider our relationship with our employees to be good.

17

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Compensation and Benefits

We offer competitive benefit packages, supporting our employees as they help create a leading, global musculoskeletal technology company. This 
includes  encouraging  a  culture  of  health  by  providing  benefits  programs  to  best  serve  our  employees  and  their  family  members.  Our  comprehensive 
benefits package may include competitive pay, annual incentive awards and bonus opportunities, health and wellness programs, healthcare and retirement 
benefits, and paid time off and sick leave.

Talent Development

We believe that success comes from investing in our people and ensuring our workforce is aligned with our mission and values. To achieve this goal, 
we  devote  time  and  resources  to  assist  our  employees  in  being  familiar  with  our  business,  industry,  and  product  offerings.  We  have  developed  a  robust
onboarding  program  for  our  newly  hired  associates  that  provides  a  comprehensive  overview  of  our  product  portfolio  and  company  history.  We  put  an 
emphasis on training our employees and sales representatives to understand our business, including the underlying medical conditions that our products 
treat. In addition, we strive to support our teams in the areas of professional development, mentoring, engagement, and health and wellness, enabling them 
to  do  their  best  work  as  they  grow  their  careers.  Employees  are  encouraged  to  partner  with  their  manager  to  create  individual  plans  to  guide  their 
development path and to incorporate training offerings and resources to support their growth and drive their continued success. Additionally, we regularly 
conduct talent reviews and succession planning to identify and develop our current and future leaders. We are committed to identifying and developing 
talent to help those employees accelerate their growth and achieve their career goals.

Employee Engagement and Communication

Our success depends on our employees understanding our strategy as well as our annual goals and priorities. This is accomplished through a number 
of channels, including a global intranet and sales enablement platform, regional and functional meetings, and quarterly updates in global Town Halls with 
leadership.  We  value  open  and  direct  communication  with  our  employees  about  their  experiences.  We  use  a  variety  of  channels  to  obtain  employee 
feedback, including employee surveys, open forums with leadership, and an employee resource group. Our annual employee engagement survey provides 
us  with  actionable  data  for  the  overall  company  and  each  department  and  also  provides  managers  with  upward  feedback  on  how  they  are  progressing 
against expectations. Each year, the input received through these mechanisms is used to help strengthen our culture and improve employee engagement. 

Diversity and Inclusion

We recognize the value associated with fostering a work environment that is culturally diverse and inclusive and believe that diverse teams stimulate 
innovation, enhance our understanding of the needs of our customers, and ultimately deliver better results for our stakeholders. As of December 31, 2023, 
our  Board  of  Directors  consisted  of  eleven  members,  two  of  whom  identified  as  female  and  two  of  whom  identified  as  having  a  racial  and  ethnic 
background other than white. Our goal is to cultivate a respectful and professional environment where all voices are heard and valued. Our HR and talent 
teams  create  professional  development  opportunities  for  employees  of  all  genders,  ethnicities  and  minority  groups,  backgrounds,  experience  levels,  and 
locations. As we seek to create a more diverse and inclusive workforce, we monitor voluntarily disclosed diversity data to review hiring, promotion and 
attrition overall at the Company and at the department level. We also review performance data and promotion and compensation information to ensure fair 
and objective decision-making. We believe that building diverse teams and leveraging broad perspectives will empower our employees and strengthen our 
ability to meet the needs of our customers, patients, and communities we serve.

Health, Safety, and Wellness

We  are  committed  to  the  protection  of  our  employees,  customers,  communities  and  the  environment.  Our  key  areas  of  focus  include  corporate 
compliance  with  responsible  hazardous  waste  management,  recycling,  emergency  preparedness,  as  well  as  various  initiatives  to  improve  our  health  and 
safety programs with the goal of reducing and ultimately eliminating serious injuries. Our Environmental, Health & Safety personnel develop global safety 
practices and procedures, train employees, host annual safety campaigns, and monitor compliance with safety procedures. 

Community

Our employees and sales representatives have a long history of providing support and care to our communities, donating time, resources and funds to 
local causes. Since 2009, we have leveraged our expertise in spine care to give back to local and global communities through Globus Cares and NuVasive 
Spine Foundation, both 501(c)(3) nonprofit organizations. These organizations support life-changing spine surgery for individuals around the world with 
limited access to high quality medical treatment by working with surgeons to advance the quality of spine care in disadvantaged communities. In addition, 
through our grants program, we support 

18

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
medical  research  and  education,  charitable  and  philanthropic  endeavors.  We  believe  in  giving  back,  and  we  also  believe  it  is  important  to  operate  our 
company in a socially responsible manner.

Information

We  were  incorporated  in  Delaware  in  March  2003.  Our  principal  executive  offices  are  located  at  2560  General  Armistead  Avenue,  Audubon, 
Pennsylvania 19403, and our telephone number at that location is (610) 930-1800. Our corporate website address is http://www.globusmedical.com. The 
information contained in or accessible through our website or contained on other websites is not deemed to be part of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

We  are  subject  to  the  filing  requirements  of  the  Exchange  Act.  Therefore,  we  file  annual  reports,  periodic  reports,  proxy  statements  and  other 
information  with  the  SEC.  The  SEC  maintains  a  website  (www.sec.gov)  that  contains  reports,  proxy  and  information  statements,  and  other  information 
regarding issuers that file electronically.

We make our annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and all amendments to such reports filed 
or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act available free of charge through a link on the Investors section of our website located 
at http://www.globusmedical.com (under “SEC Filings”) as soon as reasonably practicable after they are filed with or furnished to the SEC.

19

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Item 1A. Risk Factors

Risk factors that could cause our actual results to differ from our expectations and that could negatively impact our business, results of operations 
and financial condition are discussed below and elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. If any of these risks actually occurs, our business, results 
of operations, financial condition and future growth prospects could be materially and adversely affected. You should carefully read and consider each of 
these risks, together with all of the other information set forth in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. The risks and uncertainties described below are not the 
only ones we face. Additional risks and uncertainties not presently known to us or that we currently believe are immaterial may also materially adversely 
affect our business, results of operations, financial condition and future growth prospects, and our stock price.

We are providing the following summary of the risk factors contained in our Form 10-K to enhance the readability and accessibility of our risk 
factor  disclosures.  We  encourage  our  stockholders  to  carefully  review  the  full  risk  factors  contained  in  this  Form  10-K  in  their  entirety  for  additional 
information regarding the risks and uncertainties that could cause our actual results to vary materially from recent results or from our anticipated future 
results.

Risks Related to Our Business and Our Industry

(cid:0) To  be  commercially  successful,  we  must  convince  surgeons  and  hospitals  that  our  products  are  an  attractive  alternative  to  our  competitors’ 

products and to existing surgical treatments of musculoskeletal disorders.

(cid:0) Pricing pressure from our competitors and our customers may impact our ability to sell our products profitably.
(cid:0) If our customers are unable to obtain adequate coverage and reimbursement for their purchases of our products, we may not be able to sell them 

profitably.

(cid:0) If we are unable to maintain and expand our network of direct sales representatives and independent distributors, we may not be able to generate 

anticipated sales.

(cid:0) Our sales and operating results may be negatively affected and we may not grow if we are unable to compete successfully.
(cid:0) We  are  dependent  on  a  limited  number  of  third-party  suppliers,  and  the  loss  of  any  of  these  suppliers,  or  their  inability  to  provide  us  with  an 

adequate supply of products or materials in a timely manner could harm our business.

(cid:0) The proliferation of physician-owned distributorships (“PODs”) could result in increased pricing pressure on our products or harm our ability to

sell our products to physicians.

(cid:0) Our business could suffer if we lose the services of key members of our senior management, advisors or personnel.
(cid:0) The safety and efficacy of our products is not yet supported by long-term clinical data.
(cid:0) If we do not enhance our product offerings and introduce new products, we may be unable to effectively compete.
(cid:0) We are subject to risks arising from our acquisitions of or investments in new or complementary businesses, products or technologies.
(cid:0) We are required to maintain high levels of inventory, which may be costly.
(cid:0) We rely on information technology systems and network infrastructure to operate and manage our business, which may be subject to a breach, 

cyber-attack or other disruption.

(cid:0) We are subject to data privacy laws and our failure to comply with them could subject us to substantial liabilities.
(cid:0) If we experience significant disruptions in our information technology systems, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be 

adversely affected.

(cid:0) Consolidation in the healthcare industry could lead to demands for price concessions or to the exclusion of some suppliers from certain of our 

markets, which could have an adverse effect on our business.

(cid:0) If our Enabling Technologies products require significant amounts of service after sale or we receive a significant number of warranty claims, our

costs may increase.

(cid:0) We experience long and variable capital sales cycles for our Enabling Technologies products.
(cid:0) Certain  contractual  counterparties  may  seek  to  modify  contractual  relationships  with  the  Company,  which  could  have  an  adverse  effect  on  the 

Company’s business and operations.

(cid:0) The Company may be exposed to increased litigation, which could have an adverse effect on the Company’s business and operations.
(cid:0) Our IONM business exposes us to risks inherent with the sale of services.

20

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Risks Related to our Legal and Regulatory Environment

(cid:0) Our medical device products and operations are subject to extensive governmental regulation both in the U.S. and abroad.
(cid:0) Modifications to our products may require new 510(k) or de novo clearances, PMAs or PMA supplements.
(cid:0) Our HCT/P products are subject to extensive government regulation.
(cid:0) We and our suppliers are subject to the FDA’s good manufacturing practice regulations and similar international regulations.
(cid:0) We may be subject to a recall of our products or the discovery of serious safety issues with our products.
(cid:0) We may be subject to enforcement action if we engage in the off-label promotion of our products.
(cid:0) Governmental regulation and limited sources and suppliers could restrict our procurement and use of tissue.
(cid:0) Negative  publicity  concerning  methods  of  tissue  recovery  and  screening  of  donor  tissue  could  reduce  demand  for  our  regenerative  biologics 

products and impact the supply of available donor tissue.

(cid:0) We are subject to environmental laws and regulations that can impose significant costs and expose us to potential financial liabilities.
(cid:0) We or our suppliers may be the subject of claims for non-compliance with FDA regulations in connection with the processing, manufacturing or 

distribution of regenerative biologics implants and products.

(cid:0) We and our distributor sales representatives might be subject to claims for failing to comply with U.S. federal, state, local and foreign fraud and 

abuse laws.

Risks Related to our International Operations

(cid:0) We may fail to obtain or maintain foreign regulatory approvals to market our products in other countries.
(cid:0) We are subject to risks associated with our non-U.S. operations.
(cid:0) Our results of operations could suffer if we are unable to manage our planned international expansion effectively.
(cid:0) We are subject to risks arising from currency exchange rate fluctuations on our international transactions and translation of local currency results 

into U.S. dollars, which could adversely affect our profitability.

Risks Related to our Financial Results and Need for Financing

(cid:0) We will need to generate significant sales to remain profitable
(cid:0) We may be unable to grow our revenue or earnings as anticipated, which may have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.
(cid:0) Our quarterly and annual operating results may fluctuate significantly.
(cid:0) We have a significant amount of outstanding indebtedness, and our financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected if we 

do not effectively manage our liabilities.

(cid:0) The availability of funding under existing credit arrangements may be limited, and our cash and cash equivalents are subject to volatility.
(cid:0) Our future capital needs are uncertain and we may need to raise funds in the future, and such funds may not be available on acceptable terms or at 

all.

(cid:0) Our existing revolving credit facility contains restrictive covenants that may limit our operating flexibility. 

Risks Related to our Intellectual Property and Potential Litigation

(cid:0) We could become subject to litigation that could be costly and result in the diversion of management’s time and efforts.

Risks Related to the Ownership of our Class A Common Stock

(cid:0) Because of their significant stock ownership, our executive officers, and our directors and principal stockholders will be able to exert control over 

us and our significant corporate decisions.

(cid:0) We are a “controlled company” within the meaning of the New York Stock Exchange Rules.
(cid:0) Our Board is authorized to issue and designate shares of our preferred stock in additional series without stockholder approval.
(cid:0) Anti-takeover provisions in our organizational documents and Delaware law may discourage or prevent a change of control.

21

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

General Risk Factors

(cid:0) If we do not successfully implement our business strategy, our business and results of operations will be adversely affected
(cid:0) If we fail to properly manage our anticipated growth, our business could suffer.
(cid:0) Fluctuations in insurance cost and availability could adversely affect our profitability or our risk management profile.
(cid:0) We are exposed to the credit risk of some of our customers, which could result in material losses.
(cid:0) The widespread outbreak of a communicable disease, or any other public health crisis, could adversely affect our financial condition and results of 

operations.

Risks Relating to the Integration of NuVasive

(cid:0) Integrating the NuVasive business into Globus may be more difficult, costly or time-consuming than expected and the Company may fail to realize 
the  anticipated  benefits  of  the  Merger,  which  may  adversely  affect  the  Company’s  business  results  and  negatively  affect  the  value  of  the 
Company’s common stock.

(cid:0) The Company expects to incur substantial expenses related to the integration of NuVasive and may be unable to realize the anticipated synergies, 

which could adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

(cid:0) Certain  contractual  counterparties  may  seek  to  modify  contractual  relationships  with  the  Company,  which  could  have  an  adverse  effect  on  the 

Company’s business and operations.

(cid:0) The Company may be exposed to increased litigation, which could have an adverse effect on the Company’s business and operations.

Risks Related to Our Business and Our Industry

To be commercially successful, we must convince surgeons and hospitals that our products are an attractive alternative to our competitors’ products 
and  that  our  Enabling  Technologies  and  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  products  are  an  attractive  alternative  to  existing  surgical  treatments  of 
musculoskeletal disorders.

Surgeons play a significant role in determining the course of treatment and, ultimately, the type of product that will be used to treat a patient, so we 
rely  on  effectively  marketing  to  them.  Hospitals,  however,  are  increasingly  involved  in  the  evaluation  of  products  and  product  purchasing  decisions.  In 
order for us to sell our products, we must convince surgeons and hospitals that our products are attractive alternatives to competing products for use in 
procedures.  Acceptance  of  our  products  depends  on  educating  surgeons  and  hospitals  as  to  the  distinctive  characteristics,  perceived  benefits,  safety  and 
cost-effectiveness of our products as compared to our competitors’ products and on training surgeons in the proper application of our products. If we are 
not  successful  in  convincing  surgeons  and  hospitals  of  the  merit  of  our  products  or  educating  them  on  the  use  of  our  products,  they  may  not  use  our 
products and we will be unable to increase our sales and sustain growth or profitability.

Furthermore, we believe surgeons will not widely adopt certain of our most novel Musculoskeletal Solutions or Enabling Technologies products 
unless  they  determine,  based  on  experience,  clinical  data  and  published  peer-reviewed  journal  articles,  that  MIS  techniques,  our  motion  preservation, 
regenerative biologics, and INR technologies provide benefits or are an attractive alternative to conventional treatments of musculoskeletal disorders and 
incorporate improved technologies that permit novel surgical procedures.

Surgeons, and in certain instances, hospitals, may be hesitant to change their medical treatment practices or the products available for use to treat 

patients for the following reasons, among others:

(cid:0) lack of experience with MIS, motion preservation, regenerative biologics or INR technologies;
(cid:0) lack or perceived lack of evidence supporting additional patient benefits;
(cid:0) perceived liability risks generally associated with the use of new products and procedures; 
(cid:0) limited or lack of availability of coverage and reimbursement within healthcare payment systems;
(cid:0) costs associated with the purchase of new products and equipment; and
(cid:0) the time commitment that may be required for training.

If we are unable to convince surgeons and hospitals to use our products, or long-term data does not show the benefits of using our products, we 

will not achieve expected sales or sustain our growth, and our financial condition and results of operation may be adversely affected.

Pricing  pressure  from  our  competitors  and  our  customers  may  impact  our  ability  to  sell  our  products  at  prices  necessary  to  support  our  current 
business strategies.

The musculoskeletal devices industry is characterized by intense competition and continues to attract numerous new companies and technologies, 

which has encouraged more established companies to intensify competitive pricing pressure. As a result of this 

22

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
increased competition, as well as the challenges of third-party coverage and reimbursement practices, we believe there will be continued pricing pressure in 
the future. If competitive forces drive down the prices we are able to charge for our products, our profit margins will shrink, which will adversely affect our 
ability to maintain our profitability and to invest in and grow our business.

If  our  hospital  and  other  healthcare  provider  customers  are  unable  to  obtain  adequate  coverage  and  reimbursement  for  their  purchases  of  our 
Musculoskeletal Solutions products, we may not be able to sell our Musculoskeletal Solutions products at prices necessary to maintain our profitability 
or at all.

Maintaining  and  growing  sales  of  our  products  depends  on  the  availability  of  adequate  coverage  and  reimbursement  from  third-party  payors, 
including  government  programs  such  as  Medicare  and  Medicaid,  private  insurance  plans  and  managed  care  programs.  Hospitals  and  other  healthcare 
providers that purchase our Musculoskeletal Solutions products generally rely on third-party payors to cover all or part of the costs associated with the 
procedures performed with these products, including the cost to purchase the product. Our customers’ access to adequate coverage and reimbursement for 
the  procedures  performed  with  our  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  products  by  government  and  private  insurance  plans  is  central  to  the  acceptance  of  our 
current and future products. We may be unable to sell our Musculoskeletal Solutions products on a profitable basis, or at all, if third-party payors deny 
coverage or reduce their current levels of payment. If our cost of production increases faster than increases in reimbursement levels for the Musculoskeletal 
Solutions products, our profitability may be negatively impacted.

Future  action  by  CMS  (which  administers  the  Medicare  program  and  provides  oversight  and  funding  to  state  Medicaid  programs),  other 
government agencies or private payors, may diminish payments to physicians, outpatient surgery centers and/or hospitals, which could harm our ability to 
market  and  sell  our  products.  Private  payors  may  adopt  coverage  decisions  and  payment  amounts  determined  by  CMS  as  guidelines  in  setting  their 
coverage and reimbursement policies. Private payors that do not follow the Medicare guidelines may adopt different coverage and reimbursement policies 
for procedures performed with our products. In addition, for governmental programs, such as Medicaid, coverage and reimbursement differs from state to 
state. Medicaid payments to physicians and facilities are often lower than payments by other third-party payors and some state Medicaid programs may not 
pay an adequate amount for the procedures performed with our products, if any payment is made at all. Furthermore, the healthcare industry in the U.S. has 
experienced a trend toward cost containment as government and private insurers seek to control rising healthcare costs by imposing lower payment rates 
and negotiating reduced contract rates with service providers.

Third-party  payors,  including  public  and  private  payors,  may  develop  negative  coverage  policies  impacting  our  Musculoskeletal  Solutions 
products. In addition, some payors have changed their coverage policies to be more restrictive as to the criteria under which they will cover and reimburse 
for  vertebral  fusions  in  the  lumbar  spine  to  treat  multilevel  degenerative  disc  disease,  initial  primary  laminectomy/discectomy  for  nerve  root 
decompression,  or  spinal  stenosis.  Although  these  coverage  policy  changes  have  not  had  a  material  impact  on  our  business,  other  insurers  may  adopt 
similar  coverage  decisions  in  the  future.  Patients  covered  by  these  insurers  may  be  unwilling  or  unable  to  afford  lumbar  fusion  surgeries  to  treat  these 
conditions,  which  could  materially  harm  or  limit  our  ability  to  sell  our  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  products  designed  for  lumbar  fusion  procedures.  Our 
business would be negatively impacted if the trend by governmental agencies or third-party payors continues to reduce coverage of and/or reimbursement 
for procedures using our Musculoskeletal Solutions products.

We  cannot  be  certain  that  under  current  and  future  payment  systems,  such  as  those  utilized  by  Medicare  and  in  many  private  managed  care 
systems, the cost of our Musculoskeletal Solutions products will be adequately incorporated into the overall cost of the procedure. Therefore, we cannot be 
certain that the procedures performed with our Musculoskeletal Solutions products will be reimbursed at a sufficiently profitable level, or at all.

To  the  extent  we  sell  our  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  products  internationally,  market  acceptance  may  depend,  in  part,  upon  the  availability  of 
coverage and reimbursement within prevailing healthcare payment systems. Reimbursement and healthcare payment systems in international markets vary 
significantly by country, and include both government-sponsored healthcare and private insurance. Our Musculoskeletal Solutions products may not obtain 
international coverage and reimbursement approvals in a timely manner, if at all. Our failure to receive such approvals would negatively impact market 
acceptance of our products in the international markets in which those approvals are sought.

If  we  are  unable  to  maintain  and  expand  our  network  of  direct  sales  representatives  and  independent  distributors,  we  may  not  be  able  to  generate 
anticipated sales.

Our operating results are directly dependent upon the sales and marketing efforts of not only our employees, but also our independent distributors. 
We expect our direct sales representatives and independent distributors to develop long-lasting relationships with the surgeons they serve. If our direct sales 
representatives or independent distributors fail to adequately promote, market and sell our products, our sales could significantly decrease.

We face significant challenges and risks in managing our geographically dispersed distribution network and retaining the individuals who make up 

that network. If certain of our direct sales representatives were to leave us, or if certain of our independent 

23

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
distributors  were  to  cease  to  do  business  with  us,  our  sales  could  be  adversely  affected.  Some  of  our  independent  distributors  account  for  a  significant 
portion of our sales volume, and if any such independent distributor were to cease to distribute our products, our sales could be adversely affected. In such 
a situation, we may need to seek alternative independent distributors or increase our reliance on our direct sales representatives, which may not prevent our 
sales from being adversely affected. If a direct sales representative or independent distributor were to depart and be retained by one of our competitors, we 
may  be  unable  to  prevent  them  from  helping  competitors  solicit  business  from  our  existing  customers,  which  could  further  adversely  affect  our  sales. 
Because of the intense competition for their services, we may be unable to recruit or retain additional qualified independent distributors or to hire additional 
direct sales representatives to work with us. We may not be able to enter into agreements with them on favorable or commercially reasonable terms, if at 
all. Failure to hire or retain qualified direct sales representatives or independent distributors would prevent us from maintaining or expanding our business 
and generating sales.

As  we  launch  new  products  and  increase  our  marketing  efforts  with  respect  to  existing  products,  we  will  need  to  expand  the  reach  of  our 
marketing  and  sales  networks.  Our  future  success  will  depend  largely  on  our  ability  to  continue  to  hire,  train,  retain  and  motivate  skilled  direct  sales 
representatives and independent distributors with significant technical knowledge in various areas. New hires require training and take time to achieve full 
productivity. If we fail to train new hires adequately, or if we experience high turnover in our sales force in the future, we cannot be certain that new hires 
will become as productive as may be necessary to maintain or increase our sales.

If we are unable to expand our sales and marketing capabilities domestically and internationally, we may not be able to effectively commercialize 

our products, which would adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.

We operate in a very competitive business environment and if we are unable to compete successfully against our existing or potential competitors, our 
sales and operating results may be negatively affected and we may not grow.

Our industry is intensely competitive, subject to rapid change and highly sensitive to the introduction of new products or other market activities of 
industry  participants.  We  believe  that  our  significant  competitors  are  Medtronic,  DePuy  Synthes,  Stryker,  Zimmer  Biomet,  and  Smith  and  Nephew. 
Alphatec Holdings, Orthofix, Integra LifeSciences, ZimVie and other smaller public and private companies are also competitors of ours. At any time, these 
or  other  industry  participants  may  develop  alternative  treatments,  products  or  procedures  for  the  treatment  of  musculoskeletal  disorders  that  compete 
directly  or  indirectly  with  our  products.  They  may  also  develop  and  patent  processes  or  products  earlier  than  we  can  or  obtain  regulatory  clearance  or 
approvals for competing products more rapidly than we can, which could impair our ability to develop and commercialize similar processes or products. If 
alternative treatments are, or are perceived to be, superior to our musculoskeletal surgery products, sales of our products could be negatively affected and 
our results of operations could suffer.

Many  of  our  current  and  potential  competitors  are  major  medical  device  companies  that  have  substantially  greater  financial,  technical  and 

marketing resources than we do, and they may succeed in developing products that would render our products obsolete or non-competitive.

Many of our larger competitors enjoy several competitive advantages over us, including:

(cid:0) greater financial, human and other resources for product research and development, sales and marketing and litigation;
(cid:0) significantly greater name recognition;
(cid:0) established relationships with surgeons, hospitals and other healthcare providers;
(cid:0) large and established sales and marketing and distribution networks;
(cid:0) products supported by long-term clinical data;
(cid:0) greater experience in obtaining and maintaining regulatory clearances or approvals for products and product enhancements;
(cid:0) more expansive portfolios of intellectual property rights; and
(cid:0) greater ability to cross-sell their products or to incentivize hospitals or surgeons to use their products.

The frequent introduction by competitors of products that compete with our existing or planned products may also make it difficult to market or 
sell our products. In addition, the entry of multiple new products and competitors, including PODs, may lead some of our competitors to employ pricing 
strategies that could adversely affect the pricing of our products and pricing in the musculoskeletal implant and device market generally.

As a result, our ability to compete successfully will depend on our ability to develop proprietary products that reach the market in a timely manner, 
receive adequate coverage and reimbursement from third-party payors, and are safer, less invasive and more effective than alternatives available for similar 
purposes. If we are unable to do so, our sales or margins could decrease, thereby harming our business.

24

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

We are dependent on a limited number of third-party suppliers, and the loss of any of these suppliers, or their inability to provide us with an adequate
supply of products or materials in a timely manner, could harm our business.

We rely on third-party suppliers to supply many of our finished products and also various components and materials used to manufacture other 
products. For us to be successful, our suppliers must be able to provide us with products, components, and materials in substantial quantities, in compliance 
with regulatory requirements, in accordance with agreed upon specifications, at acceptable costs and on a timely basis. Our anticipated growth could strain 
the ability of our suppliers to deliver an increasingly large supply of products, materials and components. Other issues, including shortages of raw materials 
or components, problems with production yields and quality control and assurance, especially with products such as allograft, which is processed human 
tissue, could impair a supplier’s ability to supply us with product quantities necessary to support our sales. Furthermore, under our supplier agreements, our 
suppliers generally have no obligation to manufacture for us or sell to us any specific quantity of products. If we are unable to obtain sufficient quantities of 
high-quality components to meet demand on a timely basis, we could lose customers, our reputation may be harmed, and our business could suffer.

We generally use a small number of suppliers for our products, materials and components. Our dependence on such a limited number of suppliers 
exposes us to risks, including limited control over pricing, availability, quality and delivery schedules. Our suppliers may be impacted by equipment failure 
or economic, environmental, or geopolitical factors that disrupt manufacturing capacities.  If any one or more of our suppliers cease to provide us with 
sufficient quantities of products or materials in a timely manner or on terms acceptable to us, or cease to manufacture components of acceptable quality, we 
would have to seek alternative sources of supply. Because of the nature of our internal quality control requirements, regulatory requirements and the custom 
and proprietary nature of components, we cannot quickly engage additional or replacement suppliers for many of our critical components. Failure of any of 
our third-party suppliers to deliver products or materials at the level our business requires would limit our ability to meet our sales commitments to our 
customers and could have a material adverse effect on our business. We may also have difficulty obtaining similar components from other suppliers that are 
acceptable to the FDA or other foreign regulatory authorities. We could incur delays while we locate and engage qualified alternative suppliers, and we 
may be unable to engage alternative suppliers on favorable terms or at all. We cannot guarantee that disruptions will not occur, and any such disruption may 
result in decreased inventory, increased overhead costs, product shortages and decreased sales, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our 
business,  results  of  operations  and  financial  condition,  and  could  harm  our  commercialization  efforts  and  adversely  affect  our  ability  to  generate  future 
sales.

The proliferation of PODs could result in increased pricing pressure on our products or harm our ability to sell our products to physicians who own or 
are affiliated with those distributorships.

PODs are medical device distributors that are owned, directly or indirectly, by physicians. These physicians derive a proportion of their revenue 

from selling or arranging for the sale of medical devices for use in procedures at hospitals that agree to purchase from or through the POD.

We  do  not  sell  or  distribute  any  of  our  products  through  PODs.  The  number  of  PODs  may  continue  to  grow  as  economic  pressures  increase 
throughout the industry, as hospitals, insurers and physicians search for ways to reduce costs, and, in the case of the physicians, search for ways to increase 
their incomes. These companies and the physicians who own, or partially own, them have significant market knowledge and access to the surgeons who use 
our products and the hospitals that purchase our products, and growth in this area may reduce our ability to compete effectively for business from surgeons
who own such distributorships.

Our business could suffer if we lose the services of key members of our senior management, key advisors or personnel.

We are dependent upon the continued services of key members of our senior management and a limited number of key advisors and personnel. In 
particular,  we  are  highly  dependent  on  the  skills  and  leadership  of  our  Executive  Chairman,  David  C.  Paul,  and  our  Chief  Executive  Officer,  Daniel  T. 
Scavilla. The loss of any one of these individuals could disrupt our operations or our strategic plans. Additionally, our future success will depend on, among 
other things, our ability to continue to hire and retain the necessary qualified scientific, technical and managerial personnel, for whom we compete with 
numerous  other  companies,  academic  institutions  and  organizations.  The  loss  of  members  of  our  management  team,  key  advisors  or  personnel,  or  our
inability to attract or retain other qualified personnel or advisors, could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial 
condition.  Though  members  of  our  sales  force  generally  enter  into  non-compete  agreements  that  restrict  their  ability  to  compete  with  us,  most  of  the 
members  of  our  executive  management  team  are  not  subject  to  such  agreements.  Accordingly,  the  adverse  effect  resulting  from  the  loss  of  certain 
executives could be compounded by our inability to prevent them from competing with us.

The safety and efficacy of our products is not yet supported by long-term clinical data, which could limit sales, and our products might therefore prove 
to be less safe and effective than initially thought.

Many of our products we currently market in the U.S., have either received pre-market clearance under Section 510(k) of the Federal Food, Drug, 
and  Cosmetic  Act  (“FDCA”)  or  are  exempt  from  pre-market  review.  The  FDA's  510(k)  clearance  process,  and  similar  regulatory  processes  in  other 
countries, requires us to show that our proposed product is “substantially equivalent” to another 

25

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
510(k)-cleared product. This process is shorter and typically requires the submission of less supporting documentation than other FDA approval processes 
and does not always require long-term clinical studies. Additionally, for most products launched to date, we have not been required to complete long-term 
clinical studies in connection with the sale of our products outside the U.S. market. Our SECURE®-C device was prospectively studied through a seven-
year postoperative clinical study as part of the Postmarket Approval process. As a result, we currently lack the breadth of published long-term clinical data 
supporting  the  safety  and  efficacy  of  virtually  all  of  our  products  and  the  benefits  they  offer  that  might  have  been  generated  in  connection  with  other 
approval processes. For these reasons, surgeons may be slow to adopt our products, we may not have comparative data that our competitors have or are 
generating, and we may be subject to greater regulatory and product liability risks. Further, future patient studies or clinical experience may indicate that 
treatment with our products does not improve patient outcomes. Such results would slow the adoption of our products by surgeons, significantly reduce our 
ability to achieve expected sales, and could prevent us from sustaining our profitability.

Moreover,  if  future  results  and  experience  indicate  that  our  products  cause  unexpected  or  serious  complications  or  other  unforeseen  negative 
effects, we could be subject to mandatory product recalls, product seizures, suspension or withdrawal of FDA clearance or approval, and significant legal 
liability or harm to our business reputation.

If  we  do  not  enhance  our  existing  product  offerings  and  introduce  new  products  through  our  research  and  development  and  product  development 
efforts, we may be unable to effectively compete.

In  order  to  increase  our  market  share,  we  must  enhance  and  broaden  our  product  offerings  in  response  to  changing  customer  demands  and 
competitive pressures and technologies.  The success of any new product offering or enhancement to an existing product will depend on numerous factors, 
including our ability to:

(cid:0) properly identify and anticipate surgeon and patient needs;
(cid:0) develop and introduce new products or product enhancements in a timely manner;
(cid:0) adequately protect our intellectual property and avoid infringing upon the intellectual property rights of third parties;
(cid:0) demonstrate the safety and efficacy of new products; and
(cid:0) obtain the necessary regulatory clearances or approvals for new products or product enhancements.

If we do not develop and obtain regulatory clearance or approval for new products or product enhancements in time to meet market demand, or if 
there  is  insufficient  demand  for  these  products  or  enhancements,  our  results  of  operations  will  suffer.    Our  research  and  development  and  product 
development efforts may require a substantial investment of time and resources before we are adequately able to determine the commercial viability of a 
new product, technology, material or other innovation.  In addition, even if we are able to successfully develop enhancements or new generations of our 
products,  these  enhancements  or  new  generations  of  products  may  not  produce  sales  in  excess  of  the  costs  of  development  and  they  may  be  quickly 
rendered obsolete by changing customer preferences or the introduction by our competitors of products embodying new technologies or features.

We  continue  to  introduce  new  products  and  services  related  to  our  the  ExcelsiusGPS®  platform  and  orthopedic  trauma  products.  We  recently 
launched the Excelsius3D™ imaging system. Prior to launching these platforms, we had no prior experience marketing these new products and we may 
launch new products in the future that we have no prior experience marketing. We will need to convince a new audience of surgeons and hospital personnel 
that our new products are attractive alternatives to competing products for use in applicable procedures. If we are not successful in convincing surgeons and
hospitals of the merit of new products or educating them on their use, our sales and operating results may be negatively affected and we may not grow as 
quickly as we anticipate.

We  may  seek  to  grow  our  business  through  acquisitions  of  or  investments  in  new  or  complementary  businesses,  products  or  technologies,  and  the 
failure to manage acquisitions or investments, or the failure to integrate them with our existing business, could have a material adverse effect on us.

From time to time we expect to consider opportunities to acquire or make investments in other technologies, products and businesses that may 
enhance our capabilities, complement our current products or expand the breadth of our markets or customer base. Potential and completed acquisitions and 
strategic investments involve numerous risks, including:

(cid:0) problems assimilating the purchased technologies, products or business operations;
(cid:0) issues maintaining uniform standards, procedures, controls and policies;
(cid:0) unanticipated costs associated with acquisitions;
(cid:0) diversion of management’s attention from our core business;
(cid:0) adverse effects on existing business relationships with suppliers and customers;
(cid:0) risks associated with entering new markets in which we have limited or no experience;
(cid:0) potential loss of key employees of acquired businesses; and
(cid:0) increased legal and accounting compliance costs.

26

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

We  do  not  know  if  we  will  be  able  to  identify  acquisitions  we  deem  suitable,  whether  we  will  be  able  to  successfully  complete  any  such 
acquisitions on favorable terms or at all, or whether we will be able to successfully integrate any acquired business, product or technology into our business 
or retain any key personnel, suppliers or distributors. Our ability to successfully grow through acquisitions depends upon our ability to identify, negotiate, 
complete and integrate suitable target businesses and to obtain any necessary financing. These efforts could be expensive and time-consuming, and may 
disrupt our ongoing business and prevent management from focusing on our operations. If we are unable to integrate any acquired businesses, products or 
technologies effectively, our business, results of operations and financial condition will be materially adversely affected.

We are required to maintain high levels of inventory, which could consume a significant amount of our resources and reduce our cash flows.

As  a  result  of  the  need  to  maintain  substantial  levels  of  inventory,  we  are  subject  to  the  risk  of  inventory  obsolescence.  Many  of  our 
Musculoskeletal  Solutions  products  come  in  sets,  which  feature  components  in  a  variety  of  sizes  to  satisfy  the  particular  patient’s  anatomical  needs.  In 
order to market our Musculoskeletal Solutions products effectively, we often must maintain implant sets consisting of the full range of product sizes. For 
each surgery, fewer than all of the components of the set are used, and therefore certain portions of the set, like uncommon sizes, may become obsolete 
before they can be used. In the event that a substantial portion of our inventory becomes obsolete, it could have a material adverse effect on our earnings 
and cash flows due to the resulting costs associated with the inventory impairment charges and costs required to replace such inventory.

We rely on information technology systems and network infrastructure to operate and manage our business, if we experience a breach, cyber-attack or 
other disruption to these systems or data, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected.

We are increasingly dependent on sophisticated information technology systems to operate our business, including to process, transmit and store 
sensitive  data,  and  many  of  our  products  and  services  include  or  use  integrated  software  and  information  technology  that  may  collect  data  regarding 
customers, patients, suppliers and third parties, or connects to our systems. Given the nature of our business, we also may maintain personally identifiable 
information (“PII”) or access to PHI. Specifically, we rely on our information technology systems to effectively manage sales and marketing, accounting 
and financial functions, inventory management, engineering and product development tasks, and our research and development data. Our business therefore 
depends  on  the  continuous,  effective,  reliable,  and  secure  operation  of  our  computer  hardware,  software,  networks,  Internet  servers,  and  related 
infrastructure.

Although  our  computer  and  communications  hardware  is  protected  by  reasonable  physical,  technical,  and  administrative  safeguards,  it  is  still 
vulnerable  to  system  malfunction,  computer  viruses,  and  cybersecurity  breaches  –  including  ransomware,  phishing  DDoS,  malware,  brute  force,  insider 
threats, and other cyber attacks and security incidents. These events could lead to the unauthorized access to information systems maintained by us or our 
service providers or customers and result in the misappropriation or unauthorized disclosure of confidential information belonging to us, our employees, 
patients, partners, customers, or our suppliers. The techniques used by criminal elements to attack computer systems are sophisticated, change frequently 
and may originate from less regulated and remote areas of the world, including countries that engage in state-sponsored cyber attacks. As a result, we may 
not  be  able  to  address  these  techniques  proactively  or  implement  adequate  preventative  measures.  Additionally,  the  regulatory  environment  governing 
information, security and privacy laws is increasingly demanding and continues to evolve. If our information technology systems are compromised, we 
could be subject to fines, damages, litigation and enforcement actions and we could lose trade secrets or other confidential information, the occurrence of 
which could harm our reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition.

Our  information  systems,  and  those  of  third-parties  with  whom  we  contract,  also  require  an  ongoing  commitment  of  significant  resources  to 
maintain, protect and enhance existing systems and develop new systems to keep pace with continuing changes in information technology.  The failure of 
our information technology systems to perform as we anticipate or our failure to effectively implement new systems could disrupt our operations and could 
result  in  decreased  sales,  increased  overhead  costs,  excess  inventory  and  product  shortages,  all  of  which  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our 
reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition.

We are subject to data privacy laws and our failure to comply with them could subject us to substantial liabilities.

Our  business  relies  on  the  secure  electronic  transmission,  storage  and  hosting  of  sensitive  information,  including  personal  information,  PHI, 
financial information, intellectual property and other sensitive information related to our customers and workforce. The collection, maintenance, protection, 
use, transmission, disclosure and disposal of certain personal information and the security of medical devices are regulated at the U.S. federal and state, 
international and industry levels. U.S. federal and state laws, such as HIPAA, protect the confidentiality of certain patient health information, including 
patient  medical  records,  and  restrict  the  use  and  disclosure  of  patient  health  information.  In  addition  to  the  regulation  of  personal  health  information,  a 
number of states have also adopted laws and regulations that may affect our privacy and data security practices for other kinds of PII, such as state laws that 
govern  the  use,  disclosure  and  protection  of  sensitive  personal  information,  such  as  social  security  numbers,  or  that  are  designed  to  protect  credit  card 
account data. 

27

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
State  consumer  protection  laws  may  also  establish  privacy  and  security  standards  for  use  and  management  of  PII,  including  information  related  to 
customers, suppliers, and care providers.

Outside  the  U.S.,  we  are  impacted  by  the  privacy  and  data  security  requirements  at  the  international,  national  and  regional  level,  and  on  an 
industry  specific  basis.  Legal  requirements  in  the  countries  we  serve  relating  to  the  collection,  storage,  handling  and  transfer  of  personal  data  and 
potentially intellectual property continue to evolve with increasingly strict enforcement regimes. More privacy and security laws and regulations are being 
adopted, and more are being enforced, with potential for significant financial penalties. In the EU, stringent data protection and privacy rules impact the use 
of patient data across the healthcare industry. The GDPR applies across the EU, with similar requirements applying to the UK and European Economic 
Area countries, and includes, among other things, a requirement for prompt notice of data breaches in certain circumstances and imposes significant fines 
for non-compliance. Data protection authorities from different EU member states may interpret and apply the GDPR somewhat differently, and the GDPR 
also  permits  EU  member  states  to  create  supplemental  national  laws,  which  increases  the  complexity  for  compliance.  Failure  to  comply  with  GDPR 
requirements could result in penalties of up to €20 million or 4% of worldwide revenue, whichever is greater, for serious violations. Within the U.S., a 
number of states have enacted more onerous privacy laws, such as the California Consumer Privacy Act (the “CCPA”), which also impose stricter privacy 
requirements and are enforced by state attorneys general and other state agencies. Any investigations or any other government actions related to the GDPR, 
CCPA, and other privacy laws may be costly to respond to, result in negative publicity, increase our operating costs, require significant management time 
and  attention,  and  subject  us  to  remedies  that  may  harm  our  business,  including  fines,  demands  or  orders  that  we  modify  or  cease  existing  business 
practices. Private litigation, including class actions, related to privacy and cybersecurity issues is also on the rise in the U.S. and other countries.

If we experience significant disruptions in our information technology systems, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be 
adversely affected.

The  efficient  operation  of  our  business  depends  on  our  information  technology  systems.  We  rely  on  our  information  technology  systems  to 

effectively manage:

(cid:0) sales and marketing, accounting and financial functions;
(cid:0) inventory management;
(cid:0) engineering and product development tasks; and
(cid:0) our research and development data.

Our information technology systems are vulnerable to damage or interruption from:

(cid:0) earthquakes, fires, floods and other natural disasters;
(cid:0) terrorist attacks and attacks by computer viruses or hackers or other cybersecurity attacks or breaches;
(cid:0) power losses; and
(cid:0) computer systems, or Internet, telecommunications or data network failures.

The failure of our information technology systems to perform as we anticipate or our failure to effectively implement new systems could disrupt 
our  entire  operation  and  could  result  in  decreased  sales,  increased  overhead  costs,  excess  inventory  and  product  shortages,  all  of  which  could  have  a 
material adverse effect on our reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition.

Consolidation in the healthcare industry could lead to demands for price concessions or to the exclusion of some suppliers from certain of our markets, 
which could have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations or financial condition.

Because  healthcare  costs  have  risen  significantly  over  the  past  decade,  numerous  initiatives  and  reforms  initiated  by  legislators,  regulators  and 
third-party payors to curb these costs have resulted in a consolidation trend in the healthcare industry to aggregate purchasing power. As the healthcare 
industry consolidates, competition to provide products and services to industry participants has become and will continue to become more intense. This in 
turn has resulted and will likely continue to result in greater pricing pressures and the exclusion of certain suppliers from important market segments as 
group  purchasing  organizations,  independent  delivery  networks  and  large  single  accounts  continue  to  use  their  market  power  to  consolidate  purchasing 
decisions for hospitals. We expect that market demand, government regulation, third-party coverage and reimbursement policies and societal pressures will 
continue to change the worldwide healthcare industry, resulting in further business consolidations and alliances among our customers, which may reduce 
competition,  exert  further  downward  pressure  on  the  prices  of  our  products  and  may  adversely  impact  our  business,  results  of  operations  or  financial 
condition.

28

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

If our Enabling Technologies products require significant amounts of service after sale or we receive a significant number of warranty claims, our 
costs may increase and our financial results may be adversely affected.

Sales of certain of our Enabling Technologies products that are capital equipment typically include a warranty and maintenance obligation on our 
part  for  services  for  a  period  of  twelve  months  from  the  date  the  equipment  is  installed  at  a  customer’s  facility.  Customers  may  also  purchase  a 
supplemental  service  plan  for  technical  and  other  services  for  any  required  service  beyond  the  initial  warranty  and  service  period.  If  product  warranty 
claims or required service under the service plans exceed our expectations, we may incur additional expenditures for parts and service. In addition, our 
reputation could be damaged and our products may not achieve market acceptance and could result in reductions in sales.

We experience long and variable capital sales cycles for our Enabling Technologies products, which may cause fluctuations in our financial results.

The sales and purchase order cycle of our Enabling Technologies capital equipment products is lengthy because they are major capital items and 
their purchase generally requires the approval of senior management of hospitals, their parent organizations, purchasing groups, and government bodies, as 
applicable. In addition, sales to some of our customers are subject to competitive bidding or public tender processes. These approval and bidding processes 
can be lengthy. Further, the introduction of new products could adversely impact our sales cycle as customers take additional time to assess the benefits and 
costs of such products. As a result, it is difficult for us to predict the length of capital sales cycles and, therefore, the exact timing of capital sales.

The  above  factors  may  contribute  to  fluctuations  in  our  quarterly  operating  results.  Because  of  these  fluctuations,  it  is  possible  that  in  future 
periods our operating results will fall below the expectations of securities analysts or investors. If that happens, the market price of our stock would likely 
decrease.

Our IONM business exposes us to risks inherent with the sale of services.

Our  IONM  services  and  support  business  exposes  us  to  different  risks  than  our  other  products  and  technologies.  Through  NuVasive  Clinical 
Services,  a  Globus  subsidiary,  we  provide  onsite  and  remote  monitoring  of  the  neurological  systems  of  patients  undergoing  spinal  and  brain-related 
surgeries. Our neurophysiologists are present in the operating room during procedures and work with supervising physicians who remotely oversee and 
interpret  neurophysiologic  data  gathered  via  broadband  transmission  over  the  Internet.  Providing  this  service  subjects  us  to  malpractice  exposure.  In 
addition, given the reliance on technology, any disruption to our IONM equipment or the Internet could harm our service operations and our reputation 
among our customers. Further, any disruption to our information technology systems could adversely impact the performance of our neurophysiologists and 
oversight physicians.

In addition, IONM services are directly billed to Medicare and commercial payors, which brings with it additional risks associated with proper 
billing practice regulations, HIPAA compliance, corporate practice of medicine laws, and collections risk associated with third-party payors. Due to the 
breadth  of  many  healthcare  laws  and  regulations,  our  IONM  business  could  also  be  subject  to  healthcare  fraud  regulation  and  enforcement  by  both  the 
federal government and the states in which we conduct our business, including under the Anti-Kickback Statute, the federal false claims laws and state law 
equivalents. Further, in December 2020, in connection with the Consolidated Appropriations Act of 2021, the No Surprises Act was signed into law in the 
U.S., which introduced national limitations on physician billing for certain services furnished by providers who are not in-network with the patient’s self-
insured health plan, individual or group health plan. This federal law became effective on January 1, 2022, and several states where we conduct business 
have also enacted similar laws that would apply to patients having state-regulated insurance. These measures could limit the amount we can charge and 
recover for the IONM services we furnish where we have not contracted with the patient’s insurer, which could negatively impact the profitability of our 
IONM services business. If our operations are found to be in violation of any of these laws or any other governmental regulations that apply to us, we may 
be subject to sanctions, including civil penalties and damages, criminal fines and imprisonment, exclusion from participation in federal and state healthcare 
programs, suspension and debarment from federal procurement and non-procurement programs, refusal of orders under existing government contracts, and 
the curtailment or restructuring of our operations. Any penalties, damages, fines, exclusion or debarment, or curtailment or restructuring of our operations 
could adversely affect our ability to operate our business and our financial results.

29

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Risks Related to our Legal and Regulatory Environment

Our medical device products and operations are subject to extensive governmental regulation both in the U.S. and abroad, and our failure to comply 
with applicable requirements could cause our business to suffer.

The  medical  device  industry  is  regulated  extensively  by  governmental  authorities,  principally  the  FDA  and  corresponding  state  and  foreign 

regulatory agencies. The FDA and other U.S. and foreign governmental agencies regulate, among other things, with respect to medical devices:

(cid:0) design, development and manufacturing;
(cid:0) testing, labeling, content and language of instructions for use and storage;
(cid:0) clinical trials;
(cid:0) product safety;
(cid:0) marketing, sales and distribution;
(cid:0) pre-market clearance and approval;
(cid:0) record keeping procedures;
(cid:0) advertising and promotion;
(cid:0) recalls and field safety corrective actions;
(cid:0) post-market  surveillance,  including  reporting  of  deaths  or  serious  injuries  and  malfunctions  that,  if  they  were  to  recur,  could  lead  to  death  or 

serious injury;

(cid:0) post-market approval studies; and
(cid:0) product import and export.

The regulations to which we are subject are complex and have tended to become more stringent over time; see “Item 1. Business; Government 
Regulation” above for a summary of certain regulations to which we are subject. Regulatory changes could result in restrictions on our ability to carry on 
or expand our operations, higher than anticipated costs or lower than anticipated sales.

The processes by which 510(k) clearance, grant of a de novo classification request, or PMA approval is obtained can be expensive and lengthy and 
require the payment of significant fees. The FDA’s 510(k) clearance process usually takes from three to twelve months, but may last longer. The FDA’s 
goal is to review de novo classification requests within 150 FDA review days, but presently, the current average review period is about eight months. The 
process of obtaining a PMA is much costlier and more uncertain than the 510(k) clearance process and generally takes one to three years, or even longer, 
from  the  time  the  application  is  submitted  to  the  FDA  until  an  approval  is  obtained.  The  process  of  obtaining  regulatory  clearances  through  the  510(k) 
process, de novo classification, or approvals through the PMA process to market a medical device in the U.S. or internationally can be costly and time-
consuming, and we may not be able to obtain these clearances, grants of de novo classification, or approvals on a timely basis, if at all.

In the U.S., all of our currently commercialized medical device products, other than SECURE®-C have either received premarket clearance under 
Section  510(k)  of  the  FDCA  or  are  exempt  from  PMA  review.  If  the  FDA  requires  us  to  go  through  a  lengthier,  more  rigorous  examination  for  future 
products or modifications to existing products than we had expected, our product introductions or modifications could be delayed or canceled, which could 
cause our sales to decline and potentially harm our ability to compete. In addition, if the FDA disagrees with our determination that a product we currently 
market  is  subject  to  an  exemption  from  premarket  review,  the  FDA  may  require  us  to  submit  a  510(k),  de novo,  or  PMA  and  may  require  us  to  cease 
distribution of the product and/or recall the product unless and until we obtain 510(k) or de novo clearance or PMA. Further, even with respect to those 
future products where a PMA is not required, we cannot assure you that we will be able to obtain the 510(k) or de novo clearances with respect to those 
products.  The  FDA  may  also  reclassify  devices  currently  on  the  market  from  Class  II  to  Class  III,  which  could  result  in  additional  regulatory  burden 
requiring submission and approval of a PMA prior to marketing, or could result in the FDA rescinding a 510(k) for a previously cleared device.

The FDA can delay, limit or deny clearance or approval of a device for many reasons, including:

(cid:0) we may not be able to demonstrate to the FDA’s satisfaction that our products are safe and effective for their intended uses;
(cid:0) the data from our pre-clinical studies and clinical trials may be insufficient to support clearance or approval, where required; and
(cid:0) the manufacturing process or facilities we use may not meet applicable requirements.

In  addition,  the  FDA  may  change  its  clearance  and  approval  policies,  adopt  additional  regulations  or  revise  existing  regulations,  or  take  other 
actions which may prevent or delay approval or clearance of our products under development or impact our ability to modify our currently approved or 
cleared products on a timely basis. It is also possible that, if we obtain new FDA regulatory clearances 

30

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
or approvals, the clearances or approvals may contain limitations on the indicated uses or may prohibit certain uses which may impact the marketability of 
the product.

Any delay in, or failure to receive or maintain, clearance or approval for our medical device products under development could prevent us from 
generating revenue from these products or achieving profitability. Additionally, the FDA and other regulatory authorities have broad enforcement powers. 
Regulatory enforcement or inquiries, or other increased scrutiny on us, could dissuade some surgeons from using our products and adversely affect our 
reputation and the perceived safety and efficacy of our products.

In addition, even after we have obtained the proper regulatory approval to market a product, the FDA has the power to require us to conduct post 
marketing studies, such as a Section 522 Order. These studies can be very expensive and time-consuming to conduct. Failure to comply with those studies 
in  a  timely  manner  could  result  in  the  revocation  of  the  510(k)  clearance  for  the  product  that  is  subject  to  such  a  Section  522  Order  and  the  recall  or 
withdrawal of the product, which could prevent us from generating sales from that product in the U.S.

Similarly, we must comply with numerous international laws and regulations in order to market our products outside of the U.S.; see “Item 1. 
Business; Government Regulation; International” above for a summary of certain international laws and regulations to which we are subject. As is the 
case in the U.S., the applicable regulatory body may change its clearance and approval policies, adopt additional regulations or revise existing regulations, 
or take other actions which may prevent or delay approval or clearance of our products under development or impact our ability to modify our currently 
approved or cleared products on a timely basis. Any delay in, or failure to receive or maintain, clearance or approval for our products under development 
could prevent us from generating revenue from these products or achieving profitability. Conducting clinical studies to obtain clinical data that might be 
required as part of the clinical evaluation process can be expensive and time-consuming. Additionally, the regulatory authorities have broad enforcement 
powers. Regulatory enforcement or inquiries, or other increased scrutiny on us, could dissuade some surgeons from using our products and adversely affect 
the perceived safety and efficacy of our products and our reputation.

Failure to comply with applicable regulations could jeopardize our ability to sell our products and result in enforcement actions such as:

(cid:0) untitled letters or warning letters;
(cid:0) fines;
(cid:0) injunctions;
(cid:0) civil penalties;
(cid:0) termination of distribution;
(cid:0) recalls or seizures of products;
(cid:0) delays in the introduction of products into the market;
(cid:0) total or partial suspension of production;
(cid:0) refusal of the FDA or other regulator to grant future clearances or approvals;
(cid:0) withdrawals or suspensions of current clearances or approvals, resulting in prohibitions on sales of our products; 
(cid:0) refusal to grant export approvals; and/or
(cid:0) in the most serious cases, criminal penalties.

Any  of  these  sanctions  could  result  in  higher  than  anticipated  costs  or  lower  than  anticipated  sales  and  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our 

reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition.

Modifications to our products may require new 510(k) or de novo clearances, PMAs or PMA supplements, or may require us to cease marketing or 
recall the modified products until clearances or approvals are obtained.

Any modification to a 510(k)-cleared device that could significantly affect its safety or effectiveness or that would constitute a major change in its 
intended use, requires a new 510(k) clearance or, possibly, a de novo request or approval of a PMA. The FDA requires every manufacturer to make this 
determination in the first instance, but the FDA may review any manufacturer’s decision. The FDA may not agree with our decisions regarding whether 
new  clearances  or  approvals  are  necessary.  We  have  modified  some  of  our  510(k)-cleared  products,  and  have  determined  based  on  our  review  of  the 
applicable  FDA  guidance  that  in  certain  instances  new  510(k)  clearances  or  PMAs  are  not  required.  If  the  FDA  disagrees  with  our  determination  and 
requires  us  to  submit  new  510(k)  notifications,  de novo  petitions,  PMAs  or  PMA  supplements  for  modifications  to  our  previously  cleared  products  for 
which we have concluded that new clearances or approvals are unnecessary, we may be required to cease marketing or to recall the modified product until 
we obtain clearance or approval, and we may be subject to significant regulatory fines or penalties.

31

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Our HCT/P products are subject to extensive government regulation and our failure to comply with these requirements could cause our business to 
suffer.

In the U.S., we are marketing our human tissue products as Section 361 HCT/Ps, which are not subject to FDA premarket clearance or approval 
requirements.  The  FDA  could  disagree  with  our  determination  that  our  human  tissue  products  are  Section  361  HCT/Ps  and  could  determine  that  these 
products are biologics requiring a biological license application approval or medical devices requiring 510(k) or de novo clearance or PMA approval, or 
New Drug Application approval. The FDA may then require that we cease marketing our human tissue products and/or recall the products unless and until 
we receive the appropriate clearance or approval from the FDA.

HCT/Ps also are subject to donor eligibility and screening, CGTP, product labeling, and post market reporting requirements. If we or our suppliers 
fail to comply with these requirements, we could be subject to FDA enforcement action, including, for example, warning letters, fines, injunctions, product 
recalls or seizures, and, in the most serious cases, criminal penalties.

If we or our suppliers fail to comply with the FDA’s good manufacturing practice regulations and similar international regulations, this could impair 
our ability to market our products in a cost-effective and timely manner.

We and our third-party suppliers are required to comply with the FDA’s QSR, which covers the methods and documentation of the design, testing, 
production,  control,  quality  assurance,  labeling,  packaging,  sterilization,  storage  and  shipping  of  our  products.  In  addition,  suppliers  and  processors  of 
allograft must comply with the CGTP, which govern the methods used in and the facilities and controls used for the manufacture of human cell tissue and 
cellular and tissue-based products, record-keeping and the establishment of a quality program.

The FDA audits compliance with the QSR and CGTP requirements through periodic announced and unannounced inspections of manufacturing 
and  other  facilities.  The  FDA  may  conduct  inspections  or  audits  at  any  time.  If  we  or  our  suppliers  have  significant  non-compliance  issues  or  if  any 
corrective  action  plan  that  we  or  our  suppliers  propose  in  response  to  observed  deficiencies  is  not  sufficient,  the  FDA  could  take  enforcement  action, 
including any of the following sanctions:

(cid:0) untitled letters, warning letters, fines, injunctions, consent decrees and civil penalties;
(cid:0) customer notifications or repair, replacement, refunds, recall, detention or seizure of our products;
(cid:0) operating restrictions or partial suspension or total shutdown of production;
(cid:0) refusing or delaying our requests for 510(k) or de novo clearance or PMA of new products or modified products;
(cid:0) withdrawing 510(k) or de novo clearances or PMAs that have already been granted;
(cid:0) refusal to grant export approval for our products; or
(cid:0) criminal prosecution.

Any of these sanctions could have a material adverse effect on our reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition.

Outside the U.S., our products and operations are also often required to comply with standards set by industrial standards bodies, such as the ISO. 
Foreign  regulatory  bodies  may  evaluate  our  products  or  the  testing  that  our  products  undergo  against  these  standards.  The  specific  standards,  types  of 
evaluation and scope of review differ among foreign regulatory bodies. We intend to comply with the standards enforced by such foreign regulatory bodies 
as needed to commercialize our products. If we fail to adequately comply with any of these standards, a foreign regulatory body may take adverse actions 
similar to those within the power of the FDA. Any such action may harm our reputation and business, and could have an adverse effect on our business, 
results of operations and financial condition.

A recall of our products, either voluntarily or at the direction of the FDA or another governmental authority, or the discovery of serious safety issues 
with our products, could have a significant adverse impact on us. 

The FDA and similar foreign governmental authorities have the authority to require the recall of commercialized products in the event of material 
deficiencies or defects in design or manufacture or in the event that a product poses an unacceptable risk to health. Manufacturers may, under their own 
initiative, recall a product if any material deficiency in a device is found. Even if voluntary, the FDA requires that a medical device manufacturer report to 
the FDA any corrective action or removal of a device initiated to reduce a risk to health posed by the device. A government-mandated or voluntary recall 
by  us  or  one  of  our  distributors  could  occur  as  a  result  of  risk  to  health,  component  failures,  manufacturing  errors,  design  or  labeling  defects  or  other 
deficiencies and issues. Recalls of any of our products would divert managerial and financial resources and have an adverse effect on our reputation, results 
of operations and financial condition, which could impair our ability to produce our products in a cost-effective and timely manner in order to meet our 
customers’ demands. We may also be required to bear other costs or take other actions that may have a negative impact on our future sales and our ability 
to generate profits.

32

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

In the EEA, we must comply with the EU Medical Device Vigilance System. Under this system, manufacturers are required to take Field Safety 
Corrective Actions (“FSCAs”) to reduce a risk of death or serious deterioration in the state of health associated with the use of a medical device that is 
already placed on the market. A FSCA may include the recall, modification, exchange, destruction or retrofitting of the device.

Any adverse event involving our products, whether in the U.S. or abroad, could result in future voluntary corrective actions, such as recalls or 
customer  notifications,  or  agency  action,  such  as  inspection,  mandatory  recall  or  other  enforcement  action.  Any  corrective  action,  whether  voluntary  or 
involuntary,  as  well  as  defending  ourselves  in  a  lawsuit,  will  require  the  dedication  of  our  time  and  capital,  distract  management  from  operating  our 
business and may harm our reputation and financial results.

We may be subject to enforcement action if we engage in the off-label promotion of our products.

Our promotional materials and training methods must comply with FDA and other applicable laws and regulations, including the prohibition of 
the promotion of off-label use. Physicians may use our products off-label, as the FDA does not restrict or regulate a physician’s choice of treatment within 
the practice of medicine. However, if the FDA determines that our promotional efforts constitutes promotion of an off-label use, it could request that we 
modify our training or promotional efforts or subject us to regulatory or enforcement actions, including the issuance of an untitled letter, a warning letter, 
injunction, seizure, civil penalties and criminal fines. It is also possible that other federal, state or foreign enforcement authorities, such as DOJ or HHS, 
might  take  action  if  they  consider  our  promotional  or  training  materials  to  constitute  promotion  of  an  unapproved/off-label  use,  which  could  result  in 
significant criminal and/or civil sanctions under other statutory authorities, such as laws prohibiting false claims for reimbursement (e.g., the FCA). In that 
event, our reputation could be damaged and adoption of the products would be impaired. Although our policy is to refrain from statements that could be 
considered off-label promotion of our products, the FDA, or another regulatory agency or a Relator under the FCA could disagree and allege that we have 
engaged in off-label promotion. In addition, the off-label use of our products may increase the risk of injury to patients, and, in turn, the risk of product 
liability claims. Claims under the FCA initiated either by a government regulatory or enforcement authority or by a Relator and product liability claims are 
expensive to defend and could divert our management’s attention, result in substantial damage awards against us and harm our reputation.

Governmental regulation and limited sources and suppliers could restrict our procurement and use of tissue.

In the U.S., the procurement and transplantation of allograft bone tissue is subject to federal law pursuant to the NOTA, a criminal statute which 
prohibits  the  purchase  and  sale  of  human  organs  used  in  human  transplantation,  including  bone  and  related  tissue,  for  “valuable  consideration.”  NOTA 
permits reasonable payments associated with the removal, transportation, processing, preservation, quality control, implantation and storage of human bone 
tissue. We provide services in all of these areas in the U.S., with the exception of removal and implantation, and receive payments for all such services. We 
make payments to tissue banks for their services related to recovering allograft bone tissue on our behalf. If NOTA is interpreted or enforced in a manner 
that prevents us from receiving payment for services we render or that prevents us from paying tissue banks or certain of our clients for the services they 
render for us, our business could be materially adversely affected. In addition, there is similar legislation in Europe and the UK which we must abide by, 
including  Directive  2004/23/EC  in  relation  to  human  tissues  and  cells  requiring  that  donation  be  unpaid  (except  for  expenses  and  inconvenience)  and 
voluntary.

We depend on a limited number of sources of human tissue for use in some of our regenerative biologics products and a limited number of entities 
to  process  the  human  tissue  for  use  in  those  regenerative  biologics  products,  and  any  failure  to  obtain  tissue  from  these  sources  or  to  have  the  tissue 
processed  by  these  entities  for  us  in  a  timely  manner  will  interfere  with  our  ability  to  effectively  meet  demand  for  our  regenerative  biologics  products 
incorporating  human  tissue.  Less  than  five  third-party  suppliers  currently  supply  all  of  our  needs  for  allograft  implants  and  products,  other  than  those 
implants and products that we process ourselves. The processing of human tissue into our regenerative biologics products is very labor-intensive and it is 
therefore difficult to maintain a steady supply stream. In addition, due to seasonal changes in mortality rates, some scarce tissues used in our regenerative 
biologics products are at times in particularly short supply. We cannot be certain that our current supply of human tissue and allograft implants, plus any 
additional source that we identify in the future, will be sufficient to meet our needs. Our dependence on a small number of third-party suppliers and the 
challenges we may face in obtaining adequate supplies of human tissue involve several risks, including limited control over pricing, availability, quality and 
delivery  schedules.  In  addition,  any  interruption  in  the  supply  of  any  human  tissue  component  could  materially  harm  our  and  our  third-party  suppliers’ 
ability  to  manufacture  our  regenerative  biologics  products  until  a  new  source  of  supply,  if  any,  could  be  found.  We  may  be  unable  to  find  a  sufficient 
alternative supply channel in a reasonable time period or on commercially reasonable terms, if at all, which would have a material adverse effect on our 
business, results of operations and financial condition.

33

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Negative  publicity  concerning  methods  of  tissue  recovery  and  screening  of  donor  tissue  in  our  industry  could  reduce  demand  for  our  regenerative 
biologics products and impact the supply of available donor tissue.

Media reports or other negative publicity concerning both alleged improper methods of tissue recovery from donors and disease transmission from 
donated tissue could limit widespread acceptance of some of our regenerative biologics products. Unfavorable reports of improper or illegal tissue recovery 
practices, both in the U.S.and internationally, as well as incidents of improperly processed tissue leading to the transmission of disease, may broadly affect 
the rate of future tissue donation and market acceptance of technologies incorporating human tissue. In addition, such negative publicity could cause the 
families of potential donors to become reluctant to agree to donate tissue to for-profit tissue processors. For example, the media has reported examples of 
alleged illegal harvesting of body parts from cadavers and resulting recalls conducted by certain companies selling human tissue-based products affected by
the alleged illegal harvesting. These reports and others could have a negative effect on our tissue regeneration business.

We are subject to environmental laws and regulations that can impose significant costs and expose us to potential financial liabilities.

The manufacture of certain of our products, including our allograft implants and products, and the handling of materials used in the product testing 
process, including in our cadaveric laboratory, involve the controlled use of biological, hazardous and/or radioactive materials and wastes. Our business and 
facilities and those of our suppliers are subject to foreign, federal, state and local laws and regulations relating to the protection of human health and the 
environment, including those governing the use, manufacture, storage, handling and disposal of, and exposure to, such materials and wastes. In addition, 
under some environmental laws and regulations, we could be held responsible for costs relating to any contamination at our past or present facilities and at 
third-party  waste  disposal  sites  even  if  such  contamination  was  not  caused  by  us.  A  failure  to  comply  with  current  or  future  environmental  laws  and 
regulations  could  result  in  severe  fines  or  penalties.  Any  such  expenses  or  liability  could  have  a  significant  negative  impact  on  our  business,  results  of 
operations and financial condition.

We  or  our  suppliers  may  be  the  subject  of  claims  for  non-compliance  with  FDA  regulations  in  connection  with  the  processing,  manufacturing  or 
distribution of our proposed allograft or other regenerative biologics implants and products.

Allegations may be made against us or against donor recovery groups or tissue banks, including those with which we have a contractual supplier 
relationship,  claiming  that  the  acquisition  or  processing  of  tissue  for  allograft  implants  and  products  or  other  regenerative  biologics  products  does  not 
comply with applicable FDA regulations or other relevant statutes and regulations. Allegations like these could cause regulators or other authorities to take 
investigative or other action against us or our suppliers, or could cause negative publicity for us or our industry generally. These actions or any negative 
publicity could cause us to incur substantial costs, divert the attention of our management from our business and harm our reputation.

We and our distributor sales representatives might be subject to claims for failing to comply with U.S. federal, state, local and foreign fraud and abuse 
laws, including anti-kickback laws and other anti-referral laws. 

There  are  numerous  U.S.  federal  and  state  laws  pertaining  to  healthcare  fraud  and  abuse,  including  anti-kickback  laws.  False  claims  laws  and 
physician self-referral laws. Our relationships with surgeons, hospitals and our independent distributors are subject to scrutiny under these laws. Violations 
of these laws are punishable by criminal and civil sanctions, including, in some instances, imprisonment and exclusion from participation in federal and 
state healthcare programs, including the Medicare, Medicaid and Veterans Administration health programs. Because of the broad and far-reaching nature of 
these laws, we may be required to alter or discontinue one or more of our business practices.

Healthcare fraud and abuse regulations are complex, and even minor irregularities can potentially give rise to claims that a statute or prohibition 

has been violated. Examples of laws that may affect our ability to operate include:

(cid:0) the Federal Anti-Kickback Statute, which prohibits, among other things, persons from knowingly and willfully soliciting, receiving, offering or 
paying remuneration, directly or indirectly, in exchange for, to induce or to reward either the referral of an individual for, or the purchase, order or 
recommendation of, any good or service for which payment may be made under federal healthcare programs such as the Medicare and Medicaid 
programs;

(cid:0) federal false claims laws which prohibit, among other things, individuals or entities from knowingly presenting, or causing to be presented, claims 

for payment to Medicare, Medicaid, or other government payors that are false or fraudulent;

(cid:0) HIPAA,  which  created  federal  criminal  laws  that  prohibit  executing  a  scheme  to  defraud  any  healthcare  benefit  program  or  making  false 

statements relating to healthcare matters;

(cid:0) the Federal Trade Commission Act and similar laws regulating advertisement and consumer protections;
(cid:0) the FCPA, which prohibits corrupt payments, gifts or transfers of value to foreign officials; 
(cid:0) the Physician Payment Sunshine Act, which requires medical device companies to report ownership and investment interests by physicians and 

members of their immediate family as well as certain payments and other transfers of value, including gifts 

34

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

and other benefits, provided to physicians and certain other healthcare professionals licensed in the U.S. and to teaching hospitals; and

(cid:0) foreign and U.S. state law and code equivalents of each of the above federal laws, such as anti-kickback and false claims laws and disclosure of 
transfers of value and gift bans with respect to healthcare professionals, some of which may apply to items or services reimbursed by any third-
party payor, including commercial insurers.

Possible  sanctions  for  violation  of  these  laws  include  monetary  penalties  and  other  civil  and  criminal  sanctions,  exclusion  from  Medicare  and 
Medicaid programs and forfeiture of amounts collected in violation of such prohibitions. Any violations of these laws, or any action against us for violation 
of  these  laws,  even  if  we  successfully  defend  against  it,  could  result  in  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our  reputation,  business,  results  of  operations  and 
financial condition.

We have entered into consulting, royalty and other agreements with surgeons, including some who make referrals to us. In addition, some of our 
referring surgeons own our stock, which they either purchased in an arm’s length transaction on terms identical to those offered to non-referral sources or 
received  from  us  as  fair  market  value  consideration  for  consulting  services  performed.  While  these  transactions  were  structured  with  the  intention  of 
complying with all applicable laws, including the federal ban on physician self-referrals, commonly known as the “Stark Law,” state anti-referral laws and 
other  applicable  anti-kickback  laws,  it  is  possible  that  regulatory  agencies  may  view  these  transactions  as  prohibited  arrangements  that  must  be 
restructured, or discontinued, or for which we could be subject to other significant penalties. Regulators also could prohibit us from accepting payment for 
products  ordered  or  recommended  by  these  surgeons.  We  would  be  materially  and  adversely  affected  if  regulatory  agencies  interpret  our  financial 
relationships with surgeons who order our products to be in violation of applicable laws and we were unable to comply with applicable laws. This could 
subject us to monetary penalties for non-compliance, the cost of which could be substantial.

To  enforce  compliance  with  the  federal  laws,  the  DOJ  has  increased  its  scrutiny  of  interactions  between  healthcare  companies  and  healthcare 
providers, which has led to a number of investigations, prosecutions, convictions and settlements in the healthcare industry. Dealing with investigations can 
be time- and resource-consuming and can divert management’s attention from the business. Additionally, if an investigation were initiated involving us and 
we decided to settle that investigation with the DOJ or other law enforcement agencies, we may be forced to agree to additional onerous and expensive 
compliance  and  reporting  requirements  for  a  period  of  years  as  part  of  a  consent  decree,  requirement  for  a  corporate  monitor  or  corporate  integrity 
agreement.  Any  such  investigation  or  settlement  could  increase  our  costs  or  otherwise  have  an  adverse  effect  on  our  business,  financial  condition  and 
results of operations.

In addition, there has been a recent trend of increased federal and state regulation on payments and other transfers of value made to healthcare 
professionals related to marketing and other activities. Some states mandate implementation of healthcare compliance programs, impose gift bans, and/or 
require the tracking and reporting of gifts, compensation and other remuneration to physicians and certain other U.S. licensed healthcare professionals and 
U.S. teaching hospitals. The shifting commercial compliance environment and the need to build and maintain robust and expandable systems to comply 
with different compliance and/or reporting requirements in multiple jurisdictions increase the possibility that a healthcare company may run afoul of one or 
more of the requirements.

The scope and enforcement of these laws is uncertain and subject to rapid change in the current environment of healthcare reform, especially in 
light  of  the  lack  of  applicable  precedent  and  regulations.  Federal  or  state  regulatory  and  enforcement  authorities  might  challenge  our  current  or  future 
activities  under  these  laws.  Plaintiffs’  attorneys  acting  on  behalf  of  FCA  Relators,  who  are  incentivized  to  pursue  claims  against  manufacturers  by  the 
potential to share in any monetary damages and penalties recovered by the government, also might initiate lawsuits that challenge our current or future 
activities under these laws. Any such challenges by regulatory authorities directly or by Relators suing on behalf of the government could have a material 
adverse effect on our reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition. In addition to the sanctions described above, any state or federal 
regulatory  review  or  FCA  lawsuit,  regardless  of  the  outcome,  would  be  costly  and  time-consuming  and  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our 
business, financial condition and results of operations.

35

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Risks Related to our International Operations

We may fail to obtain or maintain foreign regulatory approvals to market our products in other countries.

We  currently  market  our  products  internationally  and  intend  to  expand  our  international  marketing.  International  jurisdictions  require  separate 
regulatory approvals and compliance with numerous and varying regulatory requirements. For example, we intend to continue to seek regulatory clearance 
to market our primary products in the EEA, Japan, Brazil, Canada and other key markets. The approval procedures vary among countries and may involve 
requirements  for  additional  testing,  and  the  time  required  to  obtain  approval  may  differ  from  country  to  country  and  from  that  required  to  obtain  FDA 
clearance or approval.

Clearance  or  approval  by  the  FDA  does  not  ensure  approval  or  certification  by  regulatory  authorities  in  other  countries  or  jurisdictions,  and 
approval or certification by one foreign regulatory authority does not ensure approval or certification by regulatory authorities in other foreign countries or 
by the FDA. The foreign regulatory approval or certification process may include all of the risks associated with obtaining FDA clearance or approval. We 
may not obtain foreign regulatory approvals on a timely basis, if at all. We may not be able to file for regulatory approvals or certifications and may not 
receive necessary approvals to commercialize our products in any market. If we fail to receive necessary approvals or certifications to commercialize our 
products in foreign jurisdictions on a timely basis, or at all, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected.

Additionally, in the EEA, we must inform the Notified Body that carried out the conformity assessment of the medical devices we market or sell in 
the EEA of any planned substantial changes to our quality system or changes to our devices which could affect compliance with the essential requirements 
or the devices’ intended use. The Notified Body will then assess the changes and verify whether they affect the products’ conformity. If the assessment is 
not favorable, it could prevent us from selling that product in the EEA, which could adversely impact our business and results of operations. In addition, on 
January  1,  2021  the  UK  left  the  EU.  EU  CE  markings  for  medical  devices  will  continue  to  be  recognized  in  Great  Britain  until  June  30,  2028,  and 
certificates issued for medical devices by EU-recognized Notified Bodies will continue to be valid for the Great Britain market until June 30, 2028 and the 
EU  no  longer  recognizes  UK  Notified  Bodies.  The  UK  has  given  no  commitment  to  follow  the  new  EU  medical  devices  legislation  (Regulation  EU 
2017/745) and has recently consulted on the form and content of new UK legislation which may result in divergence from the EU regime.

We are subject to risks associated with our non-U.S. operations.

The FCPA and similar worldwide anti-bribery laws in non-U.S. jurisdictions generally prohibit companies and their intermediaries from making 
improper payments for the purpose of obtaining or retaining business. The FCPA also imposes accounting standards and requirements on publicly traded 
U.S. corporations and their foreign affiliates, which are intended to prevent the diversion of corporate funds to the payment of bribes and other improper 
payments, and to prevent the establishment of “off books” slush funds from which such improper payments can be made. Because of the predominance of 
government-sponsored healthcare systems around the world, many of our customer relationships outside of the U.S. are with governmental entities and are 
therefore subject to such anti-bribery laws. Our internal control policies and procedures may not always protect us from reckless or criminal acts committed 
by  our  employees  or  agents.  Violations  of  these  laws,  or  allegations  of  such  violations,  could  disrupt  our  operations,  involve  significant  management 
distraction  and  result  in  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our  business,  results  of  operations  and  financial  condition.  We  also  could  suffer  severe  penalties, 
including criminal and civil penalties, disgorgement and other remedial measures, including further changes or enhancements to our procedures, policies 
and controls, as well as potential personnel changes and disciplinary actions.

Furthermore,  we  are  subject  to  the  export  controls  and  economic  embargo  rules  and  regulations  of  the  U.S.,  including,  but  not  limited  to,  the 
Export Administration Regulations and trade sanctions against embargoed countries, which are administered by the Office of Foreign Assets Control within 
the Department of the Treasury, as well as the laws and regulations administered by the Department of Commerce. These regulations limit our ability to 
market, sell, distribute or otherwise transfer our products or technology to prohibited countries or persons. A determination that we have failed to comply, 
whether knowingly or inadvertently, may result in substantial penalties, including fines and enforcement actions and civil and/or criminal sanctions, the 
disgorgement of profits and the imposition of a court-appointed monitor, as well as the denial of export privileges, and may have an adverse effect on our 
reputation.

These and other factors may have a material adverse effect on our international operations or on our business, results of operations and financial 

condition generally.

Our results of operations could suffer if we are unable to manage our planned international expansion effectively.

Expansion  into  international  markets  is  an  element  of  our  business  strategy  and  involves  risk.  The  sale  and  shipment  of  our  products  across 
international borders, as well as the purchase of components and products from international sources, subject us to extensive U.S. and foreign governmental 
trade, import and export and customs regulations and laws. Compliance with these regulations 

36

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
and laws is costly and exposes us to penalties for non-compliance. Other laws and regulations that can significantly affect us include various anti-bribery 
laws,  including  the  FCPA  and  anti-boycott  laws.  Any  failure  to  comply  with  applicable  legal  and  regulatory  obligations  in  the  U.S.  or  abroad  could 
adversely affect us in a variety of ways that include, but are not limited to, significant criminal, civil and administrative penalties, including imprisonment 
of  individuals,  fines  and  penalties,  denial  of  export  privileges,  seizure  of  shipments  and  restrictions  on  certain  business  activities.  Also,  the  failure  to 
comply with applicable legal and regulatory obligations could result in the disruption of our distribution and sales activities.

Our international operations expose us and our independent distributors to risks inherent in operating in foreign jurisdictions, including:

(cid:0) exposure to different legal and regulatory standards;
(cid:0) lack of stringent protection of intellectual property;
(cid:0) obstacles to obtaining domestic and foreign export, import and other governmental approvals, permits and licenses and compliance with foreign 

laws;

(cid:0) potentially adverse tax consequences and the complexities of foreign value-added tax systems;
(cid:0) adverse changes in tariffs and trade restrictions;
(cid:0) foreign exchange rate risk;
(cid:0) limitations on the repatriation of earnings;
(cid:0) difficulties in staffing and managing foreign operations;
(cid:0) transportation delays and difficulties of managing international distribution channels;
(cid:0) longer collection periods and difficulties in collecting receivables from foreign entities;
(cid:0) increased financing costs; and
(cid:0) political, social and economic instability and increased security concerns.

These risks may limit or disrupt our expansion, restrict the movement of funds or result in the deprivation of contractual rights or the taking of 

property by nationalization or expropriation without fair compensation.

Our  goal  of  succeeding  as  an  international  company  depends,  in  part,  on  our  ability  to  develop  and  implement  policies  and  strategies  that  are 
effective in anticipating and managing these and other risks in the countries in which we do business. Failure to manage these and other risks may have a 
material adverse effect on our operations in any particular country and on our business as a whole.

We are subject to risks arising from currency exchange rate fluctuations on our international transactions and translation of local currency results into 
U.S. dollars, which could adversely affect our profitability.

International operations account for approximately 18.4% of our total net sales, and we intend to continue to expand our international presence. A 
significant portion of our foreign revenues and expenses are generated in Japan, the Euro zone, UK and Australia. As our reporting currency is the U.S. 
dollar, significant changes in currency exchange rates can result in increased exposure to foreign exchange effects on our consolidated results of operations.  
We cannot predict changes in currency exchange rates, the impact of exchange rate changes, nor the degree to which we will be able to manage the impact 
of currency exchange rate changes.

Risks Related to our Financial Results and Need for Financing

We will need to generate significant sales to remain profitable.

We  intend  to  increase  our  operating  expenses  substantially  as  we  add  sales  representatives  and  distributors  to  increase  our  geographic  sales 
coverage,  submit  additional  investigational  device  exemption  applications  to  the  FDA,  increase  our  marketing  capabilities,  conduct  clinical  trials  and
increase our general and administrative functions to support our growing operations. We will need to generate significant sales to maintain profitability and 
we might not be able to do so. Even if we do generate significant sales, we might not be able to sustain or increase profitability on a quarterly or annual 
basis in the future. If our sales grow more slowly than we anticipate or if our operating expenses exceed our expectations, our business, financial condition 
and results of operations will likely be adversely affected.

We may be unable to grow our revenue or earnings as anticipated, which may have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.

We  have  experienced  rapid  growth  since  our  inception  and  increased  our  net  sales  to  $1,568.5  million  in  2023. Our  ability  to  achieve  future 
growth will depend upon, among other things, the success of our growth strategies, which we cannot assure will be successful. In addition, we may have 
more difficulty maintaining our historical or prior rate of growth of revenues, profitability or cash 

37

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
flows. Our future success will depend upon numerous factors, including the strength of our brand, the market success of our current and future products, 
competitive conditions, our ability to attract and retain our employees and our ability to manage our business and implement our growth strategy. If we are 
unable  to  achieve  future  growth,  our  business,  financial  condition  and  results  of  operations  could  be  adversely  affected.  In  addition,  we  anticipate 
significantly expanding our infrastructure and adding personnel in connection with our anticipated growth, which we expect will cause our selling, general 
and administrative expenses to increase, which could adversely impact our results of operations.

Our quarterly and annual operating results may fluctuate significantly.

Our operating results are difficult to predict and may be subject to periodic fluctuations. Our sales and results of operations will be affected by 

numerous factors, including:

(cid:0) our ability to drive increased sales of our products;
(cid:0) our ability to establish and maintain an effective and dedicated sales force;
(cid:0) pricing pressure applicable to our products, including adverse third-party coverage and reimbursement outcomes;
(cid:0) results of clinical research and trials on our existing products and products in development;
(cid:0) the mix of our products sold because profit margins differ amongst our products;
(cid:0) timing of new product offerings, acquisitions, licenses or other significant events by us or our competitors;
(cid:0) the ability of our suppliers to timely provide us with an adequate supply of materials and components;
(cid:0) the evolving product offerings of our competitors;
(cid:0) regulatory approvals and legislative changes affecting the products we may offer or those of our competitors;
(cid:0) interruption in the manufacturing or distribution of our products;
(cid:0) the effect of competing technological, industry and market developments;
(cid:0) changes in our ability to obtain regulatory clearance or approval for our products; and
(cid:0) our ability to expand the geographic reach of our sales and marketing efforts.

Many of the products we may seek to develop and introduce in the future will require FDA approval or clearance before commercialization in the 
U.S., and commercialization of such products outside of the U.S. would likely require additional regulatory approvals and import licenses. As a result, it 
will be difficult for us to forecast demand for these products with any degree of certainty. In addition, we will be increasing our operating expenses as we 
expand  our  commercial  capabilities.  Accordingly,  we  may  experience  significant,  unanticipated  quarterly  or  annual  losses.  If  our  quarterly  or  annual 
operating  results  fall  below  the  expectations  of  investors  or  securities  analysts,  the  price  of  our  Class  A  common  stock  could  decline  substantially. 
Furthermore,  any  quarterly  or  annual  fluctuations  in  our  operating  results  may,  in  turn,  cause  the  price  of  our  Class  A  common  stock  to  fluctuate 
substantially. We believe that quarterly comparisons of our financial results are not necessarily meaningful and should not be relied upon as an indication of 
our future performance.

Negative trends in the general economy, including interest rate fluctuations, increases in inflation, and financial market volatility may adversely 
affect our business and financial performance. If inflation in the cost of raw materials increases beyond our ability to manage it, we may not be able to 
adjust prices sufficiently to offset the effect of the various cost increases without negatively impacting our consumer demand. 

We have a significant amount of outstanding indebtedness, and our financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected if we do 
not effectively manage our liabilities.

As of December 31, 2023, we had outstanding $450.0 million aggregate principal amount of our 0.375% Convertible Senior Notes due March 15, 

2025, (the “2025 Notes”). This significant amount of debt has important risks to us and our investors, including:

(cid:0) requiring a portion of our cash flow from operations to make interest payments on this debt;
(cid:0) increasing our vulnerability to general adverse economic and industry conditions;
(cid:0) reducing the cash flow available to fund capital expenditures and other corporate purposes and to grow our business;
(cid:0) limiting our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and the industry; and
(cid:0) limiting our ability to borrow additional funds as needed or take advantage of business opportunities as they arise.

The availability of funding under existing credit arrangements may be limited, and our cash and cash equivalents are subject to volatility.

Any lender that is obligated to provide funding to us under any now existing or future credit agreement with us may not be able to provide funding 

in a timely manner, or at all, when we require it. The cost of, or lack of, available credit or equity financing could 

38

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
impact our ability to develop sufficient liquidity to maintain or grow our company, which in turn may adversely affect our business, results of operations or 
financial  condition.  We  also  manage  cash  and  cash  equivalents  and  short-term  investments  through  various  institutions.  There  may  be  a  risk  of  loss  on 
investments  based  on  the  volatility  of  the  underlying  instruments  that  will  prevent  us  from  recovering  the  full  principal  of  our  investments.  Negative 
changes in domestic and global economic conditions or disruptions of either or both of the financial and credit markets may also affect third-party payors 
and may have a material adverse effect on our stock price, business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity.

Our future capital needs are uncertain and we may need to raise funds in the future, and such funds may not be available on acceptable terms or at all.

Continued  expansion  of  our  business  will  be  expensive  and  we  may  seek  funds  from  public  and  private  stock  offerings,  borrowings  under  our 

existing or future credit facilities or other sources. Our capital requirements will depend on many factors, including:

(cid:0) the revenues generated by sales of our products;
(cid:0) the costs associated with expanding our sales and marketing efforts;
(cid:0) the expenses we incur in manufacturing and selling our products;
(cid:0) the costs of developing and commercializing new products or technologies;
(cid:0) the cost of obtaining and maintaining regulatory approval or clearance of our products and products in development;
(cid:0) the number and timing of acquisitions and other strategic transactions;
(cid:0) the costs associated with our planned international expansion;
(cid:0) the costs associated with increased capital expenditures, including fixed asset purchases of instrument sets which we loan to hospitals to support 

surgeries; and

(cid:0) unanticipated general and administrative expenses.

As a result of these factors, we may seek to raise capital, and such capital may not be available on favorable terms, or at all. Furthermore, if we 
issue equity or debt securities to raise capital, our existing stockholders may experience dilution, and the new equity or debt securities may have rights, 
preferences  and  privileges  senior  to  those  of  our  existing  stockholders.  In  addition,  if  we  raise  capital  through  collaboration,  licensing  or  other  similar 
arrangements, it may be necessary to relinquish valuable rights to our products, potential products or proprietary technologies, or grant licenses on terms 
that are not favorable to us. If we cannot raise capital on acceptable terms, we may not be able to develop or enhance our products, execute our business 
plan,  take  advantage  of  future  opportunities,  or  respond  to  competitive  pressures,  changes  in  our  supplier  relationships,  or  unanticipated  customer 
requirements. Any of these events could adversely affect our ability to achieve our development and commercialization goals, which could have a material 
adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

Our existing revolving credit facility contains restrictive covenants that may limit our operating flexibility.

Our existing revolving credit facility contains certain restrictive covenants that could limit our ability to transfer or dispose of assets, merge with 
other companies or consummate certain changes of control, acquire other companies, pay dividends, incur additional indebtedness and liens, experience 
changes in management and enter into new businesses. We therefore may not be able to engage in any of the foregoing transactions unless we obtain the 
consent of the lender or terminate the revolving credit facility. There is no guarantee that we will be able to generate sufficient cash flow or sales to meet 
the financial covenants or pay the principal and interest on any such debt. Furthermore, there is no guarantee that future working capital, borrowings or 
equity financing will be available to repay or refinance any such debt.

Risks Related to our Intellectual Property and Potential Litigation

Our ability to protect our intellectual property and proprietary technology is uncertain.

We  rely  primarily  on  patent,  copyright,  trademark  and  trade  secret  laws,  as  well  as  confidentiality  and  non-disclosure  agreements  and  other 
methods, to protect our proprietary technologies and know-how. We have applied for patent protection relating to certain existing and proposed products 
and processes. While we generally apply for patents in those countries where we intend to make, have made, use or sell patented products, we may not 
accurately predict all of the countries where patent protection will ultimately be desirable. If we fail to timely file a patent application in any such country, 
we may be precluded from doing so at a later date. Furthermore, we cannot assure you that any of our patent applications will be approved. The rights 
granted  to  us  under  our  patents,  including  prospective  rights  sought  in  our  pending  patent  applications,  may  not  be  meaningful  or  provide  us  with  any 
commercial  advantage  and  they  could  be  opposed,  contested  or  circumvented  by  our  competitors  or  be  declared  invalid  or  unenforceable  in  judicial  or 
administrative proceedings. The failure of our patents to adequately protect our technology might make it easier for our competitors to offer the same or 
similar products or technologies. Competitors may be able to design around our patents or develop products that provide outcomes which are comparable to 
ours without infringing on our intellectual property rights. We have entered into 

39

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
confidentiality  agreements  and  intellectual  property  assignment  agreements  with  our  officers,  employees,  consultants  and  advisors  regarding  our 
intellectual  property  and  proprietary  technology.  In  the  event  of  unauthorized  use  or  disclosure  or  other  breaches  of  such  agreements,  we  may  not  be 
provided with meaningful protection for our trade secrets or other proprietary information. Due to differences between foreign and U.S. patent laws, our 
patented intellectual property rights may not receive the same degree of protection in foreign countries as they would in the U.S. Even if patents are granted 
outside the U.S., effective enforcement in those countries may not be available. Since most of our issued patents and pending patent applications are for the 
U.S. only, we lack a corresponding scope of patent protection in other countries. In countries where we do not have significant patent protection, we may 
not be able to stop a competitor from marketing products in such countries that are the same as or similar to our products.

We rely on our trademarks, trade names and brand names to distinguish our products from the products of our competitors, and have registered or 
applied to register many of these trademarks. We cannot assure you that our trademark applications will be approved. Third parties may also oppose our 
trademark applications, or otherwise challenge our use of the trademarks. In the event that our trademarks are successfully challenged, we could be forced 
to rebrand our products, which could result in loss of brand recognition, and could require us to devote resources to advertising and marketing new brands. 
Further, we cannot assure you that competitors will not infringe upon our trademarks, or that we will have adequate resources to enforce our trademarks.

If a competitor infringes upon one of our patents, trademarks or other intellectual property rights, enforcing those patents, trademarks and other 
rights  may  be  difficult  and  time  consuming.  Even  if  successful,  litigation  to  defend  our  patents  and  trademarks  against  challenges  or  to  enforce  our 
intellectual property rights could be expensive and time consuming and could divert management’s attention from managing our business. Moreover, we 
may not have sufficient resources or desire to defend our patents or trademarks against challenges or to enforce our intellectual property rights.

The medical device industry is characterized by patent litigation and we could become subject to litigation that could be costly, result in the diversion of 
management’s time and efforts, require us to pay damages, and/or prevent us from marketing our existing or future products. 

Our  commercial  success  will  depend  in  part  on  not  infringing  the  patents  or  violating  the  other  proprietary  rights  of  third  parties.  Significant 
litigation regarding patent rights exists in our industry. Our competitors in both the U.S. and abroad, many of which have substantially greater resources 
and have made substantial investments in competing technologies, may have applied for or obtained or may in the future apply for and obtain, patents that 
will prevent, limit or otherwise interfere with our ability to make and sell our products. We have not conducted an independent review of patents issued to 
third parties. The large number of patents, the rapid rate of new patent issuances, the complexities of the technology involved and uncertainty of litigation 
increase the risk of business assets and management’s attention being diverted to patent litigation. We have received in the past, and expect to receive in the 
future,  communications  from  various  industry  participants  alleging  our  infringement  of  their  patents,  trade  secrets  or  other  intellectual  property  rights 
and/or offering licenses to such intellectual property. We are currently subject to lawsuits, and have received other written allegations, claiming that we 
have  infringed  certain  patents  of  others  in  the  spine  industry.  A  summary  of  these  cases  is  provided  under  “Item  3.  Legal  Proceedings”  below.  Any 
lawsuits resulting from such allegations could subject us to significant liability for damages, and invalidate our proprietary rights. Any potential intellectual 
property litigation also could force us to do one or more of the following:

(cid:0) stop selling products or using technology that contains the allegedly infringing intellectual property;
(cid:0) lose  the  opportunity  to  license  our  technology  to  others  or  to  collect  royalty  payments  based  upon  successful  protection  and  assertion  of  our 

intellectual property rights against others;

(cid:0) incur significant legal expenses;
(cid:0) pay substantial damages to the party whose intellectual property rights we may be found to be infringing;
(cid:0) redesign those products that contain the allegedly infringing intellectual property, which could be costly and disruptive; or
(cid:0) attempt to obtain a license to the relevant intellectual property from third parties, which may not be available on reasonable terms or at all.

Any litigation or claim against us, even those without merit, may cause us to incur substantial costs, and could place a significant strain on our 
financial  resources,  divert  the  attention  of  management  from  our  core  business,  and  harm  our  reputation.  Further,  as  the  number  of  participants  in  the 
musculoskeletal industry grows, the possibility of intellectual property infringement claims against us increases. If we are found to infringe the intellectual 
property  rights  of  third  parties,  we  could  be  required  to  pay  substantial  damages  (including  treble,  or  triple,  damages  if  an  infringement  is  found  to  be 
willful)  and/or  royalties  and  could  be  prevented  from  selling  our  products  unless  we  obtain  a  license  or  are  able  to  redesign  our  products  to  avoid 
infringement. Any such license may not be available on reasonable terms, if at all, and there can be no assurance that we would be able to redesign our 
products in a way that would not infringe the intellectual property rights of others. If we fail to obtain any required licenses or make any necessary changes 
to  our  products  or  technologies,  we  may  have  to  withdraw  existing  products  from  the  market  or  may  be  unable  to  commercialize  one  or  more  of  our 
products, all of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

40

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Further, in the course of our regular review of pending legal matters, we determine whether it is probable that a potential loss relating to a legal 
proceeding  may  have  a  material  impact  on  our  business,  financial  performance  or  cash  position.    However,  estimates  of  probable  losses  are  inherently 
uncertain, and even if we determine that a loss is probable, in accordance with authoritative accounting guidance, if we are unable to estimate the possible 
loss or range of loss, we do not record an accrual related to such litigation.  As a result of this accounting policy, we may experience variability in our 
results of operations if damages for which we are found liable exceed the amounts we have accrued. 

In addition, we generally indemnify our customers and distributors with respect to infringement by our products of the proprietary rights of third 
parties. Third parties may assert infringement claims against our customers or distributors. These claims may require us to initiate or defend protracted and 
costly litigation on behalf of our customers or distributors, regardless of the merits of these claims. If any of these claims succeed, we may be forced to pay 
damages  on  behalf  of  our  customers  or  distributors  or  may  be  required  to  obtain  licenses  for  the  products  they  use.  If  we  cannot  obtain  all  necessary 
licenses on commercially reasonable terms, our customers may be forced to stop using our products.

We may be subject to damages resulting from claims that we, our employees or our independent distributors have wrongfully used or disclosed alleged 
trade secrets, proprietary or confidential information of our competitors or are in breach of non-competition or non-solicitation agreements with our 
competitors.

Many of our employees were previously employed at other medical device companies, including our competitors or potential competitors, in some 
cases until recently. Many of our independent distributors sell, or in the past have sold, products of our competitors. We may be subject to claims that we, 
our  employees,  or  our  independent  distributors  have  inadvertently  or  otherwise  used  or  disclosed  trade  secrets  or  other  proprietary  information  of  these 
former employers or competitors. In addition, we have been and may in the future be subject to claims that we caused an employee to breach the terms of 
his  or  her  non-competition  or  non-solicitation  agreement.  Litigation  may  be  necessary  to  defend  against  these  claims.  Even  if  we  are  successful  in 
defending against these claims, litigation could result in substantial costs and could be a distraction to management. If our defense to those claims fails, in 
addition to paying monetary damages, we may lose valuable personnel. There can be no assurance that this type of litigation will not continue, and any
future litigation or the threat thereof may adversely affect our ability to hire additional direct sales representatives. A loss of key personnel or their work 
product could hamper or prevent our ability to commercialize product candidates, which could have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations 
and financial condition.

We may incur product liability losses and insurance coverage may be inadequate or unavailable to cover these losses.

Our business exposes us to potential product liability claims that are inherent in the testing, design, manufacture and sale of medical devices for 
surgical procedures. The development of allograft implants and technologies for human tissue repair and treatment may entail particular risk of transmitting 
diseases  to  human  recipients,  which  could  result  in  the  assertion  of  substantial  product  liability  claims  against  us.  Surgery  involves  significant  risk  of 
serious complications, including bleeding, nerve injury, paralysis and even death. In addition, if longer-term patient results and experience indicates that our 
products  or  any  component  of  a  product  cause  tissue  damage,  motor  impairment  or  other  adverse  effects,  we  could  be  subject  to  significant  liability. 
Furthermore, if surgeons are not sufficiently trained in the use of our products, they may misuse or ineffectively use our products, which may result in 
unsatisfactory patient outcomes or patient injury. We could become the subject of product liability lawsuits alleging that component failures, manufacturing 
flaws, design defects or inadequate disclosure of product-related risks or product-related information resulted in an unsafe condition or injury to patients. 
The  medical  devices  industry  has  been  particularly  prone  to  potential  product  liability  claims  that  are  inherent  in  the  testing,  manufacture  and  sale  of 
medical devices and products for surgery procedures.

A product liability or other damages claim, product recall or product misuse, regardless of the outcome, could require us to spend significant time 
and money in litigation or to pay significant damages or costs, and could seriously harm our business. If our product liability insurance is inadequate to pay 
a damages award, we may have to pay the excess out of our cash reserves, which may harm our financial condition. Any product liability claim brought 
against us, with or without merit, could result in the increase of the costs we incur to obtain product liability insurance or our inability to secure product 
liability coverage in the future. If any of our products are found to cause tissue damage, motor impairment or other adverse effects, we could be subject to 
significant liability. Even a meritless or unsuccessful product liability claim could harm our reputation in the industry, impair our ability to sell one or more 
of  our  products  in  the  future,  result  in  significant  legal  fees  and  cause  significant  diversion  of  management’s  attention  from  managing  our  business.  A 
product  liability  or  other  claim,  product  recall,  or  product  misuse  involving  any  of  our  products,  whether  or  not  meritorious,  could  also  materially  and
adversely harm our reputation and our ability to attract and retain customers.

In addition, any product liability claim brought against us, with or without merit, could result in an increase of our product liability insurance rates. 
Insurance coverage varies in cost and can be difficult to obtain, and we cannot guarantee that we will be able to obtain insurance coverage in the future on 
terms acceptable to us or at all.

41

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Risks Related to the Ownership of our Class A Common Stock

Because of their significant stock ownership, our Executive Chairman, our chief executive officer, our other executive officers, and our directors and 
principal stockholders will be able to exert control over us and our significant corporate decisions.

Because of their significant stock ownership, our Executive Chairman, our chief executive officer, our other executive officers, and our directors 
will be able to exert substantial control over us and our significant corporate decisions. Based on an aggregate of 136,335,662 shares of our Class A and 
Class B common stock outstanding as of December 31, 2023, our executive officers and directors and their affiliates beneficially owned, in the aggregate, 
approximately 66.1% of the voting power of our outstanding capital stock. In particular, as of December 31, 2023, David C. Paul, our Executive Chairman, 
and  his  family  members,  controlled  approximately  16.3%  of  our  Class  A  and  Class  B  common  stock,  representing  approximately  65.8%  of  the  voting 
power of our outstanding capital stock as of that date.

As a result, David C. Paul has, and these persons acting together have, the ability to significantly influence or determine the outcome of all matters 
submitted to our stockholders for approval, including the election and removal of directors and any merger, consolidation, or sale of all or substantially all 
of our assets. Furthermore, as of December 31, 2023, we had 192,602,552 shares of Class B common stock available for issuance. This amount exceeds 5% 
of  our  outstanding  common  stock,  meaning  our  Board  of  Directors  (“Board”)  could  issue  Class  B  common  stock  without  necessarily  triggering  the 
automatic conversion of that Class B common stock to Class A common stock that, pursuant to our charter, will occur when any holder’s shares of Class B 
common stock represents less than 5% of the aggregate number of all outstanding shares of our common stock, thereby further concentrating the voting 
power of our capital stock in a limited number of stockholders.

The interests of our executive officers, directors and principal stockholders might not coincide with the interests of the other holders of our capital 

stock. This concentration of ownership may harm the value of our Class A common stock by, among other things:

(cid:0) delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of our company;
(cid:0) impeding a merger, consolidation, takeover or other business combination involving our company; or
(cid:0) causing us to enter into transactions or agreements that are not in the best interests of all stockholders.

We are a “controlled company” within the meaning of the New York Stock Exchange Rules, and we take, and intend to continue to take, advantage of 
exemptions from certain corporate governance requirements.

David C. Paul, alone, and our management, directors and significant stockholders, collectively, beneficially own a majority of the voting power of 
our  outstanding  common  stock.  Under  the  New  York  Stock  Exchange  Rules,  a  company  of  which  more  than  50%  of  the  voting  power  is  held  by  an 
individual, group or another company is a “controlled company” and may elect not to comply with certain corporate governance requirements, including 
the  requirement  that  a  majority  of  our  directors  be  independent,  as  defined  in  the  New  York  Stock  Exchange  Rules,  and  the  requirement  that  our 
compensation and nominating and corporate governance committees consist entirely of independent directors. We rely, and intend to continue to rely, on 
the  “controlled  company”  exemption  under  the  New  York  Stock  Exchange  Rules.  As  a  result,  a  majority  of  the  members  of  our  Board  may  not  be 
independent  directors  and  our  nominating  and  corporate  governance  and  compensation  committees  will  not  consist  entirely  of  independent  directors. 
Accordingly, while we remain a controlled company and during any transition period following a time when we are no longer a controlled company, you 
will not have the same protections afforded to stockholders of companies that are subject to all of the New York Stock Exchange’s corporate governance 
requirements.

Our Board is authorized to issue and designate shares of our preferred stock in additional series without stockholder approval.

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation authorizes our Board, without the approval of our stockholders, to issue 35 million shares of 
our preferred stock, subject to limitations prescribed by applicable law, rules and regulations and the provisions of our amended and restated certificate of 
incorporation, as shares of preferred stock in series, and to establish from time to time the number of shares to be included in each such series, and to fix the 
designation,  powers,  preferences  and  rights  of  the  shares  of  each  such  series  and  the  qualifications,  limitations  or  restrictions  thereof.  The  powers, 
preferences and rights of these additional series of preferred stock may be senior to or on parity with our Class A common stock, which may reduce its 
value.

Anti-takeover  provisions  in  our  organizational  documents  and  Delaware  law  may  discourage  or  prevent  a  change  of  control,  even  if  an  acquisition 
would  be  beneficial  to  our  stockholders,  which  could  depress  the  price  of  our  Class  A  common  stock  and  prevent  attempts  by  our  stockholders  to 
replace or remove our current management.

Our  amended  and  restated  certificate  of  incorporation  and  amended  and  restated  bylaws  contain  other  provisions  that  could  delay  or  prevent  a 

change of control of our company or changes in our Board that our stockholders might consider favorable.

42

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

In addition, we are subject to the provisions of Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law regulating corporate takeovers, which may 
restrict  or  prohibit  certain  business  combination  transactions  with  stockholders  owning  15%  or  more  of  our  outstanding  voting  stock,  including 
discouraging takeover attempts that might result in a premium over the market price for shares of our Class A common stock.

Section 203 and other provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, amended and restated bylaws and Delaware law could 
make it more difficult for stockholders or potential acquirers to obtain control of our Board or initiate actions that are opposed by our then-current Board, 
including delay or impede a merger, tender offer, or proxy contest involving our company. The existence of these provisions could negatively affect the 
price of our Class A common stock and limit opportunities for you to realize value in a corporate transaction.

General Risk Factors

If we do not successfully implement our business strategy, our business and results of operations will be adversely affected.

Our  business  strategy  was  formed  based  on  assumptions  that  might  prove  wrong.  We  believe  that  various  demographics  and  industry-specific 
trends  will  help  drive  growth  in  our  markets  and  our  business,  but  these  demographics  and  trends  are  uncertain.  Actual  demand  for  our  products  could 
differ materially from projected demand if our assumptions regarding these factors prove to be incorrect or do not materialize, or if alternative treatments to 
those offered by our products gain widespread acceptance.

We  may  not  be  able  to  successfully  implement  our  business  strategy.  To  implement  our  business  strategy,  we  need  to,  among  other  things, 
strengthen our brand, develop and introduce new musculoskeletal surgery products, find new applications for and improve our existing products, obtain 
regulatory clearance or approval for new products and applications and educate surgeons about the clinical and cost benefits of our products, all of which 
we believe could increase acceptance of our products by surgeons. Our strategy of focusing exclusively on the medical devices market may limit our ability 
to grow. In addition, we are seeking to increase our sales and, in order to do so, will need to commercialize additional products and expand our direct and 
distributor  sales  forces  in  existing  and  new  territories,  all  of  which  could  result  in  our  becoming  subject  to  additional  or  different  domestic  and  foreign 
regulatory  requirements,  with  which  we  may  not  be  able  to  comply.  Moreover,  even  if  we  successfully  implement  our  business  strategy,  our  operating 
results may not improve or may decline. We may decide to alter or discontinue aspects of our business strategy and may adopt different strategies due to 
business or competitive factors not currently foreseen, such as new medical technologies that would make our products obsolete. Any failure to implement
our business strategy may adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.

If we fail to properly manage our anticipated growth, our business could suffer.

Our rapid growth has placed, and will continue to place, a significant strain on our management and on our operational and financial resources and 
systems. Failure to manage our growth effectively could cause us to over-invest or under-invest in infrastructure, and result in losses or weaknesses in our 
infrastructure, which could materially adversely affect us. Additionally, our anticipated growth will increase the demands placed on our suppliers, resulting 
in an increased need for us to carefully monitor for quality assurance. Any failure by us to manage our growth effectively could have an adverse effect on 
our ability to achieve our development and commercialization goals.

Fluctuations in insurance cost and availability could adversely affect our profitability or our risk management profile.

We  hold  a  number  of  insurance  policies,  including  product  liability  insurance,  directors’  and  officers’  liability  insurance,  property  insurance, 
health  insurance  and  workers’  compensation  insurance.  If  the  costs  of  maintaining  adequate  insurance  coverage  increase  significantly  in  the  future,  our 
operating results could be materially adversely affected. Likewise, if any of our current insurance coverage should become unavailable to us or become 
economically  impractical,  we  would  be  required  to  operate  our  business  without  indemnity  from  commercial  insurance  providers.  If  we  operate  our 
business  without  insurance,  we  could  be  responsible  for  paying  claims  or  judgments  against  us  that  would  have  otherwise  been  covered  by  insurance, 
which could adversely affect our results of operations or financial condition.

We are exposed to the credit risk of some of our customers, which could result in material losses.

Our  business  is  subject  to  the  risk  of  nonpayment  by  our  customers.  We  sell  our  Enabling  Technologies  products  through  various  credit  and 

installment payment arrangements. We may experience loss from a customer’s failure to make payments according to the contractual terms. 

43

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Although we have systems in place to monitor and mitigate the associated risk, there can be no assurance that such systems will be effective in 
reducing  the  credit  risk  relating  to  the  sale  of  our  Enabling  Technologies  products.  If  the  level  of  credit  losses  we  experience  in  the  future  exceed  our 
expectations, such losses could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations.

The widespread outbreak of a communicable disease, or any other public health crisis, could adversely affect our financial condition and results of 
operations.

We could be negatively affected by the widespread outbreak of a communicable disease, or any other public health crisis that results in disruptions 

to hospitals and other healthcare facilities.

A novel strain of coronavirus was first identified in Wuhan, China in December 2019, and the disease caused by it, COVID-19, was subsequently
declared a pandemic by the World Health Organization in March 2020. The preventative and precautionary measures that hospitals and federal, state, local, 
and  international  governments  took  to  mitigate  the  spread  of  the  disease  led  to  restrictions  on,  disruptions  in,  and  other  related  impacts  on  elective
procedure rates. On May 5, 2023 the World Health Organization declared the end of the COVID-19 pandemic as a public health emergency.

The worldwide supply chain disruption relating to the COVID-19 pandemic resulted in delays and component shortages that impacted and may 
continue to impact our ability to manufacture our products by extending our lead times. These disruptions, or disruptions from future pandemics, among 
other things, may continue to impact our ability to satisfy customer demand, which could negatively impact our results of operations.

Most jurisdictions have relaxed restrictions and resumed business operations, but a resurgence in infections or mutations of the coronavirus that 
causes  COVID-19  could  cause  governments,  hospitals,  public  institutions,  or  other  authorities  to  reinstate  such  restrictions  or  impose  additional 
restrictions.  If a resurgence occurs, or a new pandemic arises, and governments mandate restrictions, including restrictions on elective surgeries, we expect 
that it could have a material adverse impact on our revenue growth, operating profit and cash flow, leading to revised payment terms with certain of our 
customers, and could change the effective tax rate driven by changes in the mix of earnings across the Company’s jurisdictions.

Risks Relating to the Integration of NuVasive

Integrating the NuVasive business into Globus may be more difficult, costly or time-consuming than expected and the Company may fail to realize the 
anticipated  benefits  of  the  Merger,  which  may  adversely  affect  the  Company’s  business  results  and  negatively  affect  the  value  of  the  Company’s 
common stock.

The success of the Merger will depend on, among other things, our ability to realize the anticipated synergies, efficiencies and other benefits from 
combining the businesses of Globus and NuVasive. This success will depend on, among other factors, our ability to successfully integrate the Company’s 
business  with  the  business  of  NuVasive.  If  we  are  not  able  to  successfully  integrate  NuVasive’s  business  into  the  Company  within  the  anticipated 
timeframe, or at all, the anticipated synergies, efficiencies and other benefits of the Merger may not be realized fully, or at all, or may take longer to realize 
than expected.

An inability to realize the full extent of the anticipated benefits of the Merger, as well as any delays encountered in the integration process, could 
have an adverse effect upon the revenues, level of expenses and operating results of the Company, which may adversely affect the value of the common 
stock of the Company. 

There can be no assurances that the NuVasive business can be integrated successfully. It is possible that the integration process could result in the 
loss  of  key  employees,  the  loss  of  customers,  the  disruption  of  the  Company’s  business,  inconsistencies  in  standards,  controls,  procedures  and  policies, 
unexpected  integration  issues,  higher  than  expected  integration  costs  and  an  overall  post-Merger  integration  process  that  takes  longer  than  originally 
anticipated. The challenges involved in this integration, which will be complex and time-consuming, include the following:

(cid:0) combining the businesses of Globus and NuVasive, including respective operations and corporate functions, and meeting the capital requirements 
of the Company in a manner that permits the Company to achieve any revenue synergies or efficiencies anticipated to result from the Merger, the 
failure of which would result in the anticipated benefits of the Merger not being realized in the timeframe currently anticipated or at all;

(cid:0) integrating  and  retaining  personnel  from  the  two  companies  while  continuing  to  provide  consistent,  high-quality  products  and  services  to 

customers;

(cid:0) integrating each company’s technologies and technologies licensed by them from third parties;
(cid:0) identifying and eliminating redundant and underperforming functions and assets; 

44

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

(cid:0) harmonizing each company’s operating practices, employee development and compensation programs, financial reporting, internal controls and 

other policies, procedures and processes;

(cid:0) maintaining existing agreements with each company’s business partners, surgeons, suppliers and vendors, avoiding delays in entering into new 
agreements with prospective business partners, surgeons, suppliers and vendors, and leveraging relationships with such third parties for the benefit 
of the Company;

(cid:0) addressing possible differences in business backgrounds, corporate cultures and management philosophies;
(cid:0) consolidating each company’s administrative and information technology infrastructure; 
(cid:0) combining the companies’ research and development functions;
(cid:0) integrating and unifying the products and services available to historical Globus and NuVasive customers;
(cid:0) coordinating sales activities and go-to-market efforts; 
(cid:0) managing the movement of certain positions to different locations;
(cid:0) coordinating geographically dispersed organizations;
(cid:0) managing the operations of a significantly larger and more complex company; and
(cid:0) effecting actions that may be required in connection with obtaining regulatory or other governmental approvals.

In  addition,  at  times  the  attention  of  certain  members  of  the  Company’s  management  and  resources  may  be  focused  on  the  integration  of  the 
businesses of the two companies and diverted from day-to-day business operations or other opportunities that may have been beneficial to such company, 
which may disrupt each company’s ongoing business and the business of the Company.

The Company expects to incur substantial expenses related to the integration of NuVasive and may be unable to realize the anticipated synergies, which 
could adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

The Company’s ability to achieve estimated synergies in the timeframe anticipated, or at all, is subject to various assumptions, which may or may 
not  prove  to  be  accurate.  As  a  consequence,  the  Company  may  not  be  able  to  realize  all  of  these  synergies  within  the  timeframe  expected  or  at  all.  In 
addition,  the  Company  may  incur  additional  or  unexpected  costs  in  order  to  realize  these  benefits.  Failure  to  achieve  the  expected  synergies  could 
significantly reduce the expected benefits associated with the Merger.

Certain  contractual  counterparties  may  seek  to  modify  contractual  relationships  with  the  Company,  which  could  have  an  adverse  effect  on  the 
Company’s business and operations.

As  a  result  of  the  Merger,  the  Company  may  experience  impacts  on  relationships  with  contractual  counterparties  (such  as  business  partners, 
surgeons, vendors, sales representatives, contractors, distributors or other third-party service providers) that may harm the Company’s business and results 
of operations. Certain counterparties may seek to terminate or modify contractual obligations following the Merger whether or not contractual rights are 
triggered as a result of the Merger. There can be no guarantee that Globus’s or NuVasive’s contractual counterparties will remain with or continue to have a 
relationship with the Company or do so on the same or similar contractual terms following the Merger. If any contractual counterparties (such as business 
partners, surgeons, vendors, sales representatives, contractors, distributors or other third-party service providers) seek to terminate or modify contractual 
obligations or discontinue their respective relationships with the Company, then the Company’s business and results of operations may be harmed.

The Company may be exposed to increased litigation, which could have an adverse effect on the Company’s business and operations.

The Company may be exposed to increased litigation from stockholders, customers, partners, suppliers, contractors and other third parties due to 
the Merger of Globus’s and NuVasive’s businesses. Such litigation may have an adverse impact on the Company’s business and results of operations or 
may cause disruptions to the Company’s operations.

45

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments

None.

Item 1C. Cybersecurity Risk Management, Strategy, Governance, and Incident Disclosure
We have processes in place for assessing, identifying, and managing material risks from cybersecurity threats, including potential unauthorized occurrences 
on or through both, our physical systems and electronic information systems, that could adversely affect the confidentiality, integrity, or availability of our 
information systems or the information residing on those systems. These include a wide variety of mechanisms, controls, technologies, methods, systems, 
and  other  processes  that  are  designed  to  prevent,  detect,  or  mitigate  data  loss,  theft,  misuse,  unauthorized  access,  or  other  security  incidents  or 
vulnerabilities affecting the data. The data include confidential, proprietary, and business and personal information that we collect, process and store as part 
of  our  business,  including  on  behalf  of  third  parties.  Additionally,  we  use  processes  to  oversee  and  identify  material  risks  from  cybersecurity  threats 
associated  with  our  use  of  third-party  technology  and  systems,  including:  technology  and  systems  we  use  for  encryption  and  authentication;  employee 
email; content delivery to customers; back-office support; and other functions.

As  part  of  our  risk  management  process,  we  conduct  application  security  assessments,  vulnerability  management,  penetration  testing,  security 
audits,  and  ongoing  risk  assessments.  We  also  maintain  a  variety  of  incident  response  plans  that  are  utilized  when  incidents  are  detected.  We  require 
employees with access to information systems, including all corporate employees, to undertake data protection and cybersecurity training and compliance 
programs at least annually.

We  have  a  unified  and  centrally-coordinated  team,  led  by  our  Senior  Vice  President  of  Corporate  Quality  and  IT,  that  is  responsible  for 
implementing  and  maintaining  centralized  cybersecurity  and  data  protection  practices  at  Globus  in  close  coordination  with  senior  leadership  and  other 
teams across Globus. Reporting to our Senior Vice president of Corporate Quality and IT are a number of trained information security professionals. In 
addition to our extensive in-house cybersecurity capabilities, at times we also engage assessors, consultants, auditors, or other third parties to assist with 
assessing, identifying and managing cybersecurity risks.

Our cybersecurity risks and associated mitigations are evaluated by senior leadership, including as part of our risk assessments that are reviewed 
by the Audit Committee and our Board of Directors. Additional information about cybersecurity threats we face is discussed in Item 1A of Part I, “Risk 
Factors,” under the heading “We are subject to data privacy laws and our failure to comply with them could subject us to substantial liabilities,” which 
should be read in conjunction with the information above.

The  Board  of  Directors,  which  is  comprised  of  independent  directors,  oversees  our  policies  and  procedures  for  protecting  our  cybersecurity 
infrastructure and for compliance with applicable data protection and security regulations, and related risks. They receive reports regarding such risks from 
management, including our Senior Vice President of Corporate Quality and IT. They also oversee the response to any significant cybersecurity incidents. 
Our  Senior  Vice  President  of  Corporate  Quality  and  IT,  who  has  extensive  cybersecurity  knowledge  and  skills  gained  from  over  20  years  of  work 
experience, heads the team responsible for implementing and maintaining cybersecurity and data protection practices at Globus and reports directly to the 
Chief Operating Officer.

Item 2. Properties

Our owned corporate headquarters are located in Audubon, Pennsylvania. We have additional leased domestic administrative offices, research and 
training facilities in Arizona, California, Colorado, Illinois, Maryland, New Jersey North Carolina and Texas (one facility in Texas is owned). Our owned 
manufacturing and fulfillment facilities are located in Massachusetts, Ohio, Pennsylvania and Tennessee. We maintain leased distribution warehouses and 
administrative offices in seventeen additional countries.

Item 3. Legal Proceedings

We are involved in a number of proceedings, legal actions and claims.  Such matters are subject to many uncertainties, and the outcomes of these 
matters are not within our control and may not be known for prolonged periods of time.  In some actions, the claimants seek damages, as well as other 
relief, including injunctions prohibiting us from engaging in certain activities, which, if granted, could require significant expenditures and/or result in lost 
revenues.  For further details on the material legal proceedings to which we are currently a party, please refer to “Part II; Item 8. Financial Statements 
and Supplementary Data; Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements; Note 15. Commitments and Contingencies” below.

In addition, we are subject to legal proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business.

Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures

Not applicable.

46

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

PART II

Item 5. Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

Class A Common Stock

Our  Class  A  common  stock  trades  on  The  New  York  Stock  Exchange,  under  the  symbol  “GMED.”  We  had  approximately  65  stockholders  of 
record as of February 16, 2024. We believe that the number of beneficial owners is substantially greater than the number of record holders because a large 
portion of our Class A common stock is held of record through brokerage firms in “street name.”

Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities

None.

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

We repurchase shares of the Company’s Class A common stock pursuant to the publicly announced share repurchase program authorized by the 
Board of Directors in March 2020 and the expansion of the stock repurchase plan authorized by the Board of Directors in March 2022. On September 27, 
2023,  the  share  repurchase  program  was  expanded  by  authorizing  the  Company  to  repurchase  an  additional  $350.0  million  of  the  Company’s  Class  A 
common stock.

The following table provides the activity related to share repurchases for the fourth quarter of 2023.

(In thousands except for per share prices)

Period
October 1, 2023 - October 31, 2023
November 1, 2023 - November 30, 2023
December 1, 2023 - December 31, 2023
Total

Total number of shares 
purchased (a)

Average price paid 
per share (b)

Total number of shares 
purchased as part of publicly 
announced plans or programs 
(a) 

Approximate dollar value of 
shares that may yet be 
purchased under the plans or 
programs (a)

 2,829   $
 —    
 1,500    
 4,329    

 53.31    
 —    
 49.85    

 2,829   $
 —    
 1,500    
 4,329    

 350,001
 350,001
 275,239

(a) On March 11, 2020, our Board of Directors authorized a share repurchase program that allows for the repurchase up to $200 million of the Company’s Class A common stock.  On March 4, 
2022, our Board of Directors authorized the expansion of the share repurchase program of the Company’s Class A common stock by an additional $200 million. On September 27, 2023, the share 
repurchase  program  was  expanded  by  authorizing  the  Company  to  repurchase  an  additional  $350.0  million  of  the  Company’s  Class  A  common  stock. The  shares  may  be  purchased  through 
privately negotiated or open market transactions. This program has no time limit and may be suspended for periods or discontinued at any time.
(b) Inclusive of an immaterial amount of commission fees.

Dividend Policy

We have never declared or paid any cash dividends on our capital stock. We currently intend to retain future earnings, if any, for development of 

our business and do not anticipate that we will declare or pay cash dividends on our capital stock in the foreseeable future.

47

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Comparative Stock Performance Graph

The following graph illustrates a comparison of the total cumulative stockholder return on our Class A common stock from December 31, 2018 
through December 31, 2023 to two indices: the S&P 500 Index and the S&P 500 Health Care Equipment Index. The graph assumes an initial investment of 
$100 on December 31, 2018, in each of our Class A common stock, the stocks comprising the S&P 500 Index, and the stocks comprising the S&P 500 
Health Care Equipment Index, including reinvestment of dividends, if any. Historical stockholder return is not necessarily indicative of the performance to 
be expected for any future periods.

The following graph and related information shall not be deemed “soliciting material” or to be “filed” with the SEC, nor shall such information be 

incorporated by reference into any future filing, except to the extent that we specifically incorporate it by reference into such filing. 

Company/Index
Globus Medical, Inc.
S&P 500 Index
S&P 500 Health Care Equipment

2018
$100
$100
$100

December 31,

2020
$151
$156
$152

2021
$167
$200
$182

2022
$172
$164
$147

2023
$123
$207
$161

2019
$136
$131
$129

48

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read together with our consolidated financial 
statements and related notes included elsewhere in this Annual Report. This discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements that involve risks, 
uncertainties and assumptions. You should review the “Risk Factors” and “Cautionary Note Concerning Forward-Looking Statements” sections of this 
Annual  Report  for  a  discussion  of  certain  of  the  important  factors  that  could  cause  actual  results  to  differ  materially  from  the  results  described  in  or
implied  by  the  forward-looking  statements  described  in  the  following  discussion  and  analysis.  Certain  amounts  and  percentages  in  this  discussion  and 
analysis have been rounded for convenience of presentation. 

Overview

We are an engineering-driven company with a history of rapidly developing and commercializing advanced products and procedures to address 
treatment challenges. With numerous products launched since the founding of the Company, including 10 products launched on the market in 2023, we 
offer a comprehensive portfolio of innovative and differentiated technologies that treat a variety of musculoskeletal conditions. We separate our products 
and services into two major categories: Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies.

NuVasive Merger

 On September 1, 2023, pursuant to that certain Merger Agreement with NuVasive and Merger Sub, Merger Sub, a wholly owned subsidiary of the 
Company, merged with and into NuVasive, with NuVasive surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company. Under the Merger Agreement, each 
share of common stock, par value $0.001 per share, of NuVasive issued and outstanding immediately prior to the effective time of the Merger (other than 
certain excluded shares as described in the Merger Agreement) was cancelled and converted into the right to receive 0.75 fully paid and non-assessable 
shares of Class A common stock of Globus, $0.001 par value per share, and the right to receive cash in lieu of fractional shares.

Product & Service Categories

While we group our products and services into two categories, Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies, they are not limited to a 
particular technology, platform or surgical approach. Instead, our goal is to offer a comprehensive product suite that can be used to safely and effectively 
treat patients based on their specific anatomy and condition, and is customized to the surgeon’s training and surgical preference.

Musculoskeletal Solutions

Our Musculoskeletal Solutions consist primarily of implantable devices, biologics, accessories, unique surgical instruments, and neuromonitoring 
services, used in an expansive range of spinal, orthopedic and neurosurgical procedures. Musculoskeletal disorders are a leading driver of healthcare costs 
worldwide.  Disorders  range  in  severity  from  mild  pain  and  loss  of  feeling  to  extreme  pain  and  paralysis.  These  disorders  are  primarily  caused  by 
degenerative  and  congenital  conditions,  deformity,  tumors  and  traumatic  injuries.  Treatment  alternatives  for  musculoskeletal  disorders  range  from  non-
operative conservative therapies to surgical interventions depending on the pathology. Conservative therapies include bed rest, medication, casting, bracing, 
and physical therapy. When conservative therapies are not indicated, or fail to provide adequate quality of life improvements, surgical interventions may be 
used. Surgical treatments for musculoskeletal disorders can be instrumented, which include the use of implants, or non-instrumented, which forego the use 
of hardware but may include biologics. Neuromonitoring services use proprietary software-driven nerve detection and avoidance technology and include 
IONM to aid spine surgery.

Enabling Technologies

Our  Enabling  Technologies  are  comprised  of  INR  solutions  for  assisted  surgery  which  are  advanced  computer-assisted  intelligent  systems 
designed to enhance a surgeon’s capabilities, and ultimately improve patient care and reduce radiation exposure for all involved, by streamlining surgical 
procedures to be safer, less invasive, and more accurate. The market for our Enabling Technologies in spine and orthopedic surgery is still in the infancy 
stage  and  consists  primarily  of  imaging,  navigation  and  robotic  systems.  In  spine,  a  majority  of  these  technologies  are  limited  to  surgical  planning  and 
assistance in implant placement for increased accuracy and time savings with less intraoperative radiation exposure to the patient and surgical staff. As our 
Enabling Technologies become more fully integrated with our Musculoskeletal Solutions, a continued rise in adoption is expected. Furthermore, we believe 
as new technologies such as augmented reality and artificial intelligence are introduced, Enabling Technologies have the potential to transform the way 
surgery is performed and most importantly, continue to improve patient outcomes.

49

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Geographic Information 

To date, the primary market for our products has been the U.S., where we sell our products through a combination of direct sales representatives 
employed by us and distributor sales representatives employed by exclusive independent distributors, who distribute our products for a commission that is 
generally based on a percentage of sales. We believe there is significant opportunity to strengthen our position in the U.S. market by increasing the size of 
our U.S. sales force and we intend to add additional direct and distributor sales representatives in the future.

During the year ended December 31, 2023, international net sales accounted for approximately 18.4% of our total net sales. We have sold our 
products  in  approximately  64  countries  other  than  the  U.S.  through  a  combination  of  sales  representatives  employed  by  us  and  exclusive  international
distributors.  We  believe  there  are  significant  opportunities  for  us  to  increase  our  presence  in  both  existing  and  new  international  markets  through  the 
continued expansion of our direct and distributor sales forces and through the commercialization of additional products.

Seasonality

Our business is generally not seasonal in nature. However, sales of our Musculoskeletal Solutions products and services may be influenced by 
summer vacation and winter holiday periods during which we have experienced fewer surgeries taking place, as well as more surgeries taking place later in 
the year when patients have met the deductibles under insurance plans. Sales of our Enabling Technologies products may be influenced by longer capital 
purchase cycles and the timing of budget approvals for major capital purchases. 

Components of our Results of Operations

We  manage  our  business  globally  within  two  operating  segments,  which  is  consistent  with  how  our  management  reviews  our  business,  makes 
investment and resource allocation decisions and assesses operating performance. We have concluded that these operating segments are aggregated into one 
reportable segment, based on the aggregation criteria.

Net Sales

We sell implants and related disposables, primarily to hospitals, for use by surgeons to treat musculoskeletal disorders. We generally place surgical 
sets, which contain our implants, disposables, surgical instruments and cases, in the field with our sales representatives, and the surgical sets are maintained 
either with our sales representatives or at our hospital customers that purchase the surgical sets used in surgeries. We recognize revenue when the implants 
and related disposables have been implanted or used in a surgery, or for sets that are sold directly, when title to the goods and risk of loss are transferred to 
the customer and there are no remaining performance obligations which affect the customer’s final acceptance of the sale. 

We  generally  recognize  INR  solutions  revenue  when  control  transfers  to  the  customer  based  on  the  terms  of  the  arrangement,  which  typically 
occurs at the time the product is shipped or delivered. Depending on the terms of the arrangement, we may also defer the recognition of a portion of the 
consideration as we satisfy future performance obligations related to the provision of maintenance and support.

Cost of Sales

While we have increased our in-house implant product manufacturing capacity and assemble our INR systems in-house, we also have products 
manufactured by third-party suppliers. Substantially all of our suppliers manufacture our products in the U.S. Our cost of sales consists primarily of costs 
from our in-house manufacturing, costs of products purchased from third-party suppliers, excess and obsolete inventory charges, depreciation of surgical 
instruments and cases, royalties, shipping, inspection and related costs incurred in making our products available for sale or use. 

Research and Development Expenses

Research and development expenses primarily consist of engineering, product development, clinical and regulatory expenses, consulting services, 
outside prototyping services, internal and external research activities, materials, depreciation, and other costs associated with development of our products. 
Research and development expenses also include personnel and consultants’ compensation, stock-based compensation expense, and acquired research in 
process with no alternative future use. We expense research and development costs as they are incurred.

We expect to incur additional research and development costs as we continue to develop new products. These costs will increase in absolute terms 

as we continue to expand our product pipeline and add personnel.

50

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses

Selling, general and administrative expenses primarily consist of salaries, benefits and other related costs, including stock-based compensation, for 
personnel  employed  in  sales,  marketing,  finance,  legal,  compliance,  administrative,  information  technology,  medical  education  and  training,  quality  and 
human resource departments. Our selling, general and administrative expenses also include commissions, generally based on a percentage of sales, to direct 
sales representatives and distributors. We expect selling, general and administrative expenses will increase in absolute terms with the continued expansion 
of our sales force and commercialization of our current and pipeline products. We plan to hire more personnel to support the growth of our business.

Provision for Litigation

We record a provision for litigation settlements when a loss is known or considered probable and the amount can be reasonably estimated and in 

the case of a favorable settlement, income when realized.

Amortization of Intangibles

We amortize finite lived intangible assets over the period of estimated benefit using the straight-line method. Indefinite lived intangible assets are 
tested for impairment annually or whenever events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of the asset (asset group) may not be recoverable. If 
impairment is indicated, we measure the amount of the impairment loss as the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the fair value of the asset. 
Fair value is generally determined using a discounted future cash flow analysis.

Acquisition-Related Costs

Acquisition-related costs represent the change in fair value of business acquisition-related contingent consideration and specific costs related to the 

consummation of the acquisition process such as banker fees, legal fees and other acquisition-related professional fees.

Income Tax Provision

We are taxed at the rates applicable within each jurisdiction. The composite income tax rate, tax provisions, deferred tax assets and deferred tax 
liabilities will vary according to the jurisdiction in which profits arise. Tax laws are complex and subject to different interpretations by management and the 
respective  governmental  taxing  authorities,  and  require  us  to  exercise  judgment  in  determining  our  income  tax  provision,  our  deferred  tax  assets  and 
liabilities, and the valuation allowance recorded against our net deferred tax assets.

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined using the enacted tax rates in effect for the years in which those tax assets are expected to be 
realized. A valuation allowance is established when it is more likely than not that the future realization of all or some of the deferred tax assets will not be 
achieved.

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

The  preparation  of  the  consolidated  financial  statements  requires  us  to  make  assumptions,  estimates  and  judgments  that  affect  the  reported 
amounts of assets and liabilities, the disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities as of the date of the consolidated financial statements, and the reported 
amounts of sales and expenses during the reporting periods. Certain of our more critical accounting policies require the application of significant judgment 
by  management  in  selecting  the  appropriate  assumptions  for  calculating  financial  estimates.  By  their  nature,  these  judgments  are  subject  to  an  inherent 
degree of uncertainty. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our judgments, including but not limited to those related to inventories, recoverability of long-lived 
assets  and  the  fair  value  of  our  common  stock.  We  use  historical  experience  and  other  assumptions  as  the  basis  for  our  judgments  and  making  these 
estimates. Because future events and their effects cannot be determined with precision, actual results could differ significantly from these estimates. Any 
changes in those estimates will be reflected in our consolidated financial statements as they occur. While our significant accounting policies are more fully 
described in “Part II; Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data; Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements; Note 2. Summary of 
Significant Accounting Policies” below in this Annual Report, we believe that the following accounting policies and estimates are most critical to a full 
understanding and evaluation of our reported financial results. The critical accounting policies addressed below reflect our most significant judgments and 
estimates used in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements. We have reviewed these critical accounting policies with the audit committee of 
our Board.

Revenue Recognition. Revenue is recognized upon transfer of control of promised products or services to customers in an amount that reflects the 
consideration we expect to receive in exchange for those products or services. Sales and other taxes we collect concurrent with revenue-producing activities 
are  excluded  from  revenue.  For  purposes  of  disclosure,  we  disaggregate  our  revenue  into  two  categories,  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  and  Enabling 
Technologies. 

51

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Our  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  products  consist  primarily  of  the  implantable  devices,  disposables,  unique  instruments,  and  neuromonitoring 
services  used  in  an  expansive  range  of  spine,  orthopedic  trauma,  hip,  knee  and  extremity  procedures.  The  majority  of  our  Musculoskeletal  Solutions 
contracts have a single performance obligation and revenue is recognized at a point in time. For our IONM services, revenue is recognized in the period the 
service is performed for the amount of consideration expected to be received.

Our  Enabling  Technologies  products  are  advanced  hardware  and  software  systems,  and  related  technologies,  that  are  designed  to  enhance  a 
surgeon’s capabilities and streamline surgical procedures by making them less invasive, more accurate, and more reproducible to improve patient care. The 
majority  of  our  Enabling  Technologies  product  contracts  contain  multiple  performance  obligations,  including  maintenance  and  support,  and  revenue  is 
recognized as we fulfill each performance obligation. When contracts have multiple performance obligations, we allocate the contract’s transaction price to 
each performance obligation using our best estimate of the standalone selling price of each distinct good or service in the contract. 

Our policy is to classify shipping and handling costs billed to customers as sales and the related expenses as cost of sales.

Excess and Obsolete Inventory. Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or net realizable value. Cost is determined on a first-in, first-out basis. 
The  majority  of  our  inventory  is  finished  goods  and  we  utilize  both  in-house  manufacturing  and  third-party  suppliers  to  produce  our  products.  We 
periodically  evaluate  the  carrying  value  of  our  inventories  in  relation  to  our  estimated  forecast  of  product  demand,  which  takes  into  consideration  the 
estimated life cycle of product releases. When quantities on hand exceed estimated sales forecasts, we record a write-down for such excess inventories. 
Once inventory has been written down, it creates a new cost basis for inventory that is not subsequently written up.

The  need  to  maintain  substantial  levels  of  inventory  increases  the  risk  of  carrying  excess  inventory.  Many  of  our  Musculoskeletal  Solutions 
products come in sets which feature components in a variety of sizes so that the implant or device may be customized to the patient’s needs. In order to 
market our Musculoskeletal Solutions products effectively, we must often maintain and provide surgeons and hospitals with surgical sets, back-up products 
and products of different sizes. For each surgery, fewer than all of the components of the set are used, and therefore certain portions of the set may be 
considered excess inventory since they are not likely to be used. One of our primary business goals is to focus on continual product innovation. Though we 
believe this provides us with a competitive advantage, it also increases the risk that our products will become excess or obsolete inventory prior to sale or 
prior to the end of their anticipated useful lives. When we introduce new products or next-generation products, we may be required to take charges for 
excess and obsolete inventory that have a significant impact on the value of our inventory or on our operating results.

Fair Value Measurements. Fair value is defined as the price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the 
principal  or  most  advantageous  market  for  the  asset  or  the  liability  in  an  orderly  transaction  between  market  participants  on  the  measurement  date. 
Additionally, a fair value hierarchy was established that prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The hierarchy gives the 
highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs. The level
within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of any input that is significant to the fair value measurement.

Our assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis are classified and disclosed in one of the following three categories:

Level 1—quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets and liabilities;

Level 2—observable inputs other than quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities; and

Level 3—unobservable inputs in which there is little or no market data available, which require the reporting entity to use significant unobservable 
inputs or valuation techniques.  

Contingent  consideration  represents  contingent  milestone,  performance  or  revenue-sharing  payment  obligations  related  to  acquisitions  and  is 
measured at fair value, based on significant inputs that are not observable in the market, which represents a Level 3 measurement within the fair value 
hierarchy. The valuation of contingent consideration uses assumptions we believe would be made by a market participant. We assess these assumptions on 
an ongoing basis as additional data impacting the assumptions is obtained. The fair value of contingent consideration is recorded in business acquisition 
liabilities on our consolidated balance sheets, and changes in the fair value of contingent consideration are recognized in acquisition-related costs in the 
consolidated  statements  of  operations  and  comprehensive  income.  The  fair  value  of  contingent  restricted  stock  unit  grants  (“RSUs”)  are  recorded  as 
additional paid-in capital in the consolidated balance sheet on the day of the grant due to the remote likelihood of forfeiture.

The purchase price of business acquisitions is primarily allocated to the tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed 
based on their estimated fair values on the acquisition date, with the excess recorded as goodwill. We utilize Level 3 inputs in the determination of the 
initial fair value. 

52

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Goodwill and Intangible Assets. Goodwill represents the excess of purchase price over the fair values of the identifiable assets acquired less the 
liabilities assumed in the acquisition of a business. Goodwill is tested for impairment at least annually or whenever events or circumstances indicate that a 
carrying amount may be impaired. We perform our goodwill impairment analysis at the reporting unit level. We perform our annual impairment analysis by 
either comparing a reporting unit’s estimated fair value to its carrying amount or doing a qualitative assessment of a reporting unit’s fair value from the last 
quantitative assessment to determine if there is potential impairment. We may do a qualitative assessment when the results of the previous quantitative test 
indicated the reporting unit’s estimated fair value was significantly in excess of the carrying value of its net assets and we do not believe there have been 
significant changes in the reporting unit’s operations that would significantly decrease its estimated fair value or significantly increase its net assets. If a 
quantitative  assessment  is  performed,  the  evaluation  includes  management  estimates  of  discounted  cash  flow  projections  based  on  internal  future 
projections and/or use of a market approach by looking at market values of comparable companies. We perform our annual impairment test of goodwill in 
the fourth quarter of each year.

Intangible  assets  consist  of  purchased  in-process  research  and  development  (“IPR&D”),  developed  technology,  supplier  network,  patents, 
customer relationships, re-acquired rights, and non-compete agreements. Intangible assets with finite useful lives are amortized over the period of estimated 
benefit using the straight-line method and estimated useful lives ranging from one to twenty-one years. Intangible assets are tested for impairment annually 
or whenever events or circumstances indicate that a carrying amount of an asset (asset group) may not be recoverable. If an impairment is indicated, we
measure  the  amount  of  the  impairment  loss  as  the  amount  by  which  the  carrying  amount  exceeds  the  fair  value  of  the  asset.  Fair  value  is  generally 
determined using a discounted future cash flow analysis. 

IPR&D has an indefinite life and is not amortized until completion of the project at which time the IPR&D becomes an amortizable asset. If the 
related project is not completed in a timely manner, we may have an impairment related to the IPR&D, calculated as the excess of the asset’s carrying value 
over its fair value.

During the twelve months ended December 31, 2023, there were no impairments in goodwill, finite-lived intangible assets, or IPR&D.

Long-Lived Assets. We periodically evaluate the recoverability of the carrying amount of long-lived assets, which include property and equipment, 
as well as whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset group may not be fully recoverable. An impairment is 
assessed when the undiscounted future cash flows from the use and eventual disposition of an asset group are less than its carrying value. If an impairment 
is indicated, we measure the amount of the impairment loss as the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the fair value of the asset group. Our fair 
value methodology is based on quoted market prices, if available. If quoted market prices are not available, an estimate of fair value is made based on 
prices of similar assets or other valuation techniques including present value techniques. During the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, we 
did not record any impairment charges related to long-lived assets.

Stock-Based Compensation Expense. The cost of employee and non-employee director awards is measured at the grant date fair value of the award 
and is recognized as expense over the requisite service period, which is generally the vesting period of the equity award. Compensation expense for awards 
includes the impact of forfeiture in the period when they occur.

We estimate the fair value of stock options utilizing the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. Inputs to the Black-Scholes model include our stock 
price,  expected  volatility,  expected  term,  risk-free  interest  rate  and  expected  dividends.  Expected  volatility  is  based  on  the  historical  volatility  of  the 
Company’s common stock over the most recent period commensurate with the estimated expected term of the Company’s stock options offering period 
which is derived from historical experience. The risk-free interest rate assumption is based on observed interest rates of U.S. Treasury securities appropriate 
for the expected terms of the stock options. The dividend yield assumption is based on the history and expectation of no dividend payouts. The fair value of 
restricted stock units is estimated on the day of grant based on the closing price of the Company’s common stock.

We assumed equity-classified awards for certain NuVasive RSUs, and performance restricted stock units (“PRSUs”), as part of the Merger. These 
RSUs and PRSUs are measured at the grant date based on the estimated fair value of the award. The fair value of equity instruments that are expected to
vest is recognized and amortized over the requisite service period. The Company has granted awards with up to five year graded or cliff vesting terms (in 
each case, with service through the date of vesting being required). No exercise price or other monetary payment is required for receipt of the shares issued 
in settlement of the respective award; instead, consideration is furnished in the form of the participant’s service to the Company.

We  expect  to  continue  to  grant  stock-based  awards  in  the  future,  and  to  the  extent  that  we  do,  our  actual  stock-based  compensation  expense 

recognized may increase.

Legal Proceedings. We are involved in a number of proceedings, legal actions, and claims. Such matters are subject to many uncertainties, and the 
outcomes of these matters are not within our control and may not be known for prolonged periods of time. In some actions, the claimants seek damages, as 
well as other relief, including injunctions prohibiting us from engaging in certain activities, 

53

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
which, if granted, could require significant expenditures and/or result in lost revenues. We record a liability in the consolidated financial statements for 
these actions when a loss is considered probable and the amount can be reasonably estimated. If the reasonable estimate of a probable loss is a range, and 
no amount within the range is a better estimate than any other, the minimum amount of the range is accrued. If a loss is reasonably possible but not known 
or probable, and can be reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or range of loss is disclosed. In most cases, significant judgment is required to estimate the 
amount and timing of a loss to be recorded. We expense legal costs related to loss contingencies as incurred. While it is not possible to predict the outcome 
for these matters, we believe it is possible that costs associated with them could have a material adverse impact on our consolidated earnings, financial 
position or cash flows.

Income Taxes. We  recognize  deferred  tax  assets  and  liabilities  for  the  future  tax  consequences  attributable  to  differences  between  the  financial 
statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. We measure deferred tax assets and liabilities using enacted tax 
rates expected to apply to taxable income in the year in which such items are expected to be received or settled. We recognize the effect on deferred tax 
assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates in the period that includes the enactment date. We establish a valuation allowance to offset any deferred tax 
assets if, based upon available evidence, it is more likely than not that some or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized.

While  we  believe  that  our  tax  positions  are  fully  supportable,  there  is  a  risk  that  certain  positions  could  be  challenged  successfully.  In  these 
instances,  we  look  to  establish  reserves.  If  we  determine  that  a  tax  position  is  more  likely  than  not  of  being  sustained  upon  audit,  based  solely  on  the 
technical merits of the position, we recognize the benefit. We measure the benefit by determining the amount that has likelihood greater than 50% of being 
realized upon settlement. We presume that all tax positions will be examined by a taxing authority with full knowledge of all relevant information. We 
regularly  monitor  our  tax  positions,  tax  assets  and  tax  liabilities.  We  reevaluate  the  technical  merits  of  our  tax  positions  and  recognize  an  uncertain  tax 
benefit or reverse a previously recorded tax benefit when (i) a tax audit is completed, (ii) applicable tax law, including a tax case or legislative guidance, 
changes or (iii) the statute of limitations expires. Significant judgment is required in accounting for tax reserves.

Results of Operations

Year Ended December 31, 2023 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2022

Net Sales

The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, our net sales by geography expressed as dollar amounts and the changes in sales between 

the specified periods expressed in dollar amounts and as percentages:

(In thousands, except percentages)
United States
International
Total net sales

Year Ended

December 31,

  $

  $

2023
 1,279,765
 288,711
 1,568,476

 $

 $

2022

 871,939
 150,904
 1,022,843

 $

 $

Change

$
 407,826
 137,807
 545,633

%

46.8%
91.3%
53.3%

In the U.S., the increase in net sales of $407.8 million was due primarily to the addition of NuVasive, as well as increased spine product sales, 

including robotic spine instruments, resulting from penetration in existing territories and an increase in sales volume of Enabling Technologies.

International net sales increased by $137.8 million, which was due primarily due to the addition of NuVasive and increased spine product sales 

resulting from penetration in existing territories.

Cost of Sales

(In thousands, except percentages)
Cost of sales
Percentage of net sales

Year Ended

December 31,

2023

2022

  $

 548,174

 $
34.9%  

 263,725

 $
25.8%  

Change

$
 284,449

%

107.9%

The increase of $284.4 million in cost of sales was primarily due to the addition of NuVasive, amortization of the inventory fair value step up, 
increased volume and product mix, higher write-downs of excess and obsolete inventory, and higher depreciation. These increases were partially offset by 
lower production variances.

54

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Research and Development Expenses

(In thousands, except percentages)
Research and development
Percentage of net sales

Year Ended

December 31,

2023

2022

  $

 124,010

 $
7.9%  

 73,015

 $
7.1%  

Change

$

 50,995

%

69.8%

The increase of $51.0 million in research and development expenses was due primarily to the addition of NuVasive and an increase in personnel-

related expenses due to our continued investment in product development. 

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses

(In thousands, except percentages)
Selling, general and administrative
Percentage of net sales

Year Ended

December 31,

2023

2022

  $

 643,410

 $
41.0%  

 432,117

 $
42.2%  

Change

$
 211,293

%

48.9%

The $211.3 million increase in selling, general and administrative expenses was due to the addition of NuVasive, and an increase in personnel-

related expenses resulting primarily from higher product sales, and an increase in bad debt and meeting expenses.

Provision for Litigation

(In thousands, except percentages)
Provision for litigation, net
Percentage of net sales

Year Ended

December 31,

2023

2022

  $

 434
 $
0.0%  

 2,341
 $
0.2%  

Change

$

 (1,907)

%

-81.5%

The  $1.9  million  decrease  in  provision  for  litigation  is  due  to  a  settlement  receipt,  partially  offset  by  a  settlement  payment  for  the  year  ended 

December 31, 2023 compared to 2022.

Amortization of Intangibles

(In thousands, except percentages)
Amortization of intangibles
Percentage of net sales

Year Ended

December 31,

2023

2022

  $

 51,032

 $
3.3%  

 17,735

 $
1.7%  

Change

$

 33,297

%

187.7%

The increase of $33.3 million in the amortization of intangibles is primarily due to the impact of the recognized intangibles in connection with the 

Merger.

Acquisition-Related Costs

(In thousands, except percentages)
Acquisition-related costs
Percentage of net sales

Year Ended

December 31,

2023

2022

  $

 68,274

 $
4.4%  

 5,959
 $
0.6%  

Change

$

 62,315

%
1045.7%

The  increase  of  $62.3  million  in  acquisition-related  costs  is  due  to  costs  incurred  relating  to  the  closing  of  the  Merger,  including  investment 
banking,  employee  benefit  and  legal  costs.  It  also  includes  an  unfavorable  change  in  fair  value  of  business  acquisition  liabilities,  driven  by  changes  in 
market conditions and the achievement of certain performance conditions.

Other Income/(expense), Net

(In thousands, except percentages)
Other income, net
Percentage of net sales

Year Ended

December 31,

2023

2022

  $

 32,251

 $
2.1%  

 15,068

 $
1.5%  

Change

$

 17,183

%

114.0%

55

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

The increase of $17.2 million in other income, was primarily due to foreign currency exchange gains of $14.3 million in the current year compared 
to $1.0 million of foreign currency losses in the prior year and an increase of $5.9 million related to higher interest income yields on marketable securities 
from external market factors.

Income Tax Provision

(In thousands, except percentages)
Income tax provision
Effective income tax rate

Year Ended

December 31,

2023

2022

  $

 $
 42,520
25.7%  

 $
 52,850
21.7%  

Change

$
 (10,330)

%

-19.5%

The  increase  in  the  effective  tax  rate  is  primarily  due  to  non-deductible  compensation  expenses  and  other  non-deductible  Merger-related 

transaction costs as a percentage of pretax earnings.

A discussion of our Results of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2022 can be found in “Part II, Item 7. Management’s Discussion and 
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations: Results of Operations; Year Ended December 31, 2022 Compared to the Year Ended 
December 31, 2021.” on our Form 10-K filed on February 21, 2023. 

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Our principal source of liquidity is cash flow from operating activities as well as our cash and cash equivalents and marketable securities, which 
we believe will provide sufficient funding for us to meet our liquidity requirements for the foreseeable future. Our principal liquidity requirements are to 
fund working capital, research and development, including clinical trials, capital expenditures primarily related to investment in surgical sets required to 
maintain  and  expand  our  business,  service  our  2025  Notes,  and  potential  future  business  or  intellectual  property  acquisitions.  We  expect  to  continue  to 
make investments in surgical sets as we launch new products, increase the size of our U.S. sales force, and expand into international markets. Additionally, 
we have varying needs for cash in connection with our Senior Convertible Notes, of which $450 million of Senior Convertible Notes are due March 2025, 
as well as for certain acquisition-related obligations and contingent consideration achievements. Future litigation or requirements to escrow funds could 
also materially impact our liquidity and our ability to invest in and operate our business on an ongoing basis. We may, however, require additional liquidity 
as  we  continue  to  execute  our  business  strategy.  To  the  extent  that  we  require  new  sources  of  liquidity,  we  may  consider  incurring  debt,  including 
borrowing against our existing credit facility, convertible debt instruments, and/or raising additional funds through an equity offering. The sale of additional 
equity may result in dilution to our stockholders. There is no assurance that we will be able to secure such additional funding on terms acceptable to us, or 
at all.

Line of Credit

In September 2023, we entered into an unsecured credit agreement with U.S. Bank National Association, as administrative agent, Citizens Bank, 
N.A.,  as  syndication  agent,  Royal  Bank  of  Canada,  as  documentation  agent,  U.S.  Bank  National  Association  and  Citizens  Bank,  N.A.,  as  joint  lead 
arrangers  and  joint  book  runners,  and  the  other  lenders  referred  to  therein  (the  “September  2023  Credit  Agreement”),  that  provides  a  revolving  credit 
facility  permitting  borrowings  up  to  $400.0  million  and  has  a  termination  date  of  September  27,  2028.  We  may  request  an  increase  in  the  revolving 
commitments  in  an  aggregate  amount  not  to  exceed  (i)  $200  million  or  (ii)  so  long  as  the  Leverage  Ratio  (as  defined  in  the  September  2023  Credit 
Agreement)  is  at  least  0.25  to  1.00  less  than  the  applicable  Leverage  Ratio  then  required  under  the  September  2023  Credit  Agreement,  an  unlimited 
amount.  Revolving  Loans  under  the  September  2023  Credit  Agreement  bear  interest  at  either  a  base  rate  or  the  Term  SOFR  Rate  (as  defined  in  the 
Revolving  Credit  Facility)  plus,  in  each  case,  an  applicable  margin,  as  determined  in  accordance  with  the  provisions  of  the  September  2023  Credit 
Agreement.  The  Applicable  Margin  ranges  from  0.125%  to  0.625%  for  the  Base  Rate  and  1.125%  to  1.625%  for  the  Term  SOFR  Rate.  We  may  also 
request Swingline Loans (as defined in the September 2023 Credit Agreement) at either the Base Rate or the Daily Term SOFR Rate. The September 2023 
Credit Agreement is guaranteed by certain direct or indirect wholly owned subsidiaries of the Company. The September 2023 Credit Agreement contains 
financial and other customary covenants, including a funded net indebtedness to adjusted EBITDA ratio. As of December 31, 2023, we have not borrowed 
under the September 2023 Credit Agreement and we are in compliance with all covenants. 

56

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Contractual Obligations and Commitments

In connection with the Merger, the Company acquired additional obligations and commitments, including, but not limited to (i) the 2025 Notes, 
with  a  principal  balance  of  $450.0  million,  (ii)  contingent  consideration  arrangements  associated  with  certain  historical  NuVasive  acquisitions,  and  (iii) 
operating lease and finance lease obligations. Refer to the Notes to the consolidated financial statements for further description of our 2025 Notes (Note 
11), contingent consideration arrangements (Notes 6 and 15), and lease obligations (Note 16).

The following table summarizes our outstanding contractual obligations as of December 31, 2023. 

(In thousands)
Convertible Notes
Operating leases
Financing Leases
Contingent consideration 
Purchase obligations
Total (2) *

Payments Due by Period

Total

Less than 1 Year

1-3 Years

3-5 Years

  More than 5 Years

  $

  $

 452,531   $
 144,350  
 850  
 46,137  
 6,429  
 650,297   $

 1,687   $
 18,336  
 498  
 43,137  
 4,629  
 68,287   $

 450,844   $
 28,362  
 352  
 1,000  
 1,700  
 482,258   $

 —   $

 23,634  
 —  
 1,000  
 100  
 24,734   $

 —
 74,018
 —
 1,000
 —
 75,018

(1)  Reflects minimum annual volume commitments to purchase inventory under certain of our supplier contracts.
(2)  In connection with certain acquisitions completed in 2011 through 2023, we have certain contingent consideration obligations payable to the sellers in 
these  transactions  upon  the  achievement  of  certain  regulatory  and  sales  milestones.  For  further  information,  see  Notes 3,  and  6  to  the  consolidated 
financial statements in “Part II; Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”

*  Excludes contributions to pension and other post-employment benefit plans, uncertain tax positions, non-current tax liabilities and royalty obligations 
for  which  we  cannot  make  a  reliable  estimate  of  the  period  of  cash  settlement.  For  further  information,  see  Notes  14,  and  17  to  the  consolidated 
financial statements in “Part II; Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”

Cash Flows

The following table summarizes, for the periods indicated, cash flows from operating, investing and financing activities:

(In thousands)
Net cash provided by/(used in) operating activities
Net cash provided by/(used in) investing activities
Net cash provided by/(used in) financing activities
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes on cash
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

Cash Provided by Operating Activities

2023
 243,499   $
 302,968  
 (231,821) 
 2,180  
 316,826   $

 $

 $

Year Ended
December 31,
2022
 178,468   $
 (110,362) 
 (109,962) 
 (747) 
 (42,603)  $

2021
 276,274   $
 (375,939) 
 54,147  
 (810) 
 (46,328)   $

2023-2022
Change
$
 65,031   $
 413,330  
 (121,859) 
 2,927  
 359,429   $

2022-2021
Change
$
 (97,806)
 265,577
 (164,109)
 63
 3,725

The higher net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2023 was primarily the result of higher net income after 
adjusting out non-cash add-backs and non-cash expenses, such as amortization of purchase accounting related fair value step up, amortization, and stock 
based compensation, partially offset by unfavorable change in deferred income taxes.

Cash Used in Investing Activities

The higher cash provided by investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2023 was primarily from net inflows of purchases, maturities, 

and sales of marketable securities, partially offset by acquisition of businesses net of cash acquired and higher purchases of property and equipment.

Cash Provided by Financing Activities

The higher net cash used in financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2023 was primarily the result of higher repurchases of Class A 

common stock and lower proceeds from exercise of stock options.

A  discussion  of  our  cash  flows  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2022  can  be  found  in “Part  II,  Item  7.  Management’s  Discussion  and  Analysis  of 
Financial Condition and Results of Operations: Results of Operations; Cash Flows.” On our Form 10-K filed on February 21, 2023.

57

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements 

For further details on recently issued accounting pronouncements, please refer to “Part II; Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary 
Data;  Notes  to  Consolidated  Financial  Statements;  Note  2.  Summary  of  Significant  Accounting  Policies;  (v)  Recently  Issued  Accounting 
Pronouncements.”

58

 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure About Market Risk

Market risk is the potential loss arising from adverse changes in the financial markets. We are exposed to various market risks, which may result in 
potential losses arising from adverse changes in market rates, such as interest rates and foreign exchange rates. We do not enter into derivatives or other 
financial  instruments  for  trading  or  speculative  purposes  and  do  not  believe  we  are  exposed  to  material  market  risk  with  respect  to  our  cash,  cash 
equivalents and marketable debt securities. 

Market Price Risk

In order to reduce the potential equity dilution associated with our convertible notes, we entered into transactions for convertible notes hedge (the 
“2025  Hedge”)  in  connection  with  the  issuance  in  March  2020  of  $450.0  million  principal  amount  of  unsecured  senior  convertible  notes  with  a  stated 
interest rate of 0.375% and a maturity date of March 15, 2025 (the “2025 Notes”), entitling us to purchase our common stock. Upon conversion of our 
convertible  notes,  the  2025  Hedge  is  expected  to  reduce  the  equity  dilution  if  the  daily  volume-weighted  average  price  per  share  of  our  common  stock 
exceeds  the  strike  price  of  the  applicable  hedge.  We  also  entered  into  warrant  transactions  with  the  counterparties  of  the  2025  Hedge  entitling  them  to 
acquire  shares  of  our  common  stock.  The  warrant  transactions  could  have  a  dilutive  effect  on  our  earnings  per  share  to  the  extent  that  the  price  of  our 
common stock during a given measurement period (the quarter or year to date period) exceeds the strike price of the warrants. See Note 11, Debt, in the 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in this Annual Report for further discussion.

Interest Rate Risk

Our  exposure  to  interest  rate  risk  at  December  31,  2023  is  related  to  our  investment  portfolio  which  consists  of  municipal  bonds,  corporate  debt 
securities, commercial paper, asset-backed securities, and securities of government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations of high quality financial 
institutions. Due to the short-term nature of these investments, we have assessed that there is no material exposure to interest rate risk arising from our 
investments. Fixed rate investments and borrowings may have their fair market value adversely impacted from changes in interest rates. Based upon our 
overall  interest  rate  exposure  as  of  December  31,  2023,  a  change  of  10  percent  in  interest  rates,  assuming  the  amount  of  our  investment  portfolio  and 
overall economic environment remains constant, would not have a material effect on interest income.

The  primary  objective  of  our  investment  activities  is  to  preserve  the  principal  while  at  the  same  time  maximizing  yields  without  significantly 
increasing the risk. To achieve this objective, we maintain our portfolio of cash equivalents and investments in instruments that meet high credit quality 
standards, as specified in our investment policy. None of our investments are held for trading purposes. Our policy also limits the amount of credit exposure 
to any one issue, issuer and type of instrument.

As  of  December  31,  2023,  we  only  held  investments  in  securities  classified  as  cash  equivalents  and  marketable  equity  securities.  During  the 
periods presented, we did not hold any investments that were in a significant unrealized loss position and no impairment charges were recorded. Realized 
gains and losses and interest income related to cash equivalents were immaterial during all periods presented.

Foreign Exchange Risk

We operate in countries outside of the U.S. and, therefore, we are exposed to foreign currency risk. Most of our direct sales outside of the U.S. are 
invoiced in local currencies.  However, as our business in markets outside of the U.S. continues to increase, our exposure to foreign currency exchange risk 
related to our foreign operations will continue to grow. Fluctuations in the rate of exchange between the U.S. dollar and foreign currencies, primarily the
Australian dollar, the Brazilian real, the British pound sterling, the Colombian peso, the euro, the Japanese yen, and the Singapore dollar, has had and could 
continue to have an adverse effect on our financial results, including our net sales, net sales growth rates, gross margins, income and losses as well as assets 
and liabilities. In particular, as a result of NuVasive’s acquisition of Simplify Medical, we have additional exposure to fluctuations in the Australian dollar. 
We  established  intercompany  receivables  and  payables  in  Australian  dollars  as  a  result  of  the  acquisition  of  Simplify  Medical.  We  also  have  future
contingent consideration liabilities denominated in U.S. dollars, in connection with the acquisition of Simplify Medical, which are the financial obligation 
of  our  subsidiary,  NuVasive  (AUST/NZ)  Pty  Limited,  an  Australian  dollar  denominated  company.  In  addition,  loss  of  financial  stability  within  these 
markets  could  lead  to  delays  in  reimbursement  or  inability  to  remit  payment  due  to  currency  controls.  Specifically,  we  have  operations  in  Puerto  Rico, 
Brazil, and Argentina that have financial instability or currency controls.

We translate the financial statements of our foreign subsidiaries with functional currencies other than the U.S. dollar into the U.S. dollar for consolidation 
using end-of-period exchange rates for assets and liabilities and average exchange rates during each reporting period for results of operations. Net gains or 
losses resulting from the translation of foreign financial statements and the effect of exchange rate changes on intercompany receivables and payables of a 
long-term  investment  nature  are  recorded  as  a  separate  component  of  stockholders’  equity.  These  adjustments  will  affect  net  income  only  upon  sale  or 
liquidation of the underlying investment in foreign subsidiaries. Exchange rate fluctuations resulting from the translation of all other intercompany balances 
between domestic 

59

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents
entities and our foreign subsidiaries are recorded as foreign currency transaction gains or losses and are included in other expense, net in the Consolidated 
Statements  of  Operations.  For  certain  intercompany  balances,  we  may  enter  into  foreign  currency  forward  contracts  to  partially  offset  the  impact  from 
fluctuation of the foreign currency rates. The notional amount of the outstanding foreign currency forward contracts was $10.0 million as of December 31, 
2023, which were settled in January 2024. During the year ended December 31, 2023, a loss of $0.1 million was recognized in other expense, net due to the 
change in the fair value of the derivative instruments, and the fair value of the hedge contracts we held was de minimis on our Consolidated Balance Sheets 
as of December 31, 2023. The derivative instruments are recorded in other current assets or other current liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets 
commensurate with the nature of the instrument at period end. The notional principal amounts provide one measure of the transaction volume outstanding 
as of period end, but do not represent the amount of our exposure to market loss. The estimates of fair value are based on applicable and commonly used 
pricing models using prevailing financial market information. The amounts ultimately realized upon settlement of these financial instruments, together with 
the  gains  and  losses  on  the  underlying  exposures,  will  depend  on  actual  market  conditions  during  the  remaining  life  of  the  instruments.  The  financial 
exposures by exchange rate fluctuations are monitored and managed by us as an integral part of our overall risk management program, which recognizes 
the unpredictability of financial markets and seeks to reduce potentially adverse effects on our results.

60

 
 
 
Table of Contents

Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC.
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm ( Deloitte & Touche LLP, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, PCAOB ID No. 34)
Consolidated Balance Sheets
Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income
Consolidated Statements of Equity
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

62
65
66
67
68
69

61

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the shareholders and the Board of Directors of Globus Medical, Inc.

Opinion on the Financial Statements 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Globus Medical, Inc. and subsidiaries (the "Company") as of December 31, 2023 and 
2022, the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income, equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended 
December 31, 2023, and the related notes and the schedule listed in the Index at Item 15(a)(2) (collectively referred to as the "financial statements"). In our 
opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, and the 
results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2023, in conformity with accounting principles 
generally accepted in the United States of America. 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the Company's 
internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2023, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued 
by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated February 20, 2024, expressed an unqualified opinion on 
the Company's internal control over financial reporting.

Basis for Opinion

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company's financial 
statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the 
Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the 
PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable 
assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing 
procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to 
those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits 
also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the 
financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Critical Audit Matter

The critical audit matters communicated below are matters arising from the current-period audit of the financial statements that were communicated or 
required to be communicated to the audit committee and that (1) relate to accounts or disclosures that are material to the financial statements and (2) 
involved our especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgments. The communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion 
on the financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matters below, providing separate opinions on the critical 
audit matters or on the accounts or disclosures to which they relate.

Inventories Valuation – Refer to Notes 2 and 7 to the financial statements 

Critical Audit Matter Description

Inventories are recorded at the lower of cost or net realizable value. Management periodically evaluates the carrying value of inventories in relation to the 
forecasts of product demand, which takes into consideration the estimated life cycle of product releases. When quantities on hand exceed sales forecasts, a 
write-down is recorded for such excess inventories. Changes in assumptions of product demand could have a significant impact on the amount of write-
down recorded.

Given the inherent uncertainty in forecasting product demand, including the impact of product releases, auditing the reasonableness of management’s 
estimates and assumptions required a high degree of auditor judgment and an increased extent of effort.

How the Critical Audit Matter Was Addressed in the Audit

Our procedures related to management’s forecasts of product demand used to record a write-down for excess and obsolete inventories included the 
following, among others: 

62

 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

• We tested the effectiveness of controls over management’s inventory valuation model, including those over management’s development and 

approval of product demand forecasts.

• We evaluated management’s ability to accurately forecast product demand by comparing actual results to management’s historical estimates.
• We selected a sample of products and verified that the product demand forecasts were supported by historical sales data and other current 

information. 

• We performed corroborative inquiries with the personnel responsible for product development and sales forecasting to evaluate the reasonableness 

of the product demand forecasts.

• We tested the mathematical accuracy of management’s calculations.  

Business Combinations – NuVasive Merger — Refer to Notes 1 and 3 to the financial statements

Critical Audit Matter Description

On September 1, 2023, the Company completed its merger with NuVasive, Inc. with NuVasive, Inc. surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of the 
Company, for total consideration of approximately $2.604 billion. Management accounted for the acquisition as a business combination using the 
acquisition method of accounting. The most significant items recorded included intangible assets of $899.0 million, inventories of $558.0 million, senior 
convertible notes of $409.5 million, and resulting goodwill of $1,234 million. Management utilized third-party valuation specialists to assist in the 
determination of the fair value of the assets acquired. The methods used to estimate the fair value involved significant assumption. 

The principal considerations for our determination that performing procedures relating to the accounting for this transition is a critical audit matter are (i) 
the significant judgment by management when developing the fair value estimates of the assets acquired; (ii) a high degree of auditor judgment, 
subjectivity, and effort in performing procedures and evaluating audit evidence related to management's fair value estimates of the assets acquired; and (iii) 
the audit effort involved the use of professionals with specialized skill and knowledge.

How the Critical Audit Matter Was Addressed in the Audit

Our audit procedures related to the NuVasive Merger included the following, among others: 

• We read the agreement and plan of merger.
• We tested the effectiveness of controls relating to the purchase price allocation, including controls over management’s valuation of the assets 

acquired and liabilities acquired.

• We evaluated the appropriateness of the valuation methods and completeness and accuracy of significant inputs for fair value measurements used 

to develop estimates of assets and liabilities acquired.

• We tested the accuracy of the purchase price allocation and goodwill recorded. 
• We utilized professionals with specialized skill and knowledge to assist in evaluating the appropriateness of the valuation methods and the 

reasonableness of the significant inputs for fair value measurements.

/s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP

Philadelphia, Pennsylvania  
February 20, 2024 

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2017.

63

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the shareholders and the Board of Directors of Globus Medical, Inc.

Opinion on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Globus Medical, Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2023, based on 
criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway 
Commission (COSO). In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 
31, 2023, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by COSO.

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the consolidated 
financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2023, of the Company and our report dated February 20, 2024, expressed an unqualified 
opinion on those financial statements.

As described in Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting, management excluded from its assessment the internal control 
over financial reporting at NuVasive, Inc., which was acquired on September 1, 2023 and whose financial statements constitute 26% of total assets and 
26% of revenues of the consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended December 31, 2023. Accordingly, our audit did not include 
the internal control over financial reporting at NuVasive, Inc.

Basis for Opinion 

The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of 
internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our 
responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm 
registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the 
applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable 
assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an 
understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating 
effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We 
believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting 
and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control 
over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly 
reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit 
preparation  of  financial  statements  in  accordance  with  generally  accepted  accounting  principles,  and  that  receipts  and  expenditures  of  the  company  are 
being  made  only  in  accordance  with  authorizations  of  management  and  directors  of  the  company;  and  (3)  provide  reasonable  assurance  regarding 
prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial 
statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of 
effectiveness  to  future  periods  are  subject  to  the  risk  that  controls  may  become  inadequate  because  of  changes  in  conditions,  or  that  the  degree  of 
compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. 

/s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP

Philadelphia, Pennsylvania
February 20, 2024

64

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

(In thousands, except share and per share values)
ASSETS
Current assets:
Cash and cash equivalents
Short-term marketable securities
Accounts receivable, net of allowances of $8,934 and $4,724, respectively
Inventories
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
Income taxes receivable
Total current assets

Property and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation of $425,695 and $343,036, respectively
Operating lease right of use assets
Long-term marketable securities
Intangible assets, net
Goodwill
Other assets
Deferred income taxes

Total assets

LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
Current liabilities:
Accounts payable
Accrued expenses
Operating lease liabilities
Income taxes payable
Business acquisition liabilities
Deferred revenue

Total current liabilities

Business acquisition liabilities, net of current portion
Operating lease liabilities
Senior convertible notes
Deferred income taxes and other tax liabilities
Other liabilities

Total liabilities

Commitments and contingencies (Note 16)

December 31,
2023

December 31,
2022

  $

 $

 467,292   $
 50,497  
 503,235  
 848,135  
 44,580  
 1,635  
 1,915,374  
 586,932  
 59,931  
 75,428  
 924,603  
 1,434,540  
 78,590  
 10,685  
 5,086,083   $

  $

 56,671   $

 240,460  
 11,967  
 3,845  
 61,035  
 18,369  
 392,347  
 78,323  
 91,037  
 417,400  
 84,421  
 24,596  
 1,088,124  

 150,466
 295,592
 213,247
 298,981
 20,997
 4,061
 983,344
 243,729
 5,988
 495,852
 63,574
 197,471
 37,323
 48,845
 2,076,126

 36,101
 92,169
 2,536
 990
 13,308
 14,100
 159,204
 54,950
 3,475
 —
 1,779
 10,345
 229,753

Equity:
Class A common stock; $0.001 par value.  Authorized 500,000,000 shares; issued and outstanding 113,905,565 
and 77,762,282 shares at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively
Class B common stock; $0.001 par value.  Authorized 275,000,000 shares; issued and outstanding 22,430,097 
and 22,430,097 shares at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively
Additional paid-in capital
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss)
Retained earnings
Total equity
Total liabilities and equity

 $

 114  

 78

 22  
 2,870,749  
 (10,192) 
 1,137,266  
 3,997,959  
 5,086,083   $

 22
 630,952
 (24,630)
 1,239,951
 1,846,373
 2,076,126

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

65

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Net sales

Cost of sales

Gross profit

Operating expenses:

Research and development
Selling, general and administrative
Provision for litigation, net
Amortization of intangibles

Acquisition-related costs
Total operating expenses

Operating income/(loss)

Other income/(expense), net

Interest income/(expense), net
Foreign currency transaction gain/(loss)
Other income/(expense)
Total other income/(expense), net

Income/(loss) before income taxes

Income tax provision

  $

Year Ended
December 31,
2022
 1,022,843   $

2023
 1,568,476   $

 548,174  
 1,020,302  

 263,725  
 759,118  

 124,010  
 643,410  
 434  
 51,032  

 68,274  
 887,160  

 73,015  
 432,117  
 2,341  
 17,735  

 5,959  
 531,167  

2021
 958,102

 239,223
 718,879

 97,346
 408,149
 5,921
 18,526

 16,984
 546,926

 133,142  

 227,951  

 171,953

 20,130  
 14,259  
 (2,138) 
 32,251  

 165,393  
 42,520  

 14,233  
 (1,020) 
 1,855  
 15,068  

 9,297
 (1,423)
 580
 8,454

 243,019  
 52,850  

 180,407
 31,216

Net income/(loss)

  $

 122,873   $

 190,169   $

 149,191

Other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax:
Unrealized gain/(loss) on marketable securities
Foreign currency translation gain/(loss)

Total other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax
Comprehensive income/(loss)

Earnings per share:

Basic
Diluted

Weighted average shares outstanding:

Basic
Diluted

  $

  $
  $

 13,231  
 1,207  
 14,438  
 137,311   $

 (14,040) 
 (3,818) 
 (17,858) 
 172,311   $

 (6,054)
 (4,673)
 (10,727)
 138,464

 1.09   $
 1.07   $

 1.89   $
 1.85   $

 1.48
 1.44

 113,087  
 114,630  

 100,469  
 102,643  

 100,734
 103,623

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

66

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF EQUITY

(In thousands)
Balance at December 31, 2022
Stock-based compensation
Grant of contingent restricted stock units  
Exercise of stock options
Issuance of Class A common stock under 
employee and director equity option 
plans, net
Issuance of equity for NuVasive Merger
Comprehensive income/(loss)
Repurchase and retirement of common 
stock
Balance at December 31, 2023

 77,762  $
 —   
 —   
 387   

 273   
 39,813   
 —   

 78  
 —  
 —  
 0  

 0  
 40  
 —  

Class A
 Common Stock
$

  Shares

Class B
 Common Stock
Shares

$

Additional 
paid-in
capital
 630,952 $
 52,773  
 1,925  
 12,396  

Accumulated 
other 

comprehensive   Retained   
income/(loss)

  earnings

Total

 (24,630) $ 1,239,951 $ 1,846,373
 52,773
 1,925
 12,396

 —   
 —   
 —   

 —  
 —  
 —  

 22,430  $  22  $
 —   
 —   
 —   

 —   
 —   
 —   

 —   
 —   
 —   

 —   
 —   
 —   

 (11,409) 
 2,184,112  
 —  

 —   
 —   
 14,438   

 —  
 —  
 122,873  

 (11,409)
 2,184,152
 137,311

 (4,329)  
 113,906  $

 (4) 
 114  

 —   

 —  
 —   
 22,430  $  22  $ 2,870,749 $

 —   

 (225,562)
 (225,558) 
 (10,192) $ 1,137,266 $ 3,997,959

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

(In thousands)
Balance at December 31, 2021
Stock-based compensation
Grant of contingent restricted stock 
units
Exercise of stock options
Comprehensive income/(loss)
Repurchase and retirement of common 
stock
Balance at December 31, 2022

Class A
 Common Stock  

  Shares  
  79,114   $
 —    

$
 79  
 —  

 —    
 999    
 —    

 (2,351)   
  77,762   $

 —  
 1  
 —  

 (2) 
 78  

Accumulated 
other 

Class B
 Common Stock
Shares

 22,430   $
 —    

Additional 
paid-in  
capital

$
 22  $  553,787  $
 33,466   
 —   

comprehensive   Retained    
income/(loss)

earnings

Total

 (6,772) $ 1,194,272  $ 1,741,388
 33,466

 —   

 —   

 —    
 —    
 —    

 —   
 —   
 —   

 1,985   
 41,714   
 —   

 —   
 —   
 (17,858)  

 —   
 —   
 190,169   

 1,985
 41,715
 172,311

 —    
 22,430   $

 —   
 —   
 22  $  630,952  $

 —   

 (144,493)
 (144,491)  
 (24,630) $ 1,239,951  $ 1,846,373

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

Class A
 Common Stock  

(In thousands)
Balance at December 31, 2020
Stock-based compensation
Grant of contingent restricted stock units  
Exercise of stock options
Comprehensive income/(loss)
Balance at December 31, 2021

  Shares  
  77,284   $
 —    
 —    
 1,830    
 —    
  79,114   $

$
 77  
 —  
 —  
 2  
 —  
 79  

Class B
 Common Stock
Shares

 22,430  $
 —   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 22,430  $

Additional 
paid-in  
capital

$
 22  $  457,161  $
 31,254   
 —   
 1,878   
 —   
 63,494   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 22  $  553,787  $

Accumulated 
other 

comprehensive   Retained    
income/(loss)

earnings

Total

 3,955  $ 1,045,082  $ 1,506,297
 31,254
 —   
 —   
 1,878
 —   
 —   
 63,496
 —   
 —   
 138,464
 149,191   
 (10,727)  
 (6,772) $ 1,194,272  $ 1,741,388

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

67

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(In thousands)
Cash flows from operating activities:
Net income
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

Acquired in-process research and development
Depreciation and amortization
Amortization of premiums on marketable securities
Provision for excess and obsolete inventory
Amortization of inventory fair value step up
Amortization of 2025 Note fair value step up
Stock-based compensation expense
Allowance for doubtful accounts
Change in fair value of business acquisition liabilities
Change in deferred income taxes
(Gain)/loss on disposal of assets, net
Payment of business acquisition related liabilities
Net (gain)/loss from foreign currency adjustment
(Increase) decrease in:
Accounts receivable
Inventories
Prepaid expenses and other assets

Increase (decrease) in:
Accounts payable
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
Income taxes payable/receivable

Net cash provided by/(used in) operating activities
Cash flows from investing activities:
Purchases of marketable securities
Maturities of marketable securities
Sales of marketable securities
Purchases of property and equipment
Acquisition of businesses, net of cash acquired and purchases of intangible and other assets

Net cash provided by/(used in) investing activities
Cash flows from financing activities:

Payment of business acquisition-related liabilities
Net proceeds from exercise of stock options
Payments related to tax withholdings for share-based compensation
Repurchase of common stock

Net cash provided by/(used in) financing activities
Effect of foreign exchange rates on cash
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

Supplemental disclosures of cash flow information:

Income taxes paid, net

Non-cash investing and financing activities:

Equity issued in conjunction with the NuVasive Merger
Accrued purchases of property and equipment

Year Ended
December 31,
2022

2023

2021

$

 122,873   $

 190,169   $

 149,191

 —  
 144,733  
 793  
 10,959  
 71,656  
 8,176  
 52,742  
 3,658  
 17,434  
 (57,789)  
 1,541  
 (3,005)  
 (13,674)  

 (49,914)  
 (70,328)  
 1,148  

 (14,223)  
 17,127  
 (408)  
 243,499  

 (100,643)  
 240,190  
 537,723  
 (78,274)  
 (296,028)  
 302,968  

 (8,039)  
 12,397  
 (10,617)  
 (225,562)  
 (231,821)  
 2,180  
 316,826  
 150,466  
 467,292   $

 150  
 68,252  
 5,389  
 6,400  
 —  
 —  
 32,810  
 (1)  
 5,132  
 (22,223)  
 299  
 (2,647)  
 —  

 (50,843)  
 (61,745)  
 (10,292)  

 14,418  
 6,087  
 (2,887)  
 178,468  

 (419,534)  
 312,221  
 102,433  
 (74,047)  
 (31,435)  
 (110,362)  

 (7,185)  
 41,716  
 —  
 (144,493)  
 (109,962)  
 (747)  
 (42,603)  
 193,069  
 150,466   $

 34,312
 69,867
 2,781
 6,143
 —
 —
 30,586
 1,200
 16,807
 (17,615)
 464
 (210)
 —

 (25,895)
 (11,971)
 (6,178)

 3,684
 17,896
 5,212
 276,274

 (622,359)
 227,908
 109,898
 (56,898)
 (34,488)
 (375,939)

 (9,349)
 63,496
 —
 —
 54,147
 (810)
 (46,328)
 239,397
 193,069

 100,593   $

 77,823   $

 45,027

 2,153,860   $
 7,100   $

 —  
 7,423   $

 —
 4,551

$

  $

  $
$

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

68

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

NOTE 1. BACKGROUND 

(a) The Company 

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 

Globus Medical, Inc., together with its majority-owned or controlled subsidiaries, is a medical device company that develops and commercializes 
healthcare solutions with a mission to improve the quality of life of patients with musculoskeletal disorders. We are primarily focused on implants that 
promote healing in patients with musculoskeletal disorders, including the use of a robotic guidance and navigation system and products to treat patients 
who have experienced orthopedic traumas.

We  are  an  engineering-driven  company  with  a  history  of  rapidly  developing  and  commercializing  advanced  products  and  procedures  to  assist 
surgeons in effectively treating their patients and to address new treatment options. With numerous products launched since the founding of the Company, 
including  10  products  launched  in  2023,  we  offer  a  comprehensive  portfolio  of  innovative  and  differentiated  technologies  that  address  a  variety  of 
musculoskeletal pathologies, anatomies, and surgical approaches.

We are headquartered in Audubon, Pennsylvania, and market and sell our products through our exclusive sales force in the United States, as well 
as within North, Central & South America, Europe, Asia, Africa and Australia. The sales force consists of direct sales representatives and distributor sales 
representatives employed by exclusive independent distributors.

The terms the “Company,” “Globus,” “we,” “us” and “our” refer to Globus Medical, Inc. and, where applicable, our consolidated subsidiaries.

(b) NuVasive Merger

On September 1, 2023, pursuant to that certain merger agreement (the “Merger Agreement”) with NuVasive, Inc. (“NuVasive”) and Zebra Merger 
Sub, Inc. (“Merger Sub”), Merger Sub, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, merged with and into NuVasive, with NuVasive surviving as a wholly 
owned subsidiary of the Company (the “Merger”). Under the Merger Agreement, each share of common stock, par value $0.001 per share, of NuVasive 
issued and outstanding immediately prior to the effective time of the Merger (other than certain excluded shares as described in the Merger Agreement) was 
cancelled and converted into the right to receive 0.75 fully paid and non-assessable shares of Class A common stock of Globus, $0.001 par value per share, 
and the right to receive cash in lieu of fractional shares.

Globus  was  deemed  to  be  the  accounting  acquirer  of  NuVasive  for  accounting  purposes  under  U.S.  generally  accepted  accounting  principles 

(“U.S. GAAP”). Accordingly, prior periods within these consolidated financial statements may not be comparable.

NOTE 2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

(a) Basis of Presentation

The accompanying consolidated financial statements have been prepared in conformity with U.S. GAAP.

(b) Prior Period Reclassifications

Certain  prior  period  amounts  have  been  reclassified  to  conform  to  the  current  period  presentation.  “Operating  lease  right  of  use  assets”  were 
reclassified  out  of  “Other  assets”,  and  “Operating  lease  liabilities”  were  reclassified  out  of  “Accrued  expenses”  and  “Other  liabilities”,  respectively, 
depending on the short-term and long-term nature, on our consolidated balance sheets.

(c) Principles of Consolidation 

The  accompanying  consolidated  financial  statements  include  the  accounts  of  Globus  and  its  majority-owned  or  controlled  subsidiaries.  All 

intercompany balances and transactions are eliminated in consolidation. 

Variable Interest Entities

We  provide  intraoperative  neuromonitoring  (“IONM”)  services  through  various  majority  owned  or  controlled  subsidiaries,  which  collectively 
conduct business as NuVasive Clinical Services. In providing IONM services to surgeons and healthcare facilities across the U.S., the Company maintains 
contractual relationships with several physician practices (“PCs”). In accordance with authoritative guidance, the Company has determined that the PCs are 
variable interest entities and therefore, the accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the PCs from the date of acquisition. 
During the periods presented, the results of the PCs were immaterial to the Company’s 

69

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

financial statements. The creditors of the PCs have claims only to the assets of the PCs, which are not material, and the assets of the PCs are not available 
to the Company.

(d) Use of Estimates 

The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that 
affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements, 
and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. We base our estimates, in part, on historical experience that management 
believes to be reasonable under the circumstances. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Estimates and assumptions are periodically reviewed 
and the effects of revisions are reflected in the consolidated financial statements in the period they are determined to be necessary.

Significant  areas  that  require  estimates  include  revenue  recognition,  intangible  assets,  business  acquisition  liabilities,  allowance  for  doubtful 
accounts, stock-based compensation, reserves for excess and obsolete inventory, fair value measurements, useful lives of assets, the outcome of litigation, 
recoverability  of  intangible  assets  and  income  taxes.  We  are  subject  to  risks  and  uncertainties  due  to  changes  in  the  healthcare  environment,  regulatory 
oversight, competition, and legislation that may cause actual results to differ from estimated results.

(e) Revenue Recognition

In  accordance  with  Accounting  Standards  Codification  606  Revenue  from  Contracts  with  Customers,  (“ASC  606”),  the  Company  recognizes 
revenue upon the transfer of goods or services to a customer at an amount that reflects the expected consideration to be received in exchange for those 
goods  or  services.  The  principles  in  ASC  606  are  applied  using  the  following  five  steps:  (i)  identify  the  contract  with  a  customer;  (ii)  identify  the 
performance  obligation(s)  in  the  contract;  (iii)  determine  the  transaction  price;  (iv)  allocate  the  transaction  price  to  the  performance  obligation(s)  in  the 
contract; and (v) recognize revenue when (or as) the Company satisfies its performance obligation(s). Revenue is recognized upon transfer of control of 
promised products or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration we expect to receive in exchange for those products or services. 
Sales and other taxes we collect concurrent with revenue-producing activities are excluded from revenue. For purposes of disclosure, we disaggregate our 
revenue  into  two  categories,  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  and  Enabling  Technologies.  Our  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  products  consist  primarily  of  the 
implantable devices, disposables, unique instruments, and neuromonitoring services, used in an expansive range of spine, orthopedic trauma, hip, knee and 
extremity procedures. The majority of our Musculoskeletal Solutions contracts have a single performance obligation and revenue is recognized at a point in 
time. For our IONM services, revenue is recognized in the period the service is performed, which can be either point in time or over time, depending how 
the performance obligation is defined for the amount of consideration expected to be received. Our policy is to classify shipping and handling costs billed 
to customers as sales and the related expenses as cost of sales.

Our  Enabling  Technologies  products  are  advanced  hardware  and  software  systems,  and  related  technologies,  that  are  designed  to  enhance  a 
surgeon’s capabilities and streamline surgical procedures by making them less invasive, more accurate, and more reproducible to improve patient care. The 
majority  of  our  Enabling  Technologies  product  contracts  contain  multiple  performance  obligations,  including  maintenance  and  support,  and  revenue  is 
recognized  as  we  fulfill  each  performance  obligation,  generally  at  the  point  in  time  in  which  the  obligation  is  fulfilled.  When  contracts  have  multiple 
performance obligations, we allocate the contract’s transaction price to each performance obligation using our best estimate of the standalone selling price 
of each distinct good or service in the contract.

Nature of Products and Services

A  significant  portion  of  our  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  product  revenue  is  generated  from  consigned  inventory  maintained  at  hospitals  or  with 
sales representatives. Revenue from the sale of consigned musculoskeletal products is recognized when we transfer control, which occurs at the time the 
product  is  used  or  implanted.  For  all  other  Musculoskeletal  Solutions  product  transactions,  we  recognize  revenue  when  we  transfer  control,  which  is 
generally when we transfer the title to the goods, provided there are no remaining performance obligations that can affect the customer’s final acceptance of 
the sale. For Musculoskeletal Solutions service transactions, we recognize revenue in the period the service is performed for the amount of consideration 
expected to be received. In certain cases, we offer the ability for customers to lease surgical instrumentation primarily on a non-sales type basis. 

The  majority  of  Enabling  Technologies  product  contracts  contain  multiple  performance  obligations,  including  maintenance  and  support,  and 
revenue  is  recognized  as  we  fulfill  each  performance  obligation.  When  contracts  have  multiple  performance  obligations,  we  allocate  the  contract’s 
transaction price to each performance obligation using an observable price to determine the standalone selling price of each distinct good or service in the 
contract. Revenue for the performance obligations recognized at a point of time is recognized when we transfer control to the customer, which is generally 
at the point of shipment, but can also be at either delivery or installation, depending on the terms of the arrangement.

70

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Contract Balances

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

Timing of revenue recognition may differ from the timing of invoicing to customers. We record a receivable when revenue is recognized prior to 

invoicing, or deferred revenue when revenue is recognized subsequent to invoicing.

Deferred  revenue  is  comprised  mainly  of  unearned  revenue  related  to  the  sales  of  certain  Enabling  Technologies  products,  which  includes 
maintenance and support services. Maintenance and support services are generally invoiced annually, at the beginning of each contract period, and revenue
is recognized ratably over the maintenance period. For the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, there was an immaterial amount of revenue 
recognized from previously deferred revenue.

(f) Concentrations of Credit Risk

Financial instruments, which potentially subject us to concentrations of credit risk, are primarily marketable securities and accounts receivable. 
Concentrations of credit risk with respect to accounts receivable are limited due to the large number of entities comprising our customer base. We perform 
ongoing credit evaluations of our customers and generally do not require collateral.

There was no customer that accounted for 10% or more of sales for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, respectively.

(g) Cash and Cash Equivalents

The  Company  considers  all  short-term,  highly  liquid  investments  with  original  maturities  of  90  days  or  less  at  acquisition  date  to  be  cash 

equivalents.  Cash equivalents, which consist of money market accounts, commercial paper and corporate debt securities are stated at fair value.

(h) Marketable Securities

Our  marketable  securities  include  municipal  bonds,  corporate  debt  securities,  commercial  paper,  asset-backed  securities,  and  securities  of 
government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations, and are classified as available-for-sale as of December 31, 2023 and 2022. Short-term and 
long-term marketable securities are recorded at fair value on our consolidated balance sheets. Any change in fair value for available-for-sale securities, that 
do  not  result  in  recognition  or  reversal  of  an  allowance  for  credit  loss  or  write  down,  is  recorded,  net  of  taxes,  as  a  component  of  accumulated  other 
comprehensive  income  or  loss  on  our  consolidated  balance  sheets.  Premiums  and  discounts  are  recognized  over  the  life  of  the  related  security  as  an 
adjustment to yield using the straight-line method. Realized gains or losses from the sale of marketable securities are determined on a specific identification 
basis.  Realized  gains  and  losses,  interest  income  and  the  amortization/accretion  of  premiums/discounts  are  included  as  a  component  of  other 
income/(expense), net, on our consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. Interest receivable is recorded as a component of prepaid 
expenses and other current assets on our consolidated balance sheets.

We invest in securities that meet or exceed standards as defined in our investment policy. Our policy also limits the amount of credit exposure to 
any one issue, issuer or type of security. We review declines in the fair value of our securities to determine whether they are resulting from expected credit 
losses  or  other  factors.    If  the  assessment  indicates  a  credit  loss  exists,  we  recognize  any  measured  impairment  as  an  allowance  for  credit  loss  in  our 
consolidated statements of operations. Any other impairments not recorded through allowance for credit losses is recognized in our other comprehensive 
income. 

(i) Fair Value Measurements

Fair  value  is  defined  as  the  price  that  would  be  received  for  an  asset  or  paid  to  transfer  a  liability  (an  exit  price)  in  the  principal  or  most 
advantageous market for the asset or the liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. Additionally, a fair value 
hierarchy  was  established  that  prioritizes  the  inputs  to  valuation  techniques  used  to  measure  fair  value.  The  hierarchy  gives  the  highest  priority  to 
unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs. The level within the fair value 
hierarchy is based on the lowest level of any input that is significant to the fair value measurement.

Our assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis are classified and disclosed in one of the following three categories:

Level 1—quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets and liabilities;

Level 2—observable inputs other than quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities; and

Level 3—unobservable inputs in which there is little or no market data available, which require the reporting entity to use significant unobservable 
inputs or valuation techniques.  

71

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

Contingent  consideration  represents  contingent  milestone,  performance  and  revenue-sharing  payment  obligations  related  to  acquisitions  and  is 
measured at fair value, based on significant inputs that are not observable in the market, which represents a Level 3 measurement within the fair value 
hierarchy. The valuation of contingent consideration uses assumptions we believe would be made by a market participant. We assess these assumptions on 
an ongoing basis as additional data impacting the assumptions is obtained. The fair value of contingent consideration is recorded in business acquisition 
liabilities  on  our  consolidated  balance  sheets,  and  changes  in  the  fair  value  of  contingent  consideration  is  recognized  in  acquisition-related  costs  in  the 
consolidated  statements  of  operations  and  comprehensive  income.  The  fair  value  of  contingent  restricted  stock  unit  grants  (“RSUs”)  are  recorded  as 
additional paid-in capital in the consolidated balance sheet on the day of the grant due to the remote likelihood of forfeiture.

The purchase price of business acquisitions is primarily allocated to the tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed 
based on their estimated fair values on the acquisition date, with the excess recorded as goodwill. We utilize Level 3 inputs in the determination of the 
initial fair value. 

(j) Inventories

Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or net realizable value. Cost is determined on a first-in, first-out basis. The majority of our inventory is 
finished goods and we utilize both in-house manufacturing and third-party suppliers to produce our products. We periodically evaluate the carrying value of 
our inventories in relation to estimated forecasts of product demand, which takes into consideration the life cycle of product releases. When quantities on 
hand exceed estimated sales forecasts, we record a write-down for such excess inventories. Once inventory has been written down, it creates a new cost 
basis for inventory that is not subsequently written up.

(k) Property and Equipment

Property  and  equipment  is  recorded  at  cost  less  accumulated  depreciation.  Additions  or  improvements  are  capitalized,  while  repairs  and 

maintenance are expensed as incurred. Depreciation is recognized using the straight-line method over the related useful lives of the assets.

When  assets  are  sold  or  otherwise  disposed  of,  the  related  property,  equipment,  and  accumulated  depreciation  amounts  are  relieved  from  the 

accounts, and any gain or loss is recorded in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income.

(l) Goodwill and Intangible Assets

Goodwill  represents  the  excess  of  purchase  price  over  the  fair  values  of  the  identifiable  assets  acquired  less  the  liabilities  assumed  in  the 
acquisition of a business. Goodwill is tested for impairment at least annually or whenever events or circumstances indicate that a carrying amount may be 
impaired.  We  perform  our  goodwill  impairment  analysis  at  the  reporting  unit  level. We  perform  our  annual  impairment  analysis  by  either  comparing  a 
reporting  unit’s  estimated  fair  value  to  its  carrying  amount  or  doing  a  qualitative  assessment  of  a  reporting  unit’s  fair  value  from  the  last  quantitative 
assessment to determine if there is potential impairment. We may do a qualitative assessment when the results of the previous quantitative test indicated the 
reporting unit’s estimated fair value was significantly in excess of the carrying value of its net assets and we do not believe there have been significant 
changes in the reporting unit’s operations that would significantly decrease its estimated fair value or significantly increase its net assets. If a quantitative 
assessment is performed, the evaluation includes management estimates of discounted cash flow projections based on internal future projections and/or use 
of a market approach by looking at market values of comparable companies. We perform our annual impairment test of goodwill in the fourth quarter of 
each year.

Intangible  assets  consist  of  purchased  in-process  research  and  development  (“IPR&D”),  developed  technology,  supplier  network,  patents, 
customer relationships, re-acquired rights, and non-compete agreements. Intangible assets with finite useful lives are amortized over the period of estimated 
benefit using the straight-line method and estimated useful lives ranging from one to twenty-one years. Intangible assets with finite useful lives are tested 
whenever events or circumstances indicate that a carrying amount of an asset (asset group) more likely than not is not recoverable. If an impairment is 
indicated, we measure the amount of the impairment loss as the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the fair value of the asset. Fair value is 
generally determined using a discounted future cash flow analysis. 

IPR&D  has  an  indefinite  life  and  is  not  amortized  until  completion  of  the  project  at  which  time  the  IPR&D  becomes  an  amortizable  asset. 
Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are tested for impairment annually or whenever events or circumstances indicate that a carrying amount of an 
asset (asset group) may not be recoverable. If the related project is not completed in a timely manner, we may have an impairment related to the IPR&D, 
calculated as the excess of the asset’s carrying value over its fair value. 

During the twelve months ended December 31, 2023, there were no impairments in goodwill, finite-lived intangible assets, or IPR&D.

72

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

(m) Impairment of Long-Lived Assets

We  periodically  evaluate  the  recoverability  of  the  carrying  amount  of  long-lived  assets,  which  include  property  and  equipment,  as  well  as 
whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset group may not be fully recoverable. An impairment is assessed 
when  the  undiscounted  future  cash  flows  from  the  use  and  eventual  disposition  of  an  asset  group  are  less  than  its  carrying  value.  If  an  impairment  is 
indicated, we measure the amount of the impairment loss as the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the fair value of the asset group. Our fair 
value methodology is based on quoted market prices, if available. If quoted market prices are not available, an estimate of fair value is made based on 
prices of similar assets or other valuation techniques including present value techniques. During the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, we 
did not record any impairment charges related to long-lived assets.

(n) Cost of Sales

Cost of sales consists primarily of costs from our manufacturing operations, costs of products purchased from third-party suppliers, reserves for 
excess  and  obsolete  inventory,  depreciation  of  surgical  instruments  and  cases,  royalties,  shipping,  inspection  and  related  costs  incurred  in  making  our 
products available for sale or use. 

(o) Research and Development

Research  and  development  costs  are  expensed  as  incurred.  Research  and  development  costs  include  salaries,  employee  benefits,  supplies, 
consulting services, clinical services and clinical trial costs, and facilities costs. Costs incurred in obtaining technology licenses and patents are charged 
immediately to research and development expense if the technology licensed has not reached technological feasibility and has no alternative future use.

(p) Stock-Based Compensation

The cost of employee and non-employee director awards is measured at the grant date fair value of the award and is recognized as expense over 
the requisite service period, which is generally the vesting period of the equity award. Expense for performance-based restricted stock units is recognized 
when the performance condition is deemed to be probable. Compensation expense for awards includes the impact of forfeiture in the period when they 
occur.

We estimate the fair value of stock options utilizing the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. Inputs to the Black-Scholes model include our stock 
price,  expected  volatility,  expected  term,  risk-free  interest  rate  and  expected  dividends.  Expected  volatility  is  based  on  the  historical  volatility  of  the 
Company’s common stock over the most recent period commensurate with the estimated expected term of the Company’s stock options offering period 
which is derived from historical experience. The risk-free interest rate assumption is based on observed interest rates of U.S. Treasury securities appropriate 
for the expected terms of the stock options. The dividend yield assumption is based on the history and expectation of no dividend payouts. The respective 
fair values of restricted stock units and performance restricted stock units are estimated on the day of grant based on the closing price of the Company’s 
common stock.

We assumed equity-classified awards for certain NuVasive RSUs, and performance restricted stock units (“PRSUs”), as part of the Merger. These 
RSUs and PRSUs are measured at the grant date based on the estimated fair value of the award. The fair value of equity instruments that are expected to
vest is recognized and amortized over the requisite service period. The Company has granted awards with up to five year graded or cliff vesting terms (in 
each case, with service through the date of vesting being required). No exercise price or other monetary payment is required for receipt of the shares issued 
in settlement of the respective award; instead, consideration is furnished in the form of the participant’s service to the Company.

The  fair  value  of  RSUs  including  PRSUs  with  pre-defined  performance  criteria  is  based  on  the  stock  price  on  the  date  of  grant  whereas  the 

expense for PRSUs with pre-defined performance criteria is adjusted with the probability of achievement of such performance criteria at each period end.

(q) Derivative Financial Instruments

The Company recognizes all derivative instruments as assets or liabilities in its Consolidated Balance Sheets and measures these instruments at 
fair value by revaluing these assets and liabilities at the end of each reporting period. Gains and losses are recorded as a component of other expense, net in 
the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. The effects of these derivative instruments are immaterial to the Company’s financial 
statements. 

73

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

(r) Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) 

Other comprehensive income (loss) is defined as the change in equity during a period from transactions and other events and circumstances from 
non-owner sources. Other comprehensive income (loss) includes net of tax, unrealized gains or losses on the Company’s marketable debt securities and 
foreign currency translation adjustments.

(s) Provision for Litigation

We are involved in a number of proceedings, legal actions, and claims. Such matters are subject to many uncertainties, and the outcomes of these 
matters are not within our control and may not be known for prolonged periods of time. In some actions, the claimants seek damages, as well as other 
relief, including injunctions prohibiting us from engaging in certain activities, which, if granted, could require significant expenditures and/or result in lost 
revenues.  We  record  a  liability  in  the  consolidated  financial  statements  for  these  actions  when  a  loss  is  considered  probable  and  the  amount  can  be 
reasonably  estimated.  If  the  reasonable  estimate  of  a  probable  loss  is  a  range,  and  no  amount  within  the  range  is  a  better  estimate  than  any  other,  the 
minimum amount of the range is accrued. If a loss is reasonably possible but not known or probable, and can be reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or 
range of loss is disclosed. In most cases, significant judgment is required to estimate the amount and timing of a loss to be recorded. We expense legal costs 
related to loss contingencies as incurred. 

(t) Acquisition-Related Costs

Acquisition-related costs represents the change in fair value of business acquisition-related contingent consideration and specific costs related to 

the consummation of the acquisition process such as banker fees, legal fees and other acquisition-related professional fees.

(u) Foreign Currency Translation

The  functional  currency  of  our  foreign  subsidiaries  is  generally  their  local  currency.  Assets  and  liabilities  of  the  foreign  subsidiaries,  and 
intercompany receivables and payables of a long-term investment nature, are translated at the period end currency exchange rate and revenues and expenses 
are translated at an average currency exchange rate for the period. The resulting foreign currency translation gains and losses are included as a component 
of  accumulated  other  comprehensive  income.  Gains  and  losses  arising  from  intercompany  foreign  transactions  are  included  in  other  income,  net  on  the 
consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income.

(v) Accounts Receivable and Related Valuation Accounts 

Accounts receivable in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are presented net of allowances for expected credit losses. We maintain an 
allowance for expected credit losses resulting from the inability of its customers, including hospitals, ambulatory surgery centers, and distributors, to make 
required payments. The allowance for credit losses is calculated quarterly and is estimated on a region-by-region basis considering a number of factors 
including age of account balances, collection history, historical account write-offs, third-party credit reports, identified trends, current economic conditions, 
and supportable forecasted economic expectations. The allowance is adjusted on a specific identification basis for certain accounts as well as pooling of 
accounts with similar characteristics. An increase in the provision for credit losses may be required when the financial condition of our customers or their 
collection experience deteriorates. Our exposure to credit losses may also increase if its customers are adversely affected by changes in healthcare laws, 
coverage  and  reimbursement,  macroeconomic  pressures  or  uncertainty  associated  with  local  or  global  economic  recessions,  disruption  associated  with 
pandemics, or other customer-specific factors. 

(w) Income Taxes 

Deferred  tax  assets  and  liabilities  are  recognized  for  the  future  tax  consequences  attributable  to  differences  between  the  financial  statement 
carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates 
expected to apply to taxable income in the year in which such items are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities 
of a change in tax rates is recognized in the period that includes the enactment date. A valuation allowance is established to offset any deferred tax assets if, 
based upon available evidence, it is more likely than not that some or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized.

Significant judgment is required in determining income tax provisions and in evaluating tax positions. We will establish additional provisions for 
income  taxes  when,  despite  the  belief  that  tax  positions  are  fully  supportable,  there  remain  certain  positions  that  do  not  meet  the  minimum  probability 
threshold that a tax position is more likely than not to be sustained upon examination by the taxing authority. In the normal course of business, we and our 
subsidiaries are examined by various federal, state, and foreign tax authorities. We regularly assess the potential outcomes of these examinations and any 
future examinations for the current or prior years in determining the adequacy of the provision for income taxes. We periodically assess the likelihood and 
amount of potential adjustments and adjust the income tax provision, the current tax liability, and deferred taxes in the period in which the facts that give 
rise to a revision become known.

74

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

(x) Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements 

In December 2023, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”), issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2023-09, Income 

Taxes (Topic 740), Improvements to Income Tax Disclosures, to enhance the transparency and decision usefulness of income tax disclosures. The 
enhancement will provide information to better assess how an entity’s operations and related tax risks and tax planning and operational opportunities affect 
its tax rate and prospects for future cash flows. Investors currently rely on the rate reconciliation table and other disclosures, including total income taxes 
paid, to evaluate income tax risks and opportunities. This update is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2024 and early adoption is 
permitted. The amendments should be applied prospectively with retrospective applications also permitted. The Company is currently evaluating the 
impact the standard will have on its consolidated financial statements and related disclosures.

In November 2023, the FASB, issued ASU No. 2023-07, Segment Reporting (Topic 280), Improvements to Reportable Segment Disclosures, to 
improve  reportable  segment  disclosure  requirements.  The  amendment  introduced  new  requirementd  to  disclose  significant  segment  expenses  regularly 
provided  to  the  chief  operating  decision  maker (“CODM”),  extend  certain  annual  disclosures  to  interim  periods,  clarify  single  reportable  segment 
entities must apply ASC 280 in its entirety, permit more than one measure of segment profit or loss to be reported under certain conditions, and require 
disclosure of the title and position of the CODM. This update is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2023 and interim periods within 
fiscal years after December 15, 2024, early adoption is permitted. The amendments should be applied retrospectively. The Company is currently evaluating 
the impact the standard will have on its consolidated financial statements and related disclosures.

In June 2022, the FASB issued ASU No. 2022-03, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820), Fair Value Measurement of Equity Securities Subject to 
Contractual Sale Restrictions, which clarifies that a contractual restriction on the sale of an equity security is not considered part of the unit of account of 
the equity security and, therefore, is not considered in measuring fair value. The ASU introduces new disclosure requirements to provide investors with 
information about contractual restrictions, including the nature and remaining duration of such restrictions. This update is effective for fiscal years 
beginning after December 15, 2023, and interim periods within those fiscal years, with early adoption permitted. The amendments should be applied 
prospectively with any adjustments from the adoption of the amendments recognized in earnings and disclosed on the date of adoption. The Company is 
currently evaluating the impact the standard will have on its consolidated financial statements.

(y) Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements 

In October 2021, the FASB issued ASU No. 2021-08, Business Combinations (Topic 805), Accounting for Contract Assets and Contract Liabilities 
from  Contracts  with  Customers,  which  requires  an  entity  (acquirer)  to  recognize  and  measure  contract  assets  and  liabilities  acquired  in  a  business 
combination  in  accordance  with  Accounting  Standards  Codification  (“ASC”)  Topic  606,  Revenue  from  Contracts  with  Customers  (“ASC  606”).  This 
update is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2022, and interim periods within those fiscal years, with early adoption permitted. The 
amendments should be applied prospectively to business combinations occurring on or after the effective date of the amendments. The Company adopted 
ASU No. 2021-08 as of January 1, 2023. The adoption did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.  

On  March  12,  2020,  the  FASB  issued  ASU  No.  2020-04,  Facilitation  of  the  Effects  of  Reference  Rate  Reform  on  Financial  Reporting,  which 
provides  optional  expedients  and  exceptions  for  applying  generally  accepted  accounting  principles  to  contract  modifications  and  hedging  relationships, 
subject to meeting certain criteria, that reference LIBOR or another reference rate expected to be discontinued. The ASU is effective for all entities as of 
March 12, 2020, and will apply, as later extended by ASU No. 2022-06, Reference Rate Reform (Topic 848): Deferral of the Sunset Date of Topic 848, 
through December 31, 2024. To date, we have had no impacts on our investment portfolio or our credit agreement with Citizens Bank, N.A. related to 
reference rate reform. We will continue to evaluate the impact this guidance could have on our consolidated financial statements and related disclosures.

75

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

NOTE 3. ASSET ACQUISITIONS AND BUSINESS COMBINATIONS

Asset Acquisitions

During the fourth quarter of 2021, the Company acquired substantially all the assets of Capstone Surgical Technologies, LLC, which engages in 
the business of advanced drill and robotic surgery platforms. The Company determined the transaction was an asset acquisition, by an analysis of the screen 
test  in  accordance  with  ASU  No.  2017-01  in  which  substantially  all  of  the  value  was  concentrated  in  a  single  identifiable  asset  or  a  group  of  similar 
identifiable assets. The purchase price consisted of $24.5 million of cash paid at closing, subject to net working capital and other post-closing adjustments, 
if applicable. The transaction also provides for additional consideration contingent upon the developed products obtaining approval from the FDA of up to 
$15.0  million,  and  additional  consideration  contingent  upon  the  achievement  of  certain  performance  obligations  of  up  to  $10.0  million.  Contingent 
consideration is not recorded in an asset acquisition until the milestone is met. 

Also  during  the  fourth  quarter  of  2021,  the  Company  acquired  substantially  all  the  assets  of  a  company  that  engages  in  the  development  of 
technology for use in robotic surgery platforms which was not considered material to the consolidated financial statements during the periods presented. 
The  Company  determined  the  transaction  was  an  asset  acquisition,  by  an  analysis  of  the  screen  test  in  accordance  with  ASU  No.  2017-01  in  which 
substantially all of the value was concentrated in a single identifiable asset or a group of similar identifiable assets. The purchase price consisted of $10.0 
million of cash paid at closing and also provides for additional consideration contingent upon the achievement of certain performance obligations of $5.0 
million. Contingent consideration is not recorded in an asset acquisition until the milestone is met. 

Business Combinations

During the fourth quarter of 2022, the Company acquired the membership interests of Harvest Biologics LLC (the “Harvest Acquisition”), which 
engages in the business of selling systems that produce autologous biologics. The purchase price was a cash payment of $30 million, subject to post-closing 
adjustments, if applicable. The Company has included the financial results from the Harvest Acquisition in our consolidated financial statements from the 
acquisition date. At acquisition date, the preliminary fair value of the net assets acquired was $30.1 million. The purchase price consisted of approximately 
$30.0 million of cash paid at closing, plus $0.1 million of preliminary post-closing adjustments. The Company recorded identifiable net assets, based on 
their estimated fair values, for inventory of $3.0 million, goodwill of $14.2 million, customer relationships and other intangibles of $10.5 million with a 
weighted  average  useful  life  of  20  years,  and  developed  technology  of  $2.4  million  with  a  weighted  average  useful  life  of  8  years.  The  Company  has 
finalized the purchase price allocation of the assets and liabilities acquired.

During  the  second  quarter  of  2022,  the  Company  completed  one  acquisition  that  was  not  considered  material  to  the  consolidated  financial 
statements  during  the  periods  presented.  This  acquisition  has  been  included  in  the  consolidated  financial  statements  from  the  date  of  acquisition.  The 
purchase price consisted of approximately $0.2 million of cash paid at closing and $4.4 million of contingent consideration payments, resulting in goodwill 
of $4.6 million based on the estimated fair values. The contingent payments for this acquisition are based upon achieving various performance milestones 
over a period of 10 years and are payable in a combination of cash and RSUs.

During  2021,  the  Company  completed  three  acquisitions  that  were  not  considered  material,  individually  or  collectively,  to  the  consolidated 
financial statements during the periods presented. Two acquisitions were completed in the third quarter, while the third acquisition was completed in the 
fourth  quarter.  These  acquisitions  have  been  included  in  the  consolidated  financial  statements  from  the  date  of  acquisition.  The  purchase  price  of  the 
acquisition in the fourth quarter consisted of approximately $0.3 million of cash paid at closing and $13.0 million of contingent consideration payments, 
resulting in goodwill of $13.3 million based on the estimated fair values. The combined purchase price of the two acquisitions in the third quarter consisted 
of  approximately  $12.6  million  of  contingent  consideration  payments.  The  Company  recorded  other  intangible  assets  of  $1.6  million,  with  a  weighted 
average useful life of 3.8 years, and goodwill of $11.0 million based on their estimated fair values. The contingent payments for all three acquisitions are 
based upon achieving various performance obligations over a period of 10 years and are payable in a combination of cash and RSUs.

NuVasive Merger

On September 1, 2023, pursuant to that certain Merger Agreement with NuVasive and Merger Sub, Merger Sub, a wholly owned subsidiary of the 
Company, merged with and into NuVasive, with NuVasive surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company. Under the Merger Agreement, each 
share of common stock, par value $0.001 per share, of NuVasive issued and outstanding immediately prior to the effective time of the Merger (other than 
certain excluded shares as described in the Merger Agreement) was cancelled and converted into the right to receive 0.75 fully paid and non-assessable 
shares  of  Class  A  common  stock  of  Globus,  $0.001  par  value  per  share,  and  the  right  to  receive  cash  in  lieu  of  fractional  shares.  NuVasive  has  a 
comprehensive  procedural  portfolio  including  surgical  access  instruments,  spinal  implants,  fixation  systems,  biologics,  software  for  surgical  planning, 
navigation and imaging solutions, magnetically adjustable implant systems for spine and orthopedics, and IONM technology and service offerings.

76

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

As part of the Merger, the Company assumed equity awards for certain NuVasive RSUs and NuVasive PRSUs in accordance with the terms of the 
Merger Agreement. Certain awards included a change in control provision (single trigger) which accelerated the vesting of the awards on the closing date 
of the Merger. These awards were considered as part of the total purchase price. The unvested awards will continue to vest in accordance with the terms of 
the original award agreement, except for certain PRSUs that were converted into RSUs. Once vested, the holders will receive shares of the Company’s 
Class A common stock. Of the total consideration for the assumed equity awards, $28.6 million was allocated to the purchase price and $42.3 million was 
deemed compensatory as it was attributable to post acquisition vesting. Of the $42.3 million of total compensation related to the assumed awards, $12.9 
million  was  expensed  on  the  acquisition  date  due  to  accelerated  vesting  of  the  awards,  recognized  as  Merger-related  costs,  and  $29.4 million relates to 
future services and will be expensed over the remaining service periods of the unvested awards on a straight-line basis. Of the $29.4 million related to 
future services, $4.9 million of expense was recognized for the year ended December 31, 2023.

Concurrently with the Merger, the Company repaid the outstanding $420.8 million under NuVasive’s revolving senior credit facility in addition to 
assuming the 0.375% Senior Convertible Notes due 2025 (“2025 Notes”), the privately negotiated call options (“2025 Hedge”) and the privately negotiated 
warrants (“2025 Warrants”). 

The aggregate consideration in connection with the closing of the Merger was as follows:

(In thousands)
NuVasive shares outstanding as of September 1, 2023
NuVasive accelerated equity awards
Globus exchange ratio
Globus Class A Common Stock issued in exchange for NuVasive shares
Globus closing share price
Total Value Class A Common Stock

2025 Warrants
Repayment of revolving credit facility
Fair value of assumed equity awards
Total purchase price

 52,451
 632
 0.75
 39,813
$54.10
 2,153,860

 579
 420,762
 28,635
 2,603,836

$

$

We accounted for the Merger using the acquisition method of accounting, which requires the NuVasive assets and liabilities to be recorded on our 
balance sheet at fair value as of the acquisition date. We will complete a final determination of the fair value of certain assets and liabilities within the one-
year  measurement  period  from  the  date  of  the  acquisition  as  required  by  FASB  ASC  Topic  805,  “Business  Combinations”.  The  preliminary  fair  value 
estimates for the assets acquired and liabilities assumed were based upon preliminary calculations, valuations, and assumptions that are subject to change as 
the Company obtains additional information during the measurement period. 

77

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

(In thousands)
Current assets (excluding accounts receivable and inventories)
Accounts receivable
Inventories
Property, plant, and equipment
Operating lease ROU asset
Intangible assets
Other long-term assets
Deferred income taxes
Total Assets

Current Liabilities
Operating lease liabilities, including current portion
Business acquisition liabilities, including current portion
Senior convertible notes
Deferred income taxes and other tax liabilities
Other liabilities
Total liabilities

Fair value of acquired identifiable assets and liabilities

Purchase price
Less: Fair value of acquired identifiable assets and liabilities
Goodwill

Preliminary Purchase Price 
Allocation as of September 30, 
2023

Measurement Period 
and Other 
Adjustments

Purchase Price 
Allocation as of 
December 31, 2023 
(as adjusted)

$

$

$

$

$
$
$

$

$

$

$

 158,112  
 249,591  
 570,300  
 361,118  
 90,457  
 1,222,000  
 25,973  
 4,837  
 2,682,388  

 185,175  
 109,110  
 66,873  
 409,500  
 194,553  
 37,496  
 1,002,707  

 1,679,681  

 2,603,836  
 (1,679,681) 
 924,155  

 38  
 (6,912) 
 (12,266) 
 598  
 (32,174) 
 (323,000) 
 13,111  
 977  
 (359,628) 

 (1,718) 
 (7,758) 
 —  
 —  
 (16,035) 
 (23,797) 
 (49,308) 

 (310,320) 

$

$

$

$

$
$
$

 158,150
 242,679
 558,034
 361,716
 58,283
 899,000
 39,084
 5,814
 2,322,760

 183,457
 101,352
 66,873
 409,500
 178,518
 13,699
 953,399

 1,369,362

 2,603,836
 (1,369,362)
 1,234,475

The excess of the purchase price over the net tangible and intangible assets is recorded to Goodwill and primarily reflects the assembled workforce 
and expected synergies. The majority of goodwill is non-deductible for tax purposes. During the year ended December 31, 2023, total transaction costs 
incurred  in  connection  with  the  Merger  were  $49.8  million.  These  transaction  costs  were  recognized  as  acquisition-related  costs  in  the  consolidated 
statements of operations and comprehensive income.

Details  of  our  valuation  methodology  and  significant  inputs  for  fair  value  measurements  are  included  below.  The  fair  value  measurements  for 
property, plant and equipment and intangible assets are based on significant inputs that are not observable in the market and, therefore, represent Level 3 
measurements.

The preliminary fair value of work-in-process and finished goods inventory utilizes a sales comparison approach which estimates the selling price 

of the inventory in completed condition less costs of disposal and a reasonable profit allowance for the selling effort.

The  preliminary  fair  value  of  property  and  equipment  utilizes  a  combination  of  the  cost  approach,  income  approach,  and  sales  comparison 

approach less amounts for capitalized research and development costs existing on NuVasive’s closing balance sheet.

The preliminary fair value of the identifiable intangible assets was determined using variations of the income approach, namely the multi-period 
excess  earnings  and  relief  from  royalty  methodologies.  The  most  significant  assumptions  applied  in  the  development  of  the  intangible  asset  fair  values 
include: the amount and timing of future cash flows, the selection of discount and royalty rates, and the assessment of the asset’s economic life. 

The preliminary fair value of the operating lease ROU asset utilizes a market approach in determination of the measured asset. The preliminary 

fair value of the operating lease liability utilizes a discounted cost approach in determination of the measured liability.

78

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

The identifiable intangible assets acquired are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. The following table summarizes 

the estimated fair value of NuVasive’s identifiable intangible assets acquired and their remaining amortization period (in years):

(In thousands)
Developed Technology
Customer Relationships

Fair Value as of

December 31, 2023

$

 607,000  
 292,000  

Useful Life

 8
 11

Preliminary fair value of the 2025 Notes was determined using the publicly traded price.

NuVasive’s results have been included in the Company’s financial statements for the period subsequent to the date of the acquisition on September 1, 2023. 
NuVasive  contributed  revenues  of  $414.9  million,  for  the  period  from  September  1,  2023  to  December  31,  2023.  Due  to  the  continuing  integration  of 
NuVasive’s operations into the Company, it is impractical to determine NuVasive’s net income/loss during the period, which is included in the Company’s 
Net Income.

Supplemental Unaudited Pro Forma Information

The following are the supplemental consolidated financial results of Globus and NuVasive on an unaudited pro forma basis, as if the acquisitions 

had been consummated as of the beginning of fiscal year 2022.

(In thousands)
Pro forma net sales
Pro forma net income

Year Ended

December 31,

$

2023

 2,395,812
 121,017

2022
  $  2,224,785
 (27,281)

The unaudited pro forma net income for the year ended December 31, 2023 was adjusted to exclude $111.4 million of acquisition-related costs 

incurred in 2023. The unaudited pro forma net income for the year ended December 31, 2022, was adjusted to include the aforementioned charges.

NOTE 4. NET SALES

The following table represents net sales by product category: 

(In thousands)
Musculoskeletal Solutions
Enabling Technologies
Total net sales

$

$

2023

 1,448,260   $
 120,216    
 1,568,476   $

Year Ended
December 31,
2022

 926,703  
 96,140  
 1,022,843  

$

$

2021

 876,780
 81,322
 958,102

79

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

NOTE 5. MARKETABLE SECURITIES 

The composition of our short-term and long-term marketable securities is as follows:

(In thousands)
Short-term:

Municipal bonds
Corporate debt securities
Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations

Total short-term marketable securities

Long-term:

Municipal bonds
Corporate debt securities
Asset-backed securities
Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations

Total long-term marketable securities

(In thousands)

Short-term:

Municipal bonds
Corporate debt securities
Commercial paper
Asset-backed securities
Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations

Total short-term marketable securities

Long-term:

Municipal bonds
Corporate debt securities
Asset-backed securities
Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations

Total long-term marketable securities

December 31, 2023

Amortized
 Cost

Gross
 Unrealized
 Gains

Gross Unrealized 
Losses

Fair
 Value

$

$

$

$

  $

  $

  $

  $

 11,210
 38,416
 2,004
 51,630

 7,180
 21,707
 17,499
 30,363
 76,749

  $

  $

  $

  $

 —   $
 —  
 —  
 —   $

 —   $
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —   $

 (224)
 (853)
 (56)
 (1,133)

  $

  $

 (109)
 (432)
 (338)
 (442)
 (1,321)

  $

  $

Amortized
 Cost

December 31, 2022

Gross
 Unrealized
 Gains

Gross
 Unrealized
 Losses

 83,279   $

 187,174  
 5,583  
 4,200  
 21,102  
 301,338   $

 61,986   $

 268,524  
 120,929  
 58,453  
 509,892   $

 9   $
 2  
 —  
 —  
 1  
 12   $

 44   $
 72  
 217  
 18  
 351   $

 (1,680)  $
 (3,438) 
 (1) 
 (181) 
 (458) 
 (5,758)  $

 (1,549)  $
 (8,947) 
 (2,795) 
 (1,100) 
 (14,391)  $

 10,986
 37,563
 1,948
 50,497

 7,071
 21,275
 17,161
 29,921
 75,428

Fair
 Value

 81,608
 183,738
 5,582
 4,019
 20,645
 295,592

 60,481
 259,649
 118,351
 57,371
 495,852

The short-term marketable securities have effective maturity dates of less than one year  and  the  long-term  marketable  securities  have  effective 

maturity dates ranging from one to three years as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively.

NOTE 6. FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS 

The following table represents the fair value of assets and liabilities, as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included the following: 

80

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

(In thousands)
Assets:
Cash equivalents
Municipal bonds
Corporate debt securities
Asset-backed securities
Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations
2025 Hedge
Liabilities:
Senior Convertible Notes due 2025
Bifurcated Conversion Option of the Senior Convertible Notes due 2025    
Business acquisition liabilities

  $

Balance at
 December 31,
 2023

Level 1

Level 2

Level 3

 203,689   $

 —   $

 203,689   $
 18,057  
 58,838  
 17,161  
 31,869  
 687  

 —  
 —  
 —  
 2,928  
 —  

 417,363  
 687  
 139,358  

 417,363  
 —  
 —  

 18,057  
 58,838  
 17,161  
 28,941  
 687  

 —  
 687  
 —  

 —
 —
 —
 —
 —
 —

 —
 —
 139,358

(In thousands)
Assets:
Cash equivalents
Municipal bonds
Corporate debt securities
Commercial paper
Asset-backed securities
Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations

Liabilities:
Business acquisition liabilities

Balance at
 December 31,
 2022

Level 1

Level 2

Level 3

  $

 17,655   $
 142,089    
 443,387    
 5,582    
 122,370    
 78,016    

 17,655   $
 —    
 —    
 —    
 —    
 —    

 —   $

 142,089  
 443,387  
 5,582  
 122,370  
 78,016  

 —
 —
 —
 —
 —
 —

 68,258    

 —    

 —  

 68,258

Our marketable securities are classified as Level 2 within the fair value hierarchy, as we measure their fair value using quoted market prices for 
similar instruments and inputs such as actual trade data, benchmark yields, broker/dealer quotes and other similar data obtained from quoted market prices 
or independent pricing vendors.

The bifurcated conversion option and 2025 Hedge are classified as Level 2 within the fair value hierarchy, based on implied equity volatility.  The 
estimated  fair  value  of  the  2025  Notes,  inclusive  of  the  embedded  conversion  option,  at  December  31,  2023  was  $418.0  million.  The  fair  value  was 
determined based on the quoted price of the 2025 Notes in an active market on the last trading day of the reporting period and has been classified as Level 
1 within the fair value hierarchy.

81

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
   
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
   
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

Fair  value  of  the  revenue-based  business  acquisition  liabilities  was  determined  using  a  discounted  cash  flow  model  and  an  option  pricing 
methodology. The significant inputs of such models are not observable in the market, such as certain financial metric growth rates, volatility and discount 
rates,  market  price  risk  adjustment,  projections  associated  with  the  applicable  milestone,  the  interest  rate,  and  the  related  probabilities  and  payment 
structure in the contingent consideration arrangement. The following are the significant unobservable inputs used in the two valuation techniques:

Unobservable input
Revenue risk premium
Revenue volatility
Discount rate

Projected year of payment
* The weighted average rates were calculated based on the relative fair value of each business acquisition liability.

2.0%
12.5%
5.9%

2024

Range
-
-
-

-

5.5%
15.8%
8.5%

2032

  Weighted Average*

2.7%
13.9%
6.6%

The change in the carrying value of the business acquisition liabilities during the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included 

the following: 

(In thousands)
Beginning balance
Purchase price contingent consideration

Contingent cash payments

Contingent RSU grants

Changes in fair value of business acquisition liabilities

Contractual payable reclassification
Ending balance

Year Ended
December 31,

2023

2022

$

$

 68,258   $
 66,873  

 (11,044) 

 (1,925) 

 17,434  

 (238) 
 139,358   $

 70,525
 4,414

 (9,787)

 (1,986)

 5,132

 (40)
 68,258

We  translate  the  financial  statements  of  our  foreign  subsidiaries  with  functional  currencies  other  than  the  U.S.  dollar  into  the  U.S.  dollar  for 
consolidation using end-of-period exchange rates for assets and liabilities and average exchange rates during each reporting period for results of operations. 
Some of our reporting entities conduct a portion of their business in currencies other than the entity’s functional currency. These transactions give rise to 

receivables  and  payables  that  are  denominated  in  currencies  other  than  the  entity’s  functional  currency.  The  value  of  these  receivables  and  payables  is 
subject  to  changes  in  currency  exchange  rates  from  the  point  at  which  the  transactions  are  originated  until  the  settlement  in  cash.  Both  realized  and 
unrealized gains and losses in the value of these receivables and payables are included in the determination of net income or loss. Net currency exchange 

gains/(losses), which include gains and losses from derivative instruments, were $14.1 million and ($1.0) million for the year ended December 31, 2023 
and December 31, 2022, respectively, and are included in other expense, net in the Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income.

To  manage  foreign  currency  exposure  risks,  we  may  use  derivatives  for  activities  in  entities  that  have  short-term  intercompany  receivables  and 
payables  denominated  in  a  currency  other  than  the  entity’s  functional  currency.  The  fair  value  is  based  on  a  quoted  market  price  (Level  1).  As  of 
December  31,  2023,  a  notional  principal  amount  of  $10.0  million  was  outstanding  to  hedge  currency  risk  relative  to  our  foreign  currency-denominated 
receivables and payables. Derivative instrument net losses on our forward exchange contracts were $0.1 million as of December 31, 2023 and are included 
in other expense, net in the Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income. The fair value of the forward exchange contract derivative 
instrument  asset  (liability)  was  di  minimis  as  of  December  31,  2023.  The  derivative  instruments  are  recorded  in  other  current  assets  or  other  current 
liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets commensurate with the nature of the instrument at period end.

NOTE 7. INVENTORIES

Inventories as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included the following:

(In thousands)
Raw materials
Work in process
Finished goods
Total inventories

December 31,

2023

 103,349   $
 37,321  
 707,465  
 848,135   $

2022

 60,324
 18,699
 219,958
 298,981

  $

  $

82

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

As part of the NuVasive Merger, a step-up in the value of inventory of $202.6 million was recorded, which was composed of $3.0 million for work 
in process and $199.6 million for finished goods. The amortization of the inventory step-up recorded in product cost of sales was $71.7 million for the year 
ended December 31, 2023, respectively. As of December 31, 2023, the total remaining balance of inventory step-up was $131.1 million.

During years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, net adjustments to cost of sales related to excess and obsolete inventory were $10.9 

million, $6.4 million, and $6.1 million, respectively. The net adjustments for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021 reflect a combination of 
additional expense for excess and obsolete related provisions ($18.1 million, $18.5 million, and $20.2 million, respectively) offset by sales and disposals 
($7.2 million, $12.1 million, and $14.1 million, respectively) of inventory for which an excess and obsolete provision was previously recorded.

NOTE 8. PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT

Property and equipment as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included the following:

(In thousands)
Land
Buildings and improvements
Equipment
Instruments, modules, and cases
Other property and equipment

Less: accumulated depreciation and amortization
Total

Useful
Life
—
31.5
5-15
5
3-5

December 31,
2023

December 31,
2022

  $

  $

 9,748   $

 102,449  
 206,392  
 672,018  
 22,020  
 1,012,627  
 (425,695) 
 586,932   $

 8,277
 51,510
 148,803
 360,078
 18,097
 586,765
 (343,036)
 243,729

Instruments are hand-held devices used by surgeons to install implants during surgery. Modules and cases are used to store and transport the 

instruments and implants.

Depreciation expense related to property and equipment was as follows:

(In thousands)

Depreciation

NOTE 9. GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS

Year Ended
December 31,

2022

2023

2021

  $ 

 93,702

$

 50,517

$

51,342

The change in the carrying amount of goodwill during the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included the following:

(In thousands)
December 31, 2021
Additions and adjustments
Foreign exchange
December 31, 2022
Additions and adjustments
Foreign exchange
December 31, 2023

83

  $

  $

 179,708
 18,799
 (1,036)
 197,471
 1,235,890
 1,179
 1,434,540

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

Intangible assets as of December 31, 2023 included the following:

(In thousands)
Supplier network
Customer relationships & other intangibles
Developed technology
Patents
Total intangible assets

Intangible assets as of December 31, 2022 included the following:

(In thousands)
Supplier network
Customer relationships & other intangibles
Developed technology
Patents
Total intangible assets

Weighted
Average
Amortization
Period 
(in years)
10.0
10.6
8.0
16.1

Weighted
Average
Amortization
Period 
(in years)
10.0
8.7
8.0
16.1

December 31, 2023

Gross
 Carrying
 Amount

Accumulated
 Amortization

  $

  $

 4,000   $

 353,849  
 695,226  
 9,266  
 1,062,341   $

 (3,667)  $
 (54,871) 
 (74,636) 
 (4,564) 
 (137,738)  $

Intangible
 Assets,
 net

 333
 298,978
 620,590
 4,702
 924,603

December 31, 2022

Gross
 Carrying
 Amount

Accumulated
 Amortization

Intangible
 Assets,
 net

  $

  $

 4,000   $
 62,324  
 75,087  
 8,885  
 150,296   $

 (3,267)  $
 (41,651) 
 (37,984) 
 (3,820) 
 (86,722)  $

 733
 20,673
 37,103
 5,065
 63,574

The following table summarizes amortization of intangible assets for future periods as of December 31, 2023:

(In thousands)
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
Thereafter

Total

NOTE 10. ACCRUED EXPENSES

Accrued expenses as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included the following:

(In thousands)
Compensation and other employee-related costs
Legal and other settlements and expenses
Accrued non-income taxes
Royalties
Rebates
Other
Total accrued expenses

NOTE 11. DEBT

Annual
 Amortization

 118,084
 113,798
 110,354
 109,249
 105,783
 367,336
 924,603

  $

  $

December 31,

2023
 140,817   $
 9,335  
 23,726  
 10,130  
 27,605  
 28,847  
 240,460   $

2022

 53,352
 5,564
 10,029
 4,375
 10,501
 8,348
 92,169

  $

  $

The carrying values of the Company’s 2025 Notes, acquired in the Merger, as of December 31, 2023, were as follows: 

84

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

(In thousands)
0.375% Senior Convertible Notes due 2025:
     Principal
     Unamortized fair value adjustment for acquisition accounting
0.375% Senior Convertible Notes due 2025
     Embedded Conversion Option
Debt, net of unamortized fair value adjustments for acquisition accounting

Interest expense:
     Contractual coupon interest
     Amortization of fair value adjustments for acquisition accounting
Total interest expense recognized on Senior Convertible Notes due 2025

Effective interest rates:
Senior Convertible Notes due 2025

Line of Credit

$

$

$

$

December 31,

2023

449,987
33,275
416,712
 687
 417,400

December 31,

2023

 364
 9,076
 9,439

6.8%

In September 2023, we entered into an unsecured credit agreement with U.S. Bank National Association, as administrative agent, Citizens Bank, 
N.A.,  as  syndication  agent,  Royal  Bank  of  Canada,  as  documentation  agent,  U.S.  Bank  National  Association  and  Citizens  Bank,  N.A.,  as  joint  lead 
arrangers  and  joint  book  runners,  and  the  other  lenders  referred  to  therein  (the  “September  2023  Credit  Agreement”),  that  provides  a  revolving  credit 
facility  permitting  borrowings  up  to  $400.0  million  and  has  a  termination  date  of  September  27,  2028.  We  may  request  an  increase  in  the  revolving 
commitments  in  an  aggregate  amount  not  to  exceed  (i)  $200  million  or  (ii)  so  long  as  the  Leverage  Ratio  (as  defined  in  the  September  2023  Credit 
Agreement)  is  at  least  0.25  to  1.00  less  than  the  applicable  Leverage  Ratio  then  required  under  the  September  2023  Credit  Agreement,  an  unlimited 
amount.  Revolving  Loans  under  the  September  2023  Credit  Agreement  bear  interest  at  either  a  base  rate  or  the  Term  SOFR  Rate  (as  defined  in  the 
Revolving  Credit  Facility)  plus,  in  each  case,  an  applicable  margin,  as  determined  in  accordance  with  the  provisions  of  the  September  2023  Credit 
Agreement.  The  Applicable  Margin  ranges  from  0.125%  to  0.625%  for  the  Base  Rate  and  1.125%  to  1.625%  for  the  Term  SOFR  Rate.  We  may  also 
request Swingline Loans (as defined in the September 2023 Credit Agreement) at either the Base Rate or the Daily Term SOFR Rate. The September 2023 
Credit Agreement is guaranteed by certain direct or indirect wholly owned subsidiaries of the Company. The September 2023 Credit Agreement contains 
financial and other customary covenants, including a funded net indebtedness to adjusted EBITDA ratio. As of December 31, 2023, we have not borrowed 
under the September 2023 Credit Agreement and we are compliance with all covenants. 

0.375% Senior Convertible Notes due 2025

On  September  1,  2023,  in  connection  with  the  closing  of  the  Merger,  the  Company,  NuVasive  and  Wilmington  Trust  National  Association,  as 
trustee  (the  “Trustee”)  entered  into  a  supplemental  agreement  (the  “First  Supplemental  Indenture”)  to  the  Indenture,  dated  March  2,  2020  (the  “Base 
Indenture”), by and between NuVasive and the Trustee, relating to NuVasive’s $450.0 million in aggregate principal amount of 0.375% Convertible Senior 
Notes due 2025. As of the closing date of the Merger, $450 million of aggregate principal amount of the 2025 Notes were outstanding. 

Pursuant to the First Supplemental Indenture, the 2025 Notes are convertible into the Company’s Class A common stock at a conversion rate of 
8.0399  shares  per  $1,000  principal  amount  of  2025  Notes,  which  is  equivalent  to  a  conversion  price  of  approximately  $124.38  per  share,  subject  to 
adjustments. The 2025 Notes may be settled in cash, stock, or a combination thereof, solely at the Company’s discretion. Pursuant to the terms of the First 
Supplemental  Indenture,  Globus  agreed  to  guarantee  NuVasive’s  obligations  under  the  Indenture.  The  2025  Notes  bear  interest  at  a  rate  of  0.375% per 
annum, payable semi-annually in arrears on March 15 and September 15 of each year. The 2025 Notes mature on March 15, 2025, unless earlier converted, 
redeemed, or repurchased in accordance with their terms.

The Merger constituted a Merger Event as defined in the Base Indenture. In the event of a Merger Event, the Company is required to execute a 
supplemental indenture providing for (i) each holder of 2025 Notes with the right to convert each $1,000 principal amount of 2025 Notes into the same 
type of consideration that holders would have been entitled to receive if such holders had held a number of shares of NuVasive Common Stock equal to the 
applicable conversion rate in effect immediately prior to such Merger Event, and (ii) subsequent adjustments to the conversion rate set forth in the Base 
Indenture. 

85

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

Prior to September 15, 2024, holders may convert their 2025 Notes only under the following conditions: 

(a) during any calendar quarter commencing after the calendar quarter ending on June 30, 2020 (and only during such calendar

 quarter), if the last reported sale price of the Company’s common stock for at least 20 trading days (whether or not consecutive) during a 
period of 30 consecutive trading days ending on, and including, the last trading day of the immediately preceding calendar quarter is greater 
than or equal to 130% of the conversion price on each applicable trading day;

(b) during the five business day period after any five consecutive trading day period, or the measurement period, in which the

 trading price of the 2025 Notes per $1,000 principal amount of notes for each trading day of the measurement period was less than 98% of 
the product of the last reported sale price of the Company’s common stock and the conversion rate on such trading day; 

(c)

if the Company calls any or all of the 2025 Notes for redemption, at any time prior to the close of business on the second
 scheduled trading day preceding the redemption date; or 

(d) upon the occurrence of specified corporate events, as defined in the 2025 Notes.  

On or after September 15, 2024, until the close of business on the second scheduled trading day immediately preceding March 15, 2025, holders 
may convert their 2025 Notes at any time, regardless of the foregoing conditions. In addition, following certain corporate events that occur prior to the 
maturity date or if the Company issues a notice of redemption, the Company will increase the conversion rate for a holder who elects to convert its 2025 
Notes in connection with such a corporate event or in connection with such redemption in certain circumstances. 

The Company may redeem the 2025 Notes, at its option, in whole or in part, until the close of business on the business day immediately preceding 
September 15, 2024, if the last reported sale price of the Company’s common stock has been at least 130% of the conversion price then in effect for at least 
20  trading  days  during  any  30  consecutive  trading  day  period  ending  on,  and  including,  the  trading  day  immediately  preceding  the  date  on  which  the 
Company delivers written notice of a redemption. The redemption price will be equal to 100% of the principal amount of such 2025 Notes to be redeemed 
plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date. No principal payments are due on the 2025 Notes prior to maturity. Other than 
restrictions relating to certain fundamental changes and consolidations, mergers or asset sales and customary anti-dilution adjustments, the 2025 Notes do 
not contain any financial covenants and do not restrict the Company from conducting significant restructurings, paying dividends or issuing or repurchasing 
any of its other securities. 

Upon the initial recognition of the 2025 Notes pursuant to the purchase accounting for the Merger, the embedded conversion feature does not meet
the equity scope exception described in ASC 815-40, Contracts in Entity’s Own Equity. The embedded conversion feature is bifurcated and presented as a 
liability on the consolidated balance sheet with subsequent measurement at fair value with changes in fair value recognized as other income/(expense). The 
Company recognized, at Merger closing, the embedded conversion feature at fair value of $1.7 million and allocated the residual $407.8 million of the 
2025 Notes fair value to the host debt instrument. As of the December 31, 2023, the fair value of the embedded conversion feature was $0.7 million. As a 
result of the Merger and recognizing the fair value of the 2025 Notes, along with the embedded conversion feature, as of the acquisition date, the Company 
recorded $42.2 million debt discount to be accreted as interest expense over the life of the notes. 

2025 Hedge

 On September 1, 2023, in connection with the closing of the Merger, the Company, NuVasive, and certain dealers entered into amendment and 
guarantee agreements with respect to 2025 Hedge pursuant to which NuVasive purchased options from such dealers exercisable into its own common stock 
in connection with the sale of the 2025 Notes. Pursuant to such amendment and guarantee agreements, the 2025 Hedge is exercisable into Globus Class A 
common stock in certain circumstances and the Company guaranteed NuVasive’s obligations under the 2025 Hedge. Subject to the amended 2025 Hedge, 
the Company is entitled to purchase up to 3,617,955 shares of the Company’s Class A common stock at a strike price of $124.38. The 2025 Hedge will 
expire on the second scheduled trading day immediately preceding March 15, 2025 and is expected to reduce the potential equity dilution upon conversion 
of the 2025 Notes if the daily volume-weighted average price per share of the Company’s common stock exceeds the strike price of the 2025 Hedge. 

In accordance with ASC 805, the Company recognized the 2025 Hedge at an acquisition date fair value of $1.7 million. The 2025 Hedge does not 
meet the equity scope exception described in ASC 815-40, Contract in Entity’s Own Equity, and will be presented as asset on the consolidated balance 
sheet with subsequent measurement at fair value with changes in fair value recognized as other income/(expense). As of December 31, 2023, the fair value 
of  the  2025  Hedge  is  $0.7  million  recorded  within  the  Other  Assets  with  the  consolidated  balance  sheet.  An  assumed  exercise  of  the  2025  Hedge  by 
NuVasive is considered anti-dilutive since the effect of the inclusion would always be anti-dilutive with respect to the calculation of diluted earnings per 
share. 

86

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

2025 Warrants 

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

On September 1, 2023, in connection with the closing of the Merger, the Company, NuVasive, and certain dealers entered into amendment and 
guarantee agreements with respect to the 2025 Warrants, pursuant to which NuVasive sold warrants to such dealers for its own common stock in connection 
with the initial sale of the 2025 Notes. Pursuant to such amendment and guarantee agreements, the warrants are exercisable into Globus Class A common 
stock in certain circumstances and the Company guaranteed NuVasive’s obligations under the 2025 Warrants. Subject to the amended 2025 Warrants, the 
holders  of  the  2025  Warrants  are  entitled  to  purchase  up  to  3,617,955  shares  of  the  Company’s  common  stock  at  a  strike  price  of  $170.45.  The  2025 
Warrants will expire on various dates from June 2025 through October 2025 and may be settled in net shares or cash, at the Company’s election.

 In accordance with ASC 805, the Company recognized the 2025 Warrants at an acquisition date fair value of $0.6 million within additional paid-
in capital. The 2025 Warrants could have a dilutive effect on the Company’s earnings per share to the extent that the price of the Company’s common stock 
during a given measurement period exceeds the strike price of the 2025 Warrants, which is $170.45 per share. The Company uses the treasury share method 
for assumed exercise of its 2025 Warrants to compute the weighted average common shares outstanding for diluted earnings per share.

NOTE 12. EQUITY

Stock Repurchases

On March 11, 2020, the Company announced a share repurchase program, which authorized the Company to repurchase up to $200.0 million of 
the Company’s Class A common stock (“Class A Common”). On March 4, 2022, the share repurchase program was expanded by authorizing the Company 
to repurchase an additional $200.0 million of the Company’s Class A Common. On September 27, 2023, the share repurchase program was expanded by 
authorizing the Company to repurchase an additional $350.0 million of the Company’s Class A Common. The repurchase program has no time limit and 
may be suspended for periods or discontinued at any time. 

 During  the  year  ended  December  31,  2023,  the  Company  repurchased  a  total  of  4.3  million  shares  under  this  program  at  an  average  price  of 
$52.11,  for  a  dollar  amount  of  $225.6  million.  As  of  December  31,  2023,  the  Company  has  approximately  $275.2  million  remaining  under  the  share 
repurchase program authorized of Class A Common. The timing and actual number of shares repurchased will depend on various factors including price, 
corporate  and  regulatory  requirements,  debt  covenant  requirements,  alternative  investment  opportunities  and  other  market  conditions.  Funding  of  share 
repurchases is expected to come from operating cash flows and excess cash.

Shares repurchased by the Company are accounted for under the constructive retirement method, in which the shares repurchased, are immediately 
retired, as there is no plan to reissue the shares. The Company made an accounting policy election to charge the excess of repurchase price over par value 
entirely to retained earnings.

Common Stock

Our amended and restated Certificate of Incorporation provides for a total of 775,000,000 authorized shares of common stock. Of the authorized 
number of shares of common stock, 500,000,000 shares are designated as Class A Common and 275,000,000 shares are designated as Class B common 
stock (“Class B Common”).

The holders of Class A Common are entitled to one vote for each share of Class A Common held. Each share of our Class B common stock is 
convertible at any time at the option of the holder into one share of our Class A Common. In addition, each share of our Class B common stock will convert 
automatically into one share of our Class A common stock upon any transfer, whether or not for value, except for permitted transfers. For more details 
relating to the conversion of our Class B common stock please see “Exhibit 4.2, Description of Securities of the Registrant” filed herein. The holders of 
Class B Common are entitled to 10 votes for each share of Class B Common held. The holders of Class A Common and Class B Common vote together as 
one class of common stock. Except for voting rights, the Class A Common and Class B Common have the same rights and privileges.

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) 

The  tables  below  present  the  changes  in  each  component  of  accumulated  other  comprehensive  income/(loss),  including  current  period  other 
comprehensive  income/(loss)  and  reclassifications  out  of  accumulated  other  comprehensive  income/(loss)  for  the  years  ended  December  31,  2023  and 
2022, respectively: 

87

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

(In thousands)
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax, at December 31, 2022
Other comprehensive income/(loss) before reclassifications
Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax
Other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax, at December 31, 2023

(In thousands)
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax, at December 31, 2021
Other comprehensive income/(loss) before reclassifications
Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax
Other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax, at December 31, 2022

Unrealized loss on 
marketable securities, 
net of tax

Foreign currency 
translation 
adjustments

  $

  $

 (15,093)  $
 17,420  
 (4,189) 
 13,231  
 (1,862)  $

Accumulated other 
comprehensive loss
 (24,630)
 18,627
 (4,189)
 14,438
 (10,192)

 (9,537)  $
 1,207  
 —  
 1,207  
 (8,330)  $

Unrealized loss on 
marketable securities, 
net of tax

Foreign currency 
translation 
adjustments

  $

  $

 (1,053)  $
 (18,494) 
 4,454  
 (14,040) 
 (15,093)  $

Accumulated other 
comprehensive loss
 (6,772)
 (22,312)
 4,454
 (17,858)
 (24,630)

 (5,719)  $
 (3,818) 
 —  
 (3,818) 
 (9,537)  $

Amounts reclassified  from  accumulated  other  comprehensive  loss,  net  of  tax,  related  to  unrealized  gains/losses  on  marketable  securities  were 

released to other income, net in our consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income.

88

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Earnings Per Common Share

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

The Company computes basic earnings per share using the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period. Diluted 
earnings per share assumes the conversion, exercise or issuance of all potential common stock equivalents, unless the effect of inclusion would be anti-
dilutive. For purposes of this calculation, common stock equivalents include the Company’s stock options, unvested RSUs, and PRSUs. These are included 
in basic net income per share as of the date that all necessary conditions have been satisfied and are included in the denominator for dilutive calculation for 
the  entire  period  if  such  shares  would  be  issuable  as  of  the  end  of  the  reporting  period  assuming  the  end  of  the  reporting  period  was  the  end  of  the 
contingency period.

The following table sets forth the computation of basic and diluted earnings per share: 

(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Numerator:
      Net income/(loss) for basic:
      Dilutive potential net income (loss):
Adjusted net income (loss) for diluted

Denominator for basic and diluted net income per share:
      Weighted average shares outstanding for basic
      Dilutive stock options, RSUs, and PRSUs
      Weighted average shares outstanding for diluted
Earnings per share: 
      Basic
      Diluted

Anti-dilutive stock options and RSUs excluded from the calculation
Anti-dilutive warrants excluded from the calculation
Anti-dilutive Senior Convertible Notes due 2025 excluded from the calculation
Total

$

$

$
$

Year Ended

December 31,

2022

2021

2023

 122,873   $

 190,169   $

 149,191

 122,873   $

 190,169   $

 149,191

 113,087  
 1,543  
 114,630  

 100,469  
 2,174  
 102,643  

 1.09   $
 1.07   $

 1.89   $
 1.85   $

 6,295  
 3,618  
 3,618  
 13,531  

 3,851  
 —  
 —  
 3,851  

 100,734
 2,889
 103,623

 1.48
 1.44

 2,139
 —
 —
 2,139

In accordance with ASU No. 2020-06, Debt with Conversion and Other Options (Subtopic 470-20), the Company applies the if-converted method 
in computing the effect of the Company's 2025 Notes on diluted net income per share. For periods in which the Company reports net income, the numerator 
of the diluted per share computation is adjusted for interest expense and amortization of debt issuance costs, net of tax, and the denominator is adjusted for 
the weighted average number of shares into which each of the Company’s 2025 Notes could be converted. The effect is only included in the calculation of 
diluted net income per share for those 2025 Notes which reduce net income per share.

NOTE 13. STOCK-BASED AWARDS 

We have four stock plans: our 2012 Equity Incentive Plan (the “2012 Plan”) and our 2021 Equity Incentive Plan (the “2021 Plan”), the NuVasive 
2014 Equity Incentive Plan (the “NuVasive 2014 Plan”), and the Ellipse Technologies 2015 Incentive Award Plan (the “Ellipse 2015 Plan”). The 2021 Plan, 
the NuVasive 2014 Plan and the Ellipse 2015 Plan are the only active stock plans. The purpose of the 2012 Plan was, and of the 2021 Plan is, to provide 
incentive to employees, directors, and consultants of Globus. The 2012 Plan, 2021 Plan, NuVasive 2014 Plan, and Ellipse 2015 Plan are administered by 
the Board of Directors of Globus (the “Board”) or its delegates. The number, type of option, exercise price, and vesting terms are determined by the Board 
or its delegates in accordance with the terms of the 2012 Plan and 2021 Plan. The options granted expire on a date specified by the Board, which is ten 
years from the grant date. Options granted to employees vest in varying installments over a four-year period.

The 2012 Plan was approved by our Board in March 2012, and by our stockholders in June 2012. The 2012 Plan terminated as to new awards 
pursuant to its terms in 2022. Following effectiveness of the 2021 Plan, we have not issued any additional awards under the 2012 Plan; however, awards 
previously granted under the 2012 Plan remain outstanding and are administered by our Board under the terms and conditions of the 2012 Plan. Under the 
2012 Plan, the aggregate number of shares of Class A Common stock that were able to be issued subject to options and other awards is equal to the sum of 
(i) 3,076,923 shares, (ii) any shares available for issuance under the 2008 Plan as of March 13, 2012, (iii) any shares underlying awards outstanding under 
the 2008 Plan as of March 13, 2012 that, on or after that date, are forfeited, terminated, 

89

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

expired or lapse for any reason, or are settled for cash without delivery of shares and (iv) starting January 1, 2013, an annual increase in the number of 
shares available under the 2012 Plan equal to up to 3% of the number of shares of our common and preferred stock outstanding at the end of the previous 
year, as determined by our Board. The number of shares that were able to be issued or transferred pursuant to incentive stock options under the 2012 Plan 
was limited to 10,769,230 shares. The shares of Class A Common covered by the 2012 Plan included authorized but unissued shares, treasury shares or 
shares of common stock purchased on the open market.

The 2021 Plan was approved by our Board in March 2021, and by our stockholders in June 2021. Under the 2021 Plan, as amended to date, the 
aggregate number of shares of Class A Common that were able to be issued subject to options and other awards is equal to the sum of (i) 8,000,000 shares, 
(ii) any shares available for issuance under the 2012 Plan as of June 3, 2021 and (iii) any shares underlying awards outstanding under the 2012 Plan or 
2021 Plan as of June 3, 2021 that, on or after that date, are forfeited, terminated, expired or lapse for any reason, or are settled for cash without delivery of 
shares. The number of shares that could be issued or transferred pursuant to incentive stock options under the 2021 Plan is limited to 8,000,000 shares. The 
shares of Class A Common covered by the 2021 Plan include authorized but unissued shares, treasury shares or shares of common stock purchased on the 
open market.

In connection with the Merger, the Company assumed outstanding awards for the RSUs and PRSUs under the NuVasive 2014 Plan and the Ellipse 
2015 Plan in accordance with the terms in the Merger Agreement. The PRSUs ultimate issuance amount is determined by the Company’s Compensation 
Committee. Share payout levels range from 0% to 100% depending on the respective terms of an award.

As of December 31, 2023, pursuant to the 2021 Plan, the NuVasive 2014 Plan, and the Ellipse 2015 Plan, there were 9,799,141 shares 2,271,633 
shares,  and  423,886  shares  of  Class  A  Common  stock  reserved,  respectively  and  5,152,998  shares,  1,625,088  shares,  and  241,048  shares  of  Class  A 
Common stock available, respectively, for future grants.

Stock Options

Stock option activity during the year ended December 31, 2023 is summarized as follows:

Outstanding at December 31, 2022
Granted
Exercised
Forfeited
Outstanding at December 31, 2023
Exercisable at December 31, 2023
Expected to vest at December 31, 2023

Option
 Shares (thousands)  

Weighted
average
exercise
price

Weighted
 average
 remaining
 contractual
 life (years)

Aggregate
 intrinsic
 value
 (thousands)

 10,338   $
 1,897  
 (387) 
 (447) 
 11,401  
 7,103  
 4,292   $

 51.86  
 57.51  
 32.31  
 62.92  
 53.02  
 49.20  
 59.35  

 6.4   $
 5.3  
 8.2   $

 61,489
 52,537
 8,952

The  total  intrinsic  value  of  stock  options  exercised  was  $10.8 million, $26.3 million, and $71.3  million,  during  the  years  ended  December  31, 

2023, 2022, and 2021, respectively.

The fair value of the options was estimated on the date of the grant using a Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following assumptions: 

Risk-free interest rate
Expected term (years)
Expected volatility
Expected dividend yield

Year Ended
December 31,

3.45%
4.7
35.0%

2023
-
-
-
—%

4.77%    

4.8

38.0%    

1.46%
4.7
33.0%

2022
-
-
-
—%

4.04%    

0.40%

9.9

35.0%    

33.0%

2021
-
4.8
-
—%

1.14%

34.0%

The  weighted  average  grant  date  fair  value  of  stock  options  granted  during  the  years  ended  December  31,  2023,  2022,  and  2021  was  $21.47, 

$22.10, and $20.34 per share, respectively.

90

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Restricted Stock Units

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

Restricted stock unit activity during the year ended December 31, 2023 is summarized as follows: 

Outstanding at December 31, 2022
Granted
Vested
Forfeited
Outstanding at December 31, 2023

Performance-Based Restricted Stock Units

Restricted Stock
 Units (thousands)

Weighted
 average
 grant date fair value
 per share

Weighted
 average
 remaining
 contractual
 life (years)

 60   $

 1,271  
 (477) 
 (34) 
 820   $

 67.40  
 54.04  
 —  
 —  
 54.98  

 2.47

Performance-based restricted stock unit activity during the year ended December 31, 2023 is summarized as follows:

Outstanding at December 31, 2022
Granted
Vested
Forfeited
Outstanding at December 31, 2023

Stock-Based Compensation

Performance-Based 
Restricted Stock
 Units (thousands)

Weighted
 average
 grant date fair value
 per share

Weighted
 average
 remaining
 contractual
 life (years)

 —   $
 108  
 (2) 
 —  
 106   $

 —  
 53.61  
 54.10  
 —  
 53.61  

 2.47

Compensation expense related to stock options granted to employees and non-employees under the Plans and the intrinsic value of stock options 

exercised was as follows:

(In thousands)
Stock-based compensation expense
Stock-based compensation expense classified in Acquisition-Related Costs
Net stock-based compensation capitalized into inventory
Total stock-based compensation cost

  $

  $

2023

 38,995   $
 13,747  
 31  
 52,773   $

Year Ended
December 31,

2022

 32,810   $
 —  
 657  
 33,467   $

2021

 30,586
 —
 667
 31,253

As of December 31, 2023, there was $96.1 million of unrecognized compensation expense related to unvested employee stock options that vest 

over a weighted average period of three years.

NOTE 14. INCOME TAXES 

The components of income before income taxes are as follows:

(In thousands)
Domestic
Foreign
Total

  $

  $

2023
 181,752   $
 (16,359) 
 165,393   $

Year Ended
December 31,
2022
 247,260   $
 (4,241) 
 243,019   $

2021
 184,819
 (4,412)
 180,407

91

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

The components of the provision for income taxes are as follows:

(In thousands)
Current:

Federal
State
Foreign

Deferred:
Federal
State
Foreign

Total

A reconciliation of the statutory U.S. federal tax rate to our effective rate is as follows:

Statutory U.S. federal tax rate
State income taxes, net of federal benefit
Foreign taxes
Valuation allowance
Domestic production activities deduction
Tax credits
Compensation expense
Nondeductible expenses
Foreign inclusions
Acquisition related charges
Other
Effective tax rate

2023

 81,504   $
 15,190  
 4,075  
 100,769  

 (46,217) 
 (6,421) 
 (5,611) 
 (58,249) 
 42,520   $

  $

  $

Year Ended
December 31,
2022

 60,927   $
 12,408  
 1,845  
 75,180  

 (16,429) 
 (3,142) 
 (2,759) 
 (22,330) 
 52,850   $

Year Ended
December 31,
2022
 21.0 % 
 3.0
 0.7
 (0.5)
 —   
 (1.3)
 (1.2)
 —   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 21.7 % 

2023
 21.0 % 
 4.1
 (0.6)
 0.4
 —   
 (3.4)
 (0.9)
 1.3
 (0.9)
 4.9
 (0.2)
 25.7 % 

2021

 37,436
 7,688
 3,741
 48,865

 (13,535)
 (2,265)
 (1,849)
 (17,649)
 31,216

2021
 21.0 %
 2.7
 1.6
 0.1
 (0.3)
 (1.5)
 (6.6)
 0.5
 —  
 —  

 (0.2)
 17.3 %

Deferred income taxes reflect the tax effects of temporary differences between the basis of assets and liabilities recognized for financial reporting 

purposes and tax purposes. Significant components of our deferred income taxes are as follows:

92

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

(In thousands)
Deferred tax assets:
Inventory reserve
Accruals, reserves, and other currently not deductible
Stock-based compensation
Capitalized R&E
Net operating loss carryforwards
General business and other credit carryforwards
Lease Liability
Other

Total deferred tax assets

Valuation allowance

Total deferred tax assets, net of valuation allowance

Deferred tax liabilities:

Depreciation and amortization
Right of Use Asset

Total deferred tax liabilities
Net deferred tax assets/(liabilities)

December 31,

2023

2022

  $

  $

 27,228   $
 37,798  
 39,715  
 68,832  
 128,810  
 42,569  
 22,887  
 30,948  
 398,787  
 (190,762) 
 208,025  

 (244,348) 
 (12,370) 
 (256,718) 
 (48,693)  $

 29,649
 27,608
 20,554
 14,279
 4,182
 —
 —
 —
 96,272
 (5,488)
 90,784

 (43,718)
 —
 (43,718)
 47,066

In  assessing  the  realizability  of  deferred  tax  assets,  management  considers  whether  it  is  more  likely  than  not  that  some  portion  or  all  of  the 
deferred tax assets will not be realized. The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income during the 
periods  in  which  those  temporary  differences  become  deductible.  Based  upon  the  level  of  historical  taxable  income  and  projections  for  future  taxable 
income over the periods in which the deferred tax assets are deductible, management believes it is more likely than not that we will realize a portion of the 
benefits  of 
these  deductible  differences  at  December  31,  2023  and  2022.  The  Company  has  established  valuation  allowances  of 
$190.8 million and $5.5 million at December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively, primarily related to the uncertainty of the utilization of certain deferred tax 
assets comprised of tax loss carryforwards in various jurisdictions. The increase in the valuation allowance during 2023 is primarily driven by acquired 
foreign deferred tax assets from the Merger that are not expected to be realized. The amount of the deferred tax asset considered realizable, however, could 
be reduced in the near term if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are reduced.

At  December  31,  2023,  the  Company  had  $1.3  million,  $51.7  million  and  $376.8  million  of  federal,  state  and  foreign  net  operating  loss
carryforwards, respectively. Federal net operating loss carryforwards begin to expire in 2026, state net operating loss carryforwards begin to expire in 2023, 
and foreign net operating losses carry forward indefinitely.

The Company has California research and development income tax credit carryforwards of $41.9 million. The California credits can be carried 

forward indefinitely. The Company has foreign tax credit carryforwards of $2.8 million which expire beginning in 2027. 

Due  to  the  “change  of  ownership”  provision  of  the  Tax  Reform  Act  of  1986,  utilization  of  the  Company’s  net  operating  loss  and  credit 
carryforwards may be subject to an annual limitation against taxable income in future periods. As a result of any future ownership changes, the annual 
limitation of loss and credit carryforwards may cause them to expire before ultimately becoming available to reduce future income tax liabilities.

A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of unrecognized tax benefits is as follows:

(In thousands)
Unrecognized tax benefits at the beginning of the year
Additions related to current year tax positions
Additions related to prior year tax positions
Reductions related to prior year tax positions
Unrecognized tax benefits at the end of the year

  $

  $

2023

 986   $
 853  
 32,045  
 (127) 
 33,757   $

Year Ended
December 31,
2022

 1,052   $
 —  
 50  
 (116) 
 986   $

2021

 1,600
 —
 160
 (708)
 1,052

The additions related to current year tax positions for the year ended December 31, 2023 of $0.9 million are primarily related to additional current 

year reserves.  The additions related to the prior year tax positions for the year ended December 31, 2023 of $32.0 million 

93

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

are related to the historical positions from the Merger, and recorded using the acquisition method of accounting. The reductions related to prior year tax 
positions for the year ended December 31, 2023 of $0.1 million are primarily related to the resolution of certain foreign tax positions.

The impact of our unrecognized tax benefits to the effective income tax rate is as follows:

(In thousands)
Portion of total unrecognized tax benefits that, if recognized, would affect the effective income 
tax rate

2023

December 31,
2022

2021

$

 27,601

$

 1,355

$

 1,471

The undistributed earnings of our foreign subsidiaries as of December 31, 2023 are immaterial.  Due to recent tax reform in the U.S. and favorable 
treaties between the U.S. and countries in which the Company’s controlled foreign corporations operate, the Company has the ability to repatriate earnings 
without incurring additional tax liabilities. Accordingly, the Company has not recorded a liability for taxes associated with any future distributions of these 
undistributed earnings.

Interest  and  penalties  are  recorded  in  the  statement  of  income  as  provision  for  income  taxes.  The  total  interest  and  penalties  recorded  in  the 
statement of income was immaterial for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021. We do not expect a significant change in our uncertain tax 
benefits  in  the  next  twelve  months.  We  are  subject  to  federal  income  tax  as  well  as  income  tax  of  multiple  state  and  foreign  jurisdictions.  With  few 
exceptions, we are no longer subject to income tax examination by tax authorities in major jurisdictions for years prior to 2018 as of December 31, 2023. 

  NOTE 15. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

We are involved in a number of proceedings, legal actions, and claims arising in the ordinary course of business. Such matters are subject to many 
uncertainties,  and  the  outcomes  of  these  matters  are  not  within  our  control  and  may  not  be  known  for  prolonged  periods  of  time.  In  some  actions,  the 
claimants seek damages, as well as other relief, including injunctions prohibiting us from engaging in certain activities, which, if granted, could require 
significant  expenditures  and/or  result  in  lost  revenues.  We  record  a  liability  in  the  consolidated  financial  statements  for  these  actions  when  a  loss  is 
considered probable and the amount can be reasonably estimated. If the reasonable estimate of a probable loss is a range, and no amount in the range is a 
better  estimate  than  any  other,  the  minimum  amount  of  the  range  is  accrued.  If  a  loss  is  reasonably  possible  but  not  known  or  probable,  and  can  be 
reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or range of loss is disclosed. In most cases, significant judgment is required to estimate the amount and timing of a 
loss to be recorded. While it is not possible to predict the outcome for most of the matters discussed, we believe it is possible that costs associated with 
them could have a material adverse impact on our consolidated earnings, financial position or cash flows.

Moskowitz Family LLC Litigation

On  November  20,  2019,  Moskowitz  Family  LLC  filed  suit  against  us  in  the  U.S.  District  Court  for  the  Western  District  of  Texas  for  patent 
infringement. Moskowitz, a non-practicing entity, alleges that Globus willfully infringes one or more claims of six patents by making, using, offering for 
sale or selling the COALITION®, COALITION MIS®, COALITION AGX®, CORBEL®, MONUMENT®, MAGNIFY®-S, HEDRON IATM, HEDRON 
IC®,  INDEPENDENCE®,  INDEPENDENCE  MIS®,  INDEPENDENCE  MIS  AGX®,  FORTIFY®  and  XPAND®  families,  SABLE®,  RISE®,  RISE®
INTRALIF, RISE®-L, ELSA®, ELSA®  ATP,  ALTERA®, ARIEL®, CALIBER®  and  CALIBER®-L  products.  Moskowitz  seeks  monetary  damages  and 
injunctive relief. On July 2, 2020, this suit was transferred from the U.S. District Court for the Western District of Texas to the U.S. District Court for the 
Eastern District of Pennsylvania. On December 14, 2023, a jury returned a defense verdict in favor of Globus.  As such, we have not recorded a liability, 
outside of counsel fees, related to this litigation as of December 31, 2023.

NOTE 16. LEASES

The Company leases certain equipment, vehicles, office and storage facilities via various operating and financing lease agreements. Our leases 
have initial lease terms ranging from one year to seventeen years. Certain lease agreements require the Company to pay taxes, insurance, and maintenance, 
and provide for options to extend the term beyond the initial lease termination date. We use judgment to determine whether it is reasonably possible that we 
will extend the lease beyond the initial term and the length of the possible extension. Leases that have terms of less than 12 months are treated as short-term 
and we do not recognize right-of-use assets or lease liabilities for such leases. We generally estimate discount rates using our incremental borrowing rate, 
and based on other information available, at commencement date of a lease when determining the present value of future payments, as most of our leases 
do not provide an implicit rate. The Company has security deposits recorded and maintained in Other Assets totaling $1.5 million as of December 31, 2023.

The Company includes financing lease right-of-use assets in other assets, short-term financing lease liabilities in accrued expenses, and long-term 

financing lease liabilities in other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheet. Operating lease expense is recognized on a 

94

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

straight-line basis over the term of the lease as a component of operating income on the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income. 
Finance leases amortize the right-of-use assets and amortize the interest on the lease liability over the term of the lease.

Amounts reported in the consolidated balance sheet were as follows:

(In thousands)
Asset:
     Operating lease right-of-use asset
     Finance lease right-of-use asset 
Total leased assets

Liabilities:
Current:
   Operating lease liability 
   Finance lease liability
Long-term:
   Operating lease liability 
   Finance lease liability
Total lease liabilities

December 31,
2023

December 31,
2022

$

$

$

 59,931   $
 797  
 60,728   $

 11,967  
 475  

 91,037  
 337  
 103,816   $

 5,988
 -
 5,988

 2,536
 -

 3,475
 -
 6,011

The table below summarizes the Company’s lease costs arising from the operating and financing lease obligations:

(In thousands)
Lease expense:
    Operating lease expense
    Finance lease expense:
         Depreciation of right-of-use asset
         Interest expense on lease liabilities
Total lease expense

Future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable leases as of December 31, 2023 are as follows:

Twelve Months Ended
 December 30,

2023

2022

$

$

 19,471   $

 2,588

 903  
 67  
 20,441   $

 -
 -
 2,588

(In thousands)
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
Thereafter
Total minimum lease payments
     Less: amount representing interest
Present value of obligations under leases
     Less: current portion
Long-term lease obligations

Finance
 Leases

Operating
 Leases

 498  
 182  
 170  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 850  
 (38) 
 812  
 (475) 
 337  

$

$

$

 18,336
 14,931
 13,431
 12,352
 11,281
 74,018
 144,350
 (41,346)
 103,004
 (11,967)
 91,037

$

$

$

95

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

The table below summarizes the Company’s supplemental cash flow information and 
assumptions used:

(In thousands, except weighted average lease term and discount rate)
Other supplemental cash flow information:
Cash paid for amounts included in measurement of lease liabilities
     Operating cash flows from operating leases
     Operating cash flows for finance leases
     Financing cash flows for finance leases
Total cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities

Right-of-use assets obtained in exchange for lease obligations
     Operating leases
     Financing leases
Weighted-average remaining lease term
     Operating leases
     Financing leases
Weighted-average discount rate
     Operating leases
     Financing leases

NOTE 17. RETIREMENT BENEFIT PLANS

December 31,

December 31,

December 31,

2023

2022

2021

$

$

$
$

 19,773   $
 67  
 913  
 20,753   $

 2,545   $
 —  
 —  
 2,545   $

 9,043   $
 -   $

 1,915   $
 -   $

 14.9  
 2.6  

8.3%  
4.4%  

 2.4  
 -  

3.5%  
 -  

 1,743
 —
 —
 1,743

 1,436
 -

 1.8
 -

2.7%
 -

We  sponsor  401(k)  Plans  covering  all  eligible  U.S.  employees,  and  a  retirement  plan  for  all  eligible  Puerto  Rico  employees.  Under  the  401(k) 

Plans, we make matching contributions ranging from 3% to 4% of the employee’s compensation for the period.

Additionally,  we  contribute  to  various  foreign  retirement  benefit  plans  required  by  local  law  or  coordinated  with  government  sponsored  plans 
which  cover  many  of  our  international  employees.  The  benefits  offered  under  these  plans  are  reflective  of  local  customs  and  practices  in  the  countries 
concerned.

Company contributions to these retirement plans were as follows:

(In thousands)
401(k) and other retirement plan contributions

NOTE 18. SEGMENT AND GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION

2023

Year Ended
December 31,
2022

  $

 10,525   $

 7,154   $

2021

 6,588

Operating segments are defined as components of an organization for which separate financial information is available and evaluated regularly by 
the chief operating decision maker, or decision-making group, in deciding how to allocate resources and in assessing performance.   We have identified two 
operating segments, Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies, based on how management reviews the business, makes investing and resource 
allocation  decisions  and  assesses  operating  performance.    We  aggregate  these  operating  segments  into  one  reportable  segment,  based  on  conclusions 
reached after considering the factors including economic similarity, customer base, regulatory environment, production processes, nature of services and 
products provided, and our comprehensive approach to product development and offerings targeting patient needs through procedural-based solutions.

96

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

The following table represents total net sales and property and equipment, net by geographic area, based on the location of the customer for the 

years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, respectively:

(In thousands)
United States
International
Total

$

$

2023
 1,279,765  
 288,711  
 1,568,476  

$

$

Net Sales

Year Ended

December 31,

2022

Property and Equipment, Net

Year Ended

December 31,

2021

2023

2022

 871,939  
 150,904  
 1,022,843  

$

$

 819,571   $
 138,531  
 958,102   $

 527,332   $
 59,600  
 586,932   $

 237,680
 6,049
 243,729

97

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

None.

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

Our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) are 
designed  to  ensure  that  information  required  to  be  disclosed  in  the  reports  that  we  file  or  submit  under  the  Exchange  Act  is  recorded,  processed, 
summarized  and  reported  within  the  time  periods  specified  in  the  rules  and  forms  of  the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission  and  to  ensure  that 
information required to be disclosed is accumulated and communicated to management, including our principal executive officer and principal financial 
officer,  to  allow  timely  decisions  regarding  disclosure.  The  Chief  Executive  Officer  and  the  Chief  Financial  Officer  have  reviewed  the  design  and 
effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures as of December 31, 2023 and, based on their evaluation, have concluded that the disclosure controls 
and procedures were effective as of such date.

Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

Management of Globus is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as defined in Rule 13a-
15(f) and Rule 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable, but not absolute, 
assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting 
principles generally accepted in the United States of America. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures 
that  pertain  to  the  maintenance  of  records  that,  in  reasonable  detail,  accurately  and  fairly  reflect  the  transactions  and  dispositions  of  the  assets  of  the 
Company;  provide  reasonable  assurance  that  transactions  are  recorded  as  necessary  to  permit  preparation  of  financial  statements  in  accordance  with 
accounting  principles  generally  accepted  in  the  United  States  of  America,  and  that  receipts  and  expenditures  of  the  Company  are  being  made  only  in 
accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection 
of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because  of  its  inherent  limitations,  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  may  not  prevent  or  detect  misstatements.  Also,  projections  of  any 
evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree 
of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Our  management  has  performed  its  assessment  of  our  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  according  to  the  guidelines  established  by  the 
Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (2013) (“COSO”). Management excluded 
NuVasive from its assessment of internal control over financial reporting, as it was not possible to conduct an assessment of NuVasive’s internal control 
over financial reporting in the period between the Merger date and the date of management’s assessment. NuVasive accounted for approximately 26% of 
total assets as of December 31, 2023, and 26% of the total revenue for the year ended December 31, 2023. 

Based on the foregoing and as a result of this assessment and based on the criteria in the COSO framework, management has concluded that, as of 

December 31, 2023, the internal control over financial reporting of Globus was effective.

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Deloitte  &  Touche  LLP,  our  independent  registered  public  accounting  firm,  has  audited  the  effectiveness  of  our  internal  control  over  financial 

reporting as of December 31, 2023 as stated in their report that is included in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting

There was no change in our internal control over financial reporting identified in connection with the evaluation required by Rule 13a-15(d) and 
15d-15(d) of the Exchange Act that occurred during our most recent fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, 
our internal control over financial reporting.

Item 9B. Other Information

On December 14, 2023, David D. Davidar, Director, adopted a trading arrangement for the sale of securities of the Company’s Class A common 
stock  that  is  intended  to  satisfy  the  affirmative  defense  conditions  of  Securities  Exchange  Act  Rule  10b5-1(c)  (a  “Rule  10b5-1  Trading  Plan”).  Mr. 
Davidar’s Rule 10b5-1 Trading Plan, which has a term ending upon the earlier of March 14, 2025 or the 

98

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

sale of all shares subject to the plan, provides for the sale of up to 70,000 shares of Class A common stock pursuant to the terms of the plan.

On December 14, 2023, The Davidar Family Irrevocable Trust, whose shares are beneficially owned by David D. Davidar, adopted a Rule 10b5-1 
Trading Plan.  The Davidar Family Irrevocable Trust’s Rule 10b5-1 Trading Plan, which has a term ending upon the earlier of March 14, 2025 or the sale of 
all shares subject to the plan, provides for the sale of up to 40,000 shares of Class A common stock pursuant to the terms of the plan.

On December  14,  2023, Leslie  V.  Norwalk, Director, adopted  a  Rule  10b5-1  Trading  Plan  to  sell  $550,000  worth  of  the  Company’s  Class  A 
common stock on a date certain after the 90-day cooling-off period set forth in the plan, and, separately, up to 1,000 shares of Company common stock over 
a period beginning on March 15, 2024 and ending on December 31, 2024, subject to certain conditions.

On December 15, 2023, Keith W. Pfeil, the Company’s Chief Operating Officer and Chief Financial Officer, adopted a Rule 10b5-1 Trading Plan. 
Mr. Pfeil’s Rule 10b5-1 Trading Plan, which has a term ending upon the earlier of March 15, 2025 or the sale of all shares subject to the plan, provides for 
the sale of up to 99,376 shares of Class A common stock pursuant to the terms of the plan.

99

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

PART III

Certain information required by Part III is omitted from this Annual Report and will be included in the definitive proxy statement for our 2024 

annual meeting of stockholders, which will be filed within 120 days after the end of our fiscal year.

Item 9C. Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent inspections
Not applicable.

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

Code of Ethics

We have adopted a Code of Ethics for all employees, officers, directors, as well as a Code of Ethics specifically for our principal executive officer 
and senior financial officers, both of which are available on our website, www.globusmedical.com. We intend to disclose future amendments to, or waivers 
from,  provisions  of  our  Code  of  Ethics  that  apply  to  our  Principal  Executive  Officer,  Principal  Financial  Officer,  Principal  Accounting  Officer,  or 
Controller, or persons performing similar functions, within four business days of such amendment or waiver.

The other information required by this Item 10 will be set forth in the Company’s proxy statement for its 2024 annual meeting of stockholders, 

which information is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 11. Executive Compensation

The information required by this Item 11 will be set forth in the Company’s proxy statement for its 2024 annual meeting of stockholders, which 

information is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

The information required by this Item 12 will be set forth in the Company’s proxy statement for its 2024 annual meeting of stockholders, which 

information is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

The information required by this Item 13 will be set forth in the Company’s proxy statement for its 2024 annual meeting of stockholders, which 

information is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services

The information required by this Item 14 will be set forth in the Company’s proxy statement for its 2024 annual meeting of stockholders, which 

information is incorporated herein by reference.

100

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

(a) (1) Financial Statements

PART IV

Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm ( Deloitte & Touche LLP, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, PCAOB ID No. 34)
Consolidated Balance Sheets
Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income
Consolidated Statements of Equity
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

64
65
66
67
68
69

(a) (2) Financial Statement Schedules

SCHEDULE II. VALUATION ACCOUNTS AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS

Allowance for doubtful accounts:

(In thousands)
Year ended December 31, 2021
Year ended December 31, 2022
Year ended December 31, 2023

Deferred tax valuation allowance: 

(In thousands)
Year ended December 31, 2021
Year ended December 31, 2022
Year ended December 31, 2023

Beginning
 of period

Charged
 to expenses

Write-offs

  $

  $

 4,408  
 4,962  
 4,724  

$
$
$

 1,200  
 (1)  
 3,658  

$
$
$

 (646)  $
 (237)  $
 552  $

End
 of period

 4,962
 4,724
 8,934

Additions

Beginning
 of period

Charged
 to expenses

Charged to
 other accounts

  $

  $

 6,487   $
 6,594   $
 5,488   $

 107  
 (1,106)  
 8,301 

$
$
$

 —  
 —  
 176,974  

$
$
$

Deductions

Other
 deductions

End
 of period

 6,594
 5,488
 190,763

 —   $
 —   $
 —   $

101

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

(b) Exhibits, including those incorporated by reference

102

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Exhibit No.
2.1

3.1

3.2

3.3

3.4

3.5

4.1

4.2*
4.3

4.4

4.5

10.1

10.2

10.3

10.4

10.5

10.6

10.7

10.8

10.9

10.10

10.11

10.12

10.13

  Item

Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of February 8, 2023, by and among NuVasive, Inc., Globus Medical, Inc. and Zebra Merger
Sub,  Inc.  (incorporated  by  reference  to  Exhibit  2.1  to  Globus  Medical,  Inc.’s  Current  Report  on  Form  8-K  filed  with  the  SEC  on 
February 9, 2023)
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Globus Medical, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the 
Registrant’s Amendment No. 5 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on August 2, 2012).
Certificate of Amendment of the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Globus Medical, Inc., dated July 30, 2012 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 5 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on 
August 2, 2012).
Certificate of Amendment of the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Globus Medical, Inc., dated August 7, 2012 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Registrant’s Form 10-Q/A filed on September 19, 2012).
Amended and Restated Bylaws of Globus Medical, Inc. effective as of May 1, 2019 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to our 
Form 10-Q/A filed on May 2, 2019).
Amendment to Bylaws effective as of July 31, 2021 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to our Form 10-Q filed on August 4, 
2021).
Specimen Certificate for Class A Common Stock (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 3 to 
the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on July 16, 2012).

  Description of Securities of the Registrant.

Indenture, dated as of March 2, 2020, between NuVasive and the Trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to NuVasive, 
Inc.’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 2, 2020).
First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of September 1, 2023, among Globus, NuVasive and the Trustee (incorporated by reference to 
Exhibit 4.2 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 1, 2023).
Form of 0.375% Convertible Senior Note due 2025 (incorporated by reference to NuVasive, Inc.’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed 
with the SEC on March 2, 2020)
Globus Medical, Inc. 2012 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 1 to 
the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on May 8, 2012).
Form of Incentive Stock Option Grant Notice and Incentive Stock Option Agreement under 2012 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated 
by reference to Exhibit 10.10 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on May 8, 2012).
Form of Nonqualified Stock Option Grant Notice and Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement under 2012 Equity Incentive Plan 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on 
May 8, 2012).
Form of Indemnification Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.18 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 1 to the 
Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on May 8, 2012).
Form of No Competition and Non-Disclosure Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 of the Registrant’s Amendment 
No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on May 8, 2012).
Executive Employment Agreement, dated May 3, 2016 by and between Globus Medical, Inc. and Daniel T. Scavilla (incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.1 to our Form 10-Q filed on May 4, 2016).
Executive Employment Agreement, dated August 5, 2020 by and between Globus Medical, Inc. and Kelly Huller (incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.1 to our Form 10-Q filed on August 5, 2020).
Executive Employment Agreement, dated August 5, 2020 by and between Globus Medical, Inc. and Keith Pfeil (incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.2 to our Form 10-Q filed on August 5, 2020).
Globus Medical, Inc. 2021 Equity Incentive Plan, as amended (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to our Form 8-K filed on 
June 8, 2023).
Globus Medical, Inc. 2021 Equity Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.5 to our 
Form S-8 filed on December, 16, 2021).
Globus Medical, Inc. 2021 Equity Incentive Plan Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.6 to 
our Form S-8 filed on December, 16, 2021).
Globus Medical, Inc. 2021 Equity Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.7 to our Form 
S-8 filed on December, 16, 2021).
Globus Medical, Inc. 2021 Equity Incentive Plan Incentive Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.8 to 
our Form S-8 filed on December, 16, 2021).

103

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

10.14

10.15

10.16

10.17

10.18

10.19

10.20

10.21

10.22

10.23

10.24

10.25

10.26

10.27

10.28

10.29

10.30

Indenture, dated as of March 2, 2020, between NuVasive and the Trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to NuVasive, 
Inc.’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 2, 2020).
First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of September 1, 2023, among Globus, NuVasive and the Trustee (incorporated by reference to 
Exhibit 4.2 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 1, 2023).
Credit Agreement, dated as of September 27, 2023, by and among the Company, U.S. Bank National Association, as administrative 
agent, Citizens Bank, N.A., as syndication agent, and Royal Bank of Canada, as documentation agent, U.S. Bank National 
Association and Citizens Bank, N.A. as joint lead arrangers and joint book runners, and the other lenders referred to therein 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 2, 
2023).
Guaranty, dated as of September 27, 2023, by and among U.S. Bank National Association, as administrative agent, and NuVasive, 
Inc., NuVasive Clinical Services Monitoring, Inc. and Branch Medical Group, as guarantors (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
10.2 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 2, 2023).
2014 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit A to NuVasive Inc.'s Definitive Proxy Statement filed with the 
Commission on March 27, 2014) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q 
filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023).
2015 Ellipse Technologies, Inc. Incentive Award Plan (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Registration Statement on Form 
S-8 filed with the Commission on February 11, 2016).
Lease for Sorrento Summit, dated as of August 28, 2017, by and between HCPI/Sorrento, LLC and the Company (incorporated by 
reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on August 29, 2017).
Confirmation for base call option transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the 
Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020).
Confirmation for base call option transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association 
and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 
2020).
Confirmation for base call option transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company 
(incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020).

Confirmation for base call option transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company 
(incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020).

Confirmation for base call option transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company 
(incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020).

Confirmation for base warrant transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the 
Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020).

Confirmation for base warrant transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association and 
the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 
2020).

Confirmation for base warrant transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company 
(incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020).

Confirmation for base warrant transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company 
(incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020).
Confirmation for base warrant transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company 
(incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020).

104

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

10.31

10.32

10.33

10.34

10.35

10.36

10.37

10.38

10.39

10.40

10.41

10.42

10.43

10.44

10.45

10.46

10.47

10.48

Bond Hedge Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company (incorporated 
by reference to Exhibit 10.18 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). 
Bond Hedge Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company (incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.19 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). 
Warrant Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company (incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.20 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023).
Warrant Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company (incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.21 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). 
Bond Hedge Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association and the 
Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.22 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on 
November 7, 2023).
Bond Hedge Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association and the 
Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on 
November 7, 2023). 
Warrant Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association and the 
Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on 
November 7, 2023). 
Warrant Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association and the 
Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on 
November 7, 2023). 
Bond Hedge Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the 
Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on 
November 7, 2023). 
Bond Hedge Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the 
Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on 
November 7, 2023). 
Warrant Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the Company 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.28 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 
7, 2023). 
Warrant Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the Company 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 
7, 2023). 
Bond Hedge Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 
7, 2023).
Bond Hedge Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.31 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 
7, 2023). 
Warrant Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company (incorporated 
by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). 
Warrant Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company (incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.33 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). 
Bond Hedge Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 
7, 2023). 
Bond Hedge Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company (incorporated 
by reference to Exhibit 10.35 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). 

105

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

10.49

10.50

21.1*
23.1*
31.1*
31.2*
32**
97.1*
101.INS*

101.SCH*
101.CAL*
101.LAB*
101.PRE*
101.DEF*
104

*
**
***

Warrant Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company (incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.36 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). 
Warrant Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company (incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.37 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). 

  Subsidiaries of Globus Medical, Inc.
  Consent of independent registered public accounting firm – Deloitte & Touche LLP.
  Certification by Principal Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  Certification by Principal Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  Certifications pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  Globus Compensation Recoupment Policy

XBRL Instance Document – the instance document does not appear in the Interactive Data File because its XBRL tags are embedded 
within the Inline XBRL document.

  XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document
  XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document
  XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document
  XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document
  XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document
  Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as Inline XBRL and contained in Exhibit 101)

  Filed herewith.
  Furnished herewith.

Schedules  and  exhibits  have  been  omitted  pursuant  to  Item  601(b)(2)  of  Regulation  S-K.  The  Registrant  agrees  to  furnish  on  a 
supplemental basis a copy of the omitted schedules and exhibits to the Commission upon request.

Item 16. Form 10-K Summary

None.

106

 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed 

on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

SIGNATURES

Dated: February 20, 2024

/s/ DANIEL T. SCAVILLA

GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC.

Daniel T. Scavilla
Chief Executive Officer
President
(Principal Executive Officer)

Dated: February 20, 2024

/s/ KEITH PFEIL

Keith Pfeil
Chief Financial Officer and Chief Operating Officer

Chief Accounting Officer 
Senior Vice President
(Principal Financial Officer)

107

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Table of Contents

Pursuant  to  the  requirements  of  the  Securities  Exchange  Act  of  1934,  this  report  has  been  signed  by  the  following  persons  on  behalf  of  the 

Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

SIGNATURE

TITLE

President and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
and Director

Chief Financial Officer and Chief Operating Officer
Chief Accounting Officer
Senior Vice President
(Principal Financial Officer)

DATE

February 20, 2024

February 20, 2024

/s/ DANIEL T. SCAVILLA
Daniel T. Scavilla

/s/ KEITH PFEIL
Keith Pfeil

/s/ DAVID C. PAUL
David C. Paul

/s/ DAVID D. DAVIDAR
David D. Davidar

/s/ ROBERT DOUGLAS
Robert Douglas

/s/ DANIEL T. LEMAITRE
Daniel T. Lemaitre

/s/ ANN D. RHOADS
Ann D. Rhoads

/s/ JAMES R. TOBIN
James R. Tobin

/s/ STEPHEN T. ZARRILLI
Stephen T. Zarrilli

/s/ JOHN A. DEFORD
John A. DeFord

/s/ DANIEL J. WOLTERMAN
Daniel J. Wolterman

/s/ LESLIE V. NORWALK
Leslie V. Norwalk

Executive Chairman and Director

February 20, 2024

Director

Director

Director

Director

Director

Director

Director

Director

Director

108

February 20, 2024

February 20, 2024

February 20, 2024

February 20, 2024

February 20, 2024

February 20, 2024

February 20, 2024

February 20, 2024

February 20, 2024

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
DESCRIPTION OF THE REGISTRANT’S SECURITIES
REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12 OF THE
SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

EXHIBIT 4.2

As of December 31, 2023, Globus Medical, Inc. (the “Company”,  “our”, “us”, or “we”) had one class of securities registered
under Section 12 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”): Class A common stock, par value $.001 per
share. The Company’s Class A common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the trading symbol “GMED”.

DESCRIPTION OF COMMON STOCK

The following is a description of the rights of our Class A and Class B common stock and related provisions of the Company’s
Amended  and  Restated  Certificate  of  Incorporation  (the  “Certificate”),  Amended  and  Restated  Bylaws  (the  “Bylaws”),  and  applicable
Delaware  law.  This  description  is  qualified  in  its  entirety  by,  and  should  be  read  in  conjunction  with,  the  Certificate,  Bylaws,  and
applicable Delaware law.

Authorized Capital Stock

The Company’s authorized capital stock consists of 500,000,000 shares of Class A common stock and 275,000,000 shares of
Class B common stock. The Company is authorized to issue up to 35,000,000 shares of preferred stock. As of December 31, 2023, the
Company does not have any issued or outstanding shares of preferred stock.

Common Stock

Fully Paid and Nonassessable

All of the outstanding shares of the Company’s common stock are fully paid and nonassessable.

Voting Rights

Holders  of  our  Class  A  and  Class  B  common  stock  have  identical  voting  rights,  except  that  holders  of  our  Class  A  common
stock are entitled to one vote per share and holders of our Class B common stock are entitled to 10 votes per share. Holders of shares of
our Class A and Class B common stock will vote together as a single class on all matters (including the election of directors) submitted to
a vote of stockholders, unless otherwise required by law or the Certificate. Delaware law could require either our Class A common stock
or our Class B common stock to vote separately as a single class in the following circumstances:

·

·

If we were to seek to amend the Certificate or increase or decrease the authorized number of shares of a class of stock, or to
increase  or  decrease  the  par  value  of  a  class  of  stock,  then  that  class  would  be  required  to  vote  separately  to  approve  the
proposed amendment; and
If we were to seek to amend the Certificate in a manner that altered or changed the powers, preferences or special rights of a
class  of  stock  in  a  manner  that  affected  them  adversely,  then  that  class  would  be  required  to  vote  separately  to  approve  the
proposed amendment.

We have not provided for cumulative voting for the election of directors in the Certificate. Our Board of Directors (the “Board”)
is  divided  into  three  classes,  which  are  as  nearly  equal  in  number  as  possible,  with  each  director  elected  at  an  annual  stockholders’
meeting serving a three-year term and one class being elected at each year’s annual meeting of stockholders.

Dividend Rights

Subject to preferences that may apply to any shares of preferred stock outstanding at the time, if any, the holders of outstanding
shares  of  Class  A  and  Class  B  common  stock  are  entitled  to  receive  dividends  out  of  funds  legally  available  at  the  times  and  in  the
amounts  that  the  Board  may  determine.  Dividends  may  be  paid  in  cash,  in  property,  or  in  shares  of  the  Company’s  capital  stock.  If
dividends are paid in shares of stock or rights to purchase shares of stock, the holders of Class A common stock will receive shares of
Class A common stock or rights to purchase shares of Class A common stock and the holders of  Class  B  common  stock  will  receive
shares of Class B common stock or rights to purchase shares of Class B common stock.

Right to Receive Liquidation Distributions

Upon the Company’s liquidation, dissolution, distribution of assets or winding-up, the assets legally available for distribution to
stockholders  would  be  distributable  ratably  among  the  holders  of  Class  A  and  Class  B common stock and  any  participating  preferred
stock outstanding at that time, if any, after payment of liquidation preferences, if any, on any outstanding shares of preferred stock and
payment of other claims of creditors.

 
No Preemptive or Similar Rights

Neither Class A nor Class B common stock is entitled to preemptive rights, and neither is subject to redemption. There are no

sinking fund provisions applicable to the Company’s common stock.

Conversion

Our Class A  common  stock  is  not  convertible  into  any  other  shares  of  our  capital  stock.  Each  share  of  our  Class  B  common
stock is convertible at any time at the option of the holder into one share of our Class A common stock. In addition, each share of our
Class B common stock will convert automatically into one share of our Class A  common  stock  upon  any  transfer,  whether  or  not  for
value,  except  for  permitted  transfers.  Class  B  common  stockholders  may  transfer  shares  of  Class  B  common  stock  in  the  following
manner without having the shares of Class B common stock convert to Class A common stock:

·

·

·

·
·
·

the granting of a proxy to officers or directors of the Company whether or not at the request of the Board in connection with
actions to be taken at an annual or special meeting of stockholders;
entering into a voting trust, agreement or arrangement (with or without granting a proxy) pursuant to which voting control is
granted over such share to an officer or director of the Company that does not involve any payment of cash, securities, property
or other consideration to the Class B stockholder other than the mutual promise to vote shares in a designated manner;
a  transfer  by  a  stockholder  who  is  an  individual  upon  such  stockholder’s  death  pursuant  to  a  will  or  the  laws  of  descent  and
distribution;
any transfer of convertible securities;
any transfer to an affiliate; or
any transfer by an individual stockholder to, or for the benefit of, any spouse or any ancestor, descendant, sibling, or child of a
sibling of such stockholder or his or her spouse, or any transfer by a stockholder to a trust, limited partnership or limited liability
company for the benefit of such individual stockholder or any such family member, or any transfer by such a trust, partnership
or limited liability company to any such stockholder or family member.

With  respect  to  each  holder  of  one  or  more  shares  of  our  Class  B  common  stock,  each  of  such  holder’s  shares  of  Class  B

common stock will automatically convert into one share of our Class A common stock if:

·

such holder’s shares of Class B common stock, together with the shares of Class B common stock then held by that holder’s
affiliates, represents less than 5% of the aggregate number of all outstanding shares of our common stock.

Once converted into Class A common stock, Class B common stock cannot be reissued.

Anti-Takeover Provisions of the Certificate, Bylaws, and Delaware Law

The provisions of Delaware law, our dual class structure, the Certificate and Bylaws may have the effect of delaying, deferring

or discouraging another person from acquiring control of our company.

Delaware Law

We are governed by the provisions of Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law. In general, Section 203 prohibits a
public Delaware corporation from engaging in a “business combination” with an “interested stockholder” for a period of three years after
the date of prescribed manner. A “business combination” includes mergers, asset sales or other transactions resulting in a financial benefit
to the stockholder. An “interested stockholder” is a person who, together with affiliates and associates, owns, or within three years did
own,  15%  or  more  of  the  corporation’s  outstanding  voting  stock.  These  provisions  may  have  the  effect  of  delaying,  deferring  or
preventing a change in our control.

Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Amended and Restated Bylaw Provisions

The Certificate and Bylaws provide for a dual class structure and include a number of other provisions that could deter hostile

takeovers or delay or prevent changes in control of our management team, including the following:

Dual Class Structure

As discussed above, our  Class  B  common  stock  has  10    votes  per  share,  while  our  Class  A  common  stock  has  one  vote per
share. David C. Paul, a director and our current Executive Chairman, and his affiliates, in the aggregate, beneficially own 100% of our
outstanding  Class  B  common  stock,  representing  approximately  65.8%  of  the  total  voting  power  of  our  outstanding  capital  stock.
Because of our dual class structure, the holders of our Class B common stock will continue to be able to control all matters submitted to
our stockholders for approval even if they own significantly less than 50% of the shares of our outstanding common stock. This

 
concentrated  control  could  discourage  others  from  initiating  any  potential  merger,  takeover  or  other  change  of  control  transaction  that
other stockholders might view as beneficial. The Board is authorized, without stockholder approval, to issue additional authorized shares
of our Class A and Class B common stock.

Board of Directors Vacancies

The  Certificate  and  Bylaws  authorize  our  board  of  directors  or  stockholders  (at  a  duly  convened  meeting)  to  fill  vacant

directorships.

Classified Board

The Bylaws provide that the Board is classified into three classes of directors. This could delay a successful tender offeror from
obtaining majority control of the Board, and the prospect of that delay might deter a potential offeror. In addition, stockholders are not
permitted to cumulate their votes for the election of directors.

Stockholder Action; Special Meeting of Stockholders

The Bylaws provide that our stockholders may not take action by written consent, but may only take action at annual or special
meetings of our stockholders. The Bylaws further provide that special meetings of our stockholders may be called only by a majority of
our board of directors.

Advance Notice Requirements for Stockholder Proposals and Director Nominations

The  Bylaws  provide  advance  notice  procedures  for  stockholders  seeking  to  bring  business  before  our  annual  meeting  of
stockholders,  or  to  nominate  candidates  for  election  as  directors  at  our  annual  meeting  of  stockholders.  To  be  timely,  a  stockholder’s
notice must be delivered to, or mailed and received at, our principal executive offices not more than 90 nor less than 50 days prior to the
meeting with respect to an annual meeting of stockholders, and not later than 10 business days after public announcement of a special
meeting. The Bylaws also specify certain requirements regarding the form and content of a stockholder’s notice. These provisions might
preclude our stockholders from bringing matters before our annual meeting of stockholders or from making nominations for directors at
our annual meeting of stockholders.

Preferred Stock

The  Board  has  the  authority,  without  further  action  by  our  stockholders,  to  issue  up  to  35,000,000  shares  of  undesignated
preferred  stock  with  rights  and  preferences,  including  voting,  dividend,  redemption,  liquidation  or  preemptive rights, designated from
time to time by the Board, which could be in preference or priority to the rights of holders of our Class A and Class B common stock.
The  Board  may  utilize  such  shares  for  a  variety  of  corporate  purposes,  including  future  public  offerings  to  raise  additional  capital,
corporate acquisitions and employee benefit plans. Also, the existence of authorized but unissued shares of preferred stock would enable
the Board to render more difficult or to discourage an attempt to obtain control of us by means of a merger, tender offer, proxy contest or
other  means.  If  we  issue  such  shares  without  stockholder  approval  and  in  violation  of  limitations  imposed  by  the  New  York  Stock
Exchange or any stock exchange on which our stock may then be trading, our stock could be delisted.

Listing

The Company’s Class A common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the trading symbol “GMED”.

Subsidiaries of Globus Medical, Inc.

EXHIBIT 21.1

The following is a list of our subsidiaries as of December 31, 2023, omitting subsidiaries which, considered in the aggregate, would not
constitute a significant subsidiary as defined by Rule 1-02(w) of Regulation S-X.

Subsidiary
Globus Medical North America, Inc.
Branch Medical Group, LLC
NuVasive, Inc.
NuVasive Technology International Limited
KB Medical SA
Synoste OY
Nemaris Inc.
Globus Medical SARL
MIS Spine Comercials de R.L. de C.V.
Globus Medical Brazil LDTA
Globus Medical Italy S.r.l
American Neuromonitoring Associates, P.C.
Simplify Medical Pty.
Globus Medical Netherlands Biologics
NuVasive Netherlands Coopertief U.A.
NuVasive Netherlands B.V.
NuVasive Clinical Services Monitoring Inc.
NuVasive Japan K.K.
NuVasive Specialized Orthopedics, Inc.
NuVasive Germany GmbH
NuVasive Italia S.r.l.
Globus Medical Japan GK
NuVasive (AUST/NZ) Pty. Ltd.

  Jurisdiction
  Pennsylvania
  Delaware
  Delaware
  Malta
  Switzerland
  Finland
  Delaware
  Switzerland
  Mexico
  Brazil
  Italy
  Maryland
  Australia
  Netherlands
  Netherlands
  Netherlands
  Delaware
  Japan
  Delaware
  Germany
  Italy
  Japan
  Australia

 
 
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

We consent to the incorporation by reference in Registration Statement on Form S-8 (Nos. 333-275809, 333-261694, 333-198698  and
333-184196)  of  our  reports  dated  February  20, 2024,  relating  to  the  financial  statements  and  financial  statement  schedule  of  Globus
Medical, Inc. and the effectiveness of Globus Medical, Inc.’s internal control over financial reporting appearing in this Annual Report on
Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2023.  

EXHIBIT 23.1

/s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP

Philadelphia, Pennsylvania
February 20, 2024

EXHIBIT 31.1

I, Daniel T. Scavilla, certify that:

Certification By Principal Executive Officer
Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

1.

2.

3.

4.

I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Globus Medical, Inc.;

Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact
necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading
with respect to the period covered by this report;

Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all
material respects the financial condition, results of operations, and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods
presented in this report;

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures
(as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e)) and 15d-15(e) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in
Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:

a)

b)

c)

d)

Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed
under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated
subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is
being prepared;

Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be
designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our
conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by
this report based on such evaluation; and

Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the
registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has
materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting;
and

5.

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over
financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons
performing the equivalent functions):

a)

b)

All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial
reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize, and
report financial information; and

Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the
registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

Date: February 20, 2024

/s/ DANIEL T. SCAVILLA

Daniel T. Scavilla
Chief Executive Officer
President
(Principal Executive Officer)

 
 
 
 
 
 
EXHIBIT 31.2

I, Keith Pfeil, certify that:

Certification By Principal Financial Officer
Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

1.

2.

3.

4.

I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Globus Medical, Inc.;

Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact
necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading
with respect to the period covered by this report;

Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all
material respects the financial condition, results of operations, and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods
presented in this report;

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures
(as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in
Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:

a)

b)

c)

d)

Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed
under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated
subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is
being prepared;

Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be
designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our
conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by
this report based on such evaluation; and

Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the
registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has
materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting;
and

5.

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over
financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons
performing the equivalent functions):

a)

b)

All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial
reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize, and
report financial information; and

Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the
registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.

Date: February 20, 2024

/s/ KEITH PFEIL

Keith Pfeil
Chief Financial Officer and Chief Operating Officer
Chief Accounting Officer
Senior Vice President
(Principal Financial Officer)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted
Pursuant to Section 906 of The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

EXHIBIT 32

Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code), Daniel T.
Scavilla, Chief Executive Officer, and Keith Pfeil,  Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Globus Medical, Inc. (the
“Company”), each certifies with respect to the Annual Report of the Company on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2023
(the “Report”) that, to the best of his knowledge:

(1) The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

(2) The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations

of the Company.

Date: February 20, 2024

/s/ DANIEL T. SCAVILLA

Daniel T. Scavilla
Chief Executive Officer
President
(Principal Executive Officer)

Date: February 20, 2024

/s/ KEITH PFEIL

Keith Pfeil
Chief Financial Officer and Chief Operating Officer
Chief Accounting Officer
Senior Vice President
(Principal Financial Officer)

The foregoing certification is being furnished solely pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (Section 1350 of Chapter
63 of Title 18 of the United States Code) and is not being filed as part of the Report or as a separate disclosure document.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC.

COMPENSATION RECOUPMENT POLICY

I.

Purpose

The  Board  of  Directors  (“Board”) of Globus Medical, Inc. (“Globus”),  as  recommended  by
this  Compensation
its  Compensation  Committee 
Recoupment Policy (this “Policy) as its mandatory clawback policy if a Restatement under
the Applicable Rules (defined below) occurs.

(“Committee”),  has  adopted 

Any  capitalized  terms  used  but  not  immediately  defined  in  this  Policy  shall  have  the
meanings contained in Section II.

II.

Defined Terms

a.

b.

c.

d.

e.

“Applicable  Rules”  means  Section  10D  of  the  Exchange  Act  and  Rule  10D-1
promulgated  thereunder,  Section  303A.14  of  The  New  York  Stock  Exchange
(“NYSE”) Listed Company Manual, applicable interpretations of these rules, and any
other  national  stock  exchange  rules  or  interpretations  to  which  Globus  is  or
becomes subject.

“Exchange Act” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

“Financial  Reporting  Measures”  mean  (i)  measures  used  in  preparing  Globus’s
financial  statements  that  are  determined  and  presented  in  accordance  with  U.S.
generally accepted accounting principles, and any measures derived in whole or in
part  from  such  measures,  (ii)  Globus’s  stock  price,  and  (iii)  Globus’s  total
shareholder return. A “Financial Reporting Measure” need  not  be  presented  in  the
financial statements or a report filed with the SEC.

“Incentive-Based Compensation”  means  any  compensation  granted,  earned,  paid,
received,  or  vested,  based  in  whole  or  in  part  on  the  attainment  of  a  Financial
Reporting Measure. Incentive-Based Compensation does not include, among other
forms  of  compensation,  base  salary  or  cash  bonuses  or  equity  awards  that  vest
exclusively upon completion of a specified employment period and are unrelated to
Financial  Reporting  Measures.  Incentive-Based  Compensation  is  deemed  to  be
“Received” 
the  Financial  Reporting
Measure applicable to the Incentive-Based Compensation award is attained, even if
the payment or grant of the Incentive-Based Compensation occurs in another fiscal
period.

fiscal  period  during  which 

the 

in 

“Recovery Period” means the three  completed  fiscal  years  immediately  before  the
date that Globus is required to prepare a Restatement, which date is the earlier of
the  date  (i)  the  Board,  a  Board  committee,  or  the  officer  or  officers  of  Globus
authorized  to  take  such  action  if  Board  action  is  not  required,  conclude,  or
reasonably  should  have  concluded,  that  Globus  is  required  to  prepare  a
Restatement or (ii) a court, regulator, or other legally authorized body directs Globus
to prepare a Restatement.

f.

“Regulators” means, as applicable, the SEC and NYSE.

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
g.

h.

i.

“Restatement” means an accounting restatement that Globus is required to prepare
due  to  Globus’s  material  noncompliance  with  any  financial  reporting  requirement
under  the  securities  laws,  including  (i)  an  error  in  previously  issued  financial
statements  that  is  material  to  the  previously  issued  financial  statements,  or  (ii)  an
error that would result in a material misstatement if it were corrected in the current
period or left uncorrected in the current period.

“SEC” means the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.

“Senior Officer” means any person designated by the Board as such in accordance
with the definition of executive officer set forth in the Applicable Rules.

III.

Administration

The Committee shall administer this Policy and has the sole discretion to make all related
determinations under this Policy, provided that the Committee must interpret this Policy in a
manner that is consistent with the Applicable Rules.

IV.

Recovery on a Restatement

If required to prepare a Restatement, Globus shall reasonably and promptly recover from
any  Senior  Officer  the  amount,  as  calculated  pursuant  to  this  Section  IV,  of  erroneously
awarded Incentive-Based Compensation that was Received by such Senior  Officer  during
the  Recovery  Period.  The  amount  of  erroneously  awarded 
Incentive-Based
Compensation subject to this Policy will be the excess of (i) the amount of Incentive-Based
Compensation  the  Senior  Officer  Received  (whether  in  cash  or  shares)  based  on  the
erroneous data in the original financial statements; over (ii) the amount of Incentive-Based
Compensation (whether in cash or shares) the Senior Officer would have Received if the
Incentive-Based Compensation had been based on the restated results, without respect to
any  tax  liabilities  the  Senior  Officer  incurred  or  paid  in  respect  of  such  Incentive-Based
Compensation.

Recovery of any erroneously awarded compensation under this Policy is not dependent on
fraud or misconduct by any Senior Officer in connection with a Restatement.

Without limiting the foregoing, for Incentive-Based Compensation based on Globus’s stock
price or total shareholder return, where the amount of erroneously awarded compensation
is  not  subject  to  mathematical  recalculation  directly  from  the  information  in  the
Restatement, (i) the amount shall be based on Globus’s reasonable estimate of the  effect
of the Restatement on the stock price or total shareholder return upon which the Incentive-
Based  Compensation  was  Received  and  (ii)  Globus  shall  maintain  documentation  of  the
determination of that reasonable estimate and provide such estimate to NYSE.

If a Senior Officer fails to repay or reimburse erroneously awarded compensation subject to
recovery  under  this  Policy,  the  Committee  may  require  the  Senior  Officer  to  reimburse
Globus  for  any  and  all  expenses  reasonably  incurred  (including  legal  fees)  in  recovering
the erroneously awarded compensation.

2

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
V.

Coverage and Application

This Policy covers all Senior Officers  who  have  Received  Incentive-Based  Compensation
at  any  time  during  the  Recovery  Period.  Incentive-Based  Compensation  shall  not  be
recovered under this Policy if Received by any person before the effective date that such
person  was  appointed  a  Senior  Officer.  Subsequent  changes  in  a  Senior  Officer’s
employment  status,  including  retirement  or  termination  of  employment,  do  not  affect
Globus’s right or obligation to recover Incentive-Based Compensation under this Policy.

This  Policy  shall  apply  to  Incentive-Based  Compensation  Received  by  any  Senior  Officer
on  or  after  October  2,  2023  (the  “NYSE  Rule  Effective  Date”)  that  results  from  the
attainment of a Financial Reporting Measure based on or derived from financial information
for  any  fiscal  period  ending  on  or  after  the  NYSE  Rule  Effective  Date.  This  includes
Incentive-Based  Compensation  approved,  awarded,  or  granted  to  a  Senior  Officer  on  or
before  the  NYSE  Rule  Effective  Date,  even  if  such  Incentive-Based  Compensation  is
Received after the NYSE Rule Effective Date.

VI.

Exceptions to Policy

Globus  shall  not  be  required  to  recover  Incentive-Based  Compensation  if  any  of  the
following conditions exist and the Committee determines that these conditions would cause
recovery to be impracticable:

a.

c.

The  direct  expense  paid  to  a  third  party  to  assist  in  enforcing  this  Policy  would
exceed  the  recoverable  amount;  provided  that  before  the  Committee  determines
that recovery would be impracticable based on the expense of enforcement, Globus
shall  have  (i)  made  a  reasonable  attempt  to  recover  the  Incentive-Based
Compensation,  (ii)  documented  such  reasonable  attempts  to  recover,  and  (iii)
provided NYSE applicable documentation;

b. Recovery would violate the home country law where that law was adopted before
November 28, 2022, and the Committee has obtained an opinion of home  country
counsel,  acceptable  to  NYSE,  that  recovery  would  result  in  such  a  violation,  and
has provided such opinion to NYSE in accordance with the Applicable Rules; or

Recovery  would  likely  cause  an  otherwise  tax-qualified  retirement  plan,  under
which benefits are broadly available to employees, to fail to meet the requirements
of  Section  401(a)(13)  or  Section  411(a)  of  the  Internal  Revenue  Code  of  1986,  as
amended (the “Code”), and related U.S. Treasury regulations.

VII.

Public Disclosure

Globus shall make all required disclosures and filings with the Regulators concerning this
Policy  consistent  with  the  requirements  of  the  Applicable  Rules  and  any  other  applicable
requirements, including any disclosures required in connection with SEC filings.

VIII. Methods of Recovery

In  the  event  of  a  Restatement,  the  Committee  may  take  any  such  actions  as  it  deems
necessary or appropriate, subject to applicable law, including, without limitation:

4

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
a.

b.

c.

d.

e.

f.

The reduction or cancellation of any Incentive-Based Compensation  in  the  form  of
vested or unvested equity or equity-based awards that have not been distributed or
otherwise settled before the date of determination;

The  recovery  of  any  Incentive-Based  Compensation  previously  paid  to  the  Senior
Officer;

The  recovery  of  any  gain  realized  on  the  vesting,  exercise,  settlement,  sale,
transfer,  or  other  disposition  of  any  Incentive-Based  Compensation  in  the  form  of
equity or equity-based awards;

The offset, withholding, or elimination of any amount that could be paid or awarded
to the Senior Officer after the date of determination;

The recoupment of any amount of Incentive-Based Compensation contributed to a
plan that takes into account Incentive-Based Compensation (excluding certain tax-
qualified  plans,  but  including  long-term  disability,  life  insurance,  supplemental
executive  retirement  plans  and  deferred  compensation  plans,  in  each  case  to  the
extent  permitted  by  applicable  law,  including  Section  409A  of  the  Code)  and  any
earnings accrued to date on any such amount; and

The  taking  of  any  other  remedial  and  recovery  action  permitted  by  law  that  the
Committee determines.

The  Committee  also  may  authorize  legal  action  for  breach  of  fiduciary  duty  or  other
violation  of  law  and  take  such  other  actions  to  enforce  the  Senior  Officer’s  obligations  to
Globus as the Committee deems appropriate.

IX.

No Indemnification

Globus  shall  not  indemnify  any  current  or  former  Senior  Officer  against  the  loss  of
erroneously awarded compensation and shall not pay or reimburse any Senior Officer for
premiums incurred or paid for any insurance policy to fund such  Senior  Officer’s  potential
recovery obligations.

X.

Administrator Indemnification

The  Committee,  and  any  other  members  of  the  Board  who  assist  in  the  administration  of
this  Policy,  shall  not  be  personally  liable  for  any  action,  determination  or  interpretation
made  with  respect  to  this  Policy  and  shall  be  fully  indemnified  by  Globus  to  the  fullest
extent  under  applicable  law  and  Globus  policy  with  respect  to  any  such  action,
determination  or  interpretation.  The  foregoing  sentence  shall  not  limit  any  other  rights  to
indemnification of the Committee or members of the Board under applicable law, Globus’s
Certificate  of  Incorporation  and  Bylaws  (as  each  may  be  amended  from  time  to  time),  or
any contractual rights.

6

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
XI.

No Substitution of Rights; Non-Exhaustive Rights

Any  right  of  recoupment  under  this  Policy  is  additive  and  does  not  replace  any  other
remedies  or  rights  of  recoupment  that  may  be  available  to  Globus  under  (a)  the  Globus
2021 Equity Incentive Plan, as amended, and any other incentive plan of Globus or any of
its  subsidiaries  or  affiliates,  or  any  amendments  or  successor  plans  thereto  and  (b)  the
terms  of  any  similar  policy  or  provision  in  any  equity  award  agreement,  employment
agreement, compensation agreement or arrangement, or similar agreement and any other
legal remedies available to Globus.

In  addition  to  recovery  of  compensation  as  provided  for  in  this  Policy,  Globus  may  take
any and all other actions as it deems necessary, appropriate, and in Globus’s best interest
in  connection  with  a  Restatement,  including  termination  of  a  Senior  Officer’s  employment
and  initiating  legal  action  against  a  Senior  Officer.  Nothing  in  this  Policy  limits  Globus’s
rights to take any such or other appropriate actions.

XII.

Amendment

The  Board,  on  the  Committee’s  recommendation,  may  amend  this  Policy  at  any  time  for
any  reason,  subject  to  any  limitations  under  the  Applicable  Rules.  The  Board  may
terminate this Policy whenever the Applicable Rules no longer apply to Globus.

XIII.

Successors

This Policy shall be binding and enforceable against all Senior Officers, their beneficiaries,
heirs, executors, administrators, or other legal representatives.

XIV.

Effective Date of Policy

This  Policy  shall  be  effective  as  of  December  1,  2023  (the  “Policy  Effective  Date”).  The
terms  of  this  Policy  shall  apply  to  any  Incentive-Based  Compensation  Received  by  any
Senior  Officer  on  or  after  the  NYSE  Rule  Effective  Date,  even  if  such  Incentive-Based
Compensation was approved, awarded, granted, or paid to such Senior Officer before  the
Policy  Effective  Date.  Without  limiting  the  generality  of  Section  VIII,  and  subject  to
applicable  law,  the  Committee  may  effect  recovery  under  this  Policy  from  any  amount  of
compensation approved, awarded, granted, payable, or paid to any Senior Officer prior to,
on, or after the Policy Effective Date.

8